2k15_export_cadillac_srx_KTA-6301_GB.ai
(Country = United Kingdom)
Color = Black
Spine Size = NEEDED - Est. .66 inch
07/16/14
KTA-6301/5-GB 07/2014
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
2014 Cadillac SRX Owner Manual M
In Brief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . 1-4
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
Performance and
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
Keys, Doors, and
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Keys and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Vehicle Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
Exterior Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
Interior Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
Seats and Restraints . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . 4-1
Additional Storage Features . . . 4-3
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
Climate Control Systems . . . . . . 8-1
Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Instruments and Controls . . . . 5-1
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Warning Lights, Gauges, and
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
Information Displays . . . . . . . . . . 5-25
Vehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28
Vehicle Personalisation . . . . . . . 5-38
Driving and Operating . . . . . . . . 9-1
Driving Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Starting and Operating . . . . . . . 9-13
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . 9-21
Drive Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26
Ride Control Systems . . . . . . . . 9-29
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32
Driver Assistance Systems . . . 9-42
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-54
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-57
Conversions and Add-Ons . . . 9-64
Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Lighting Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . 7-1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1
General Information . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
Vehicle Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32
Wheels and Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (2,1)
2014 Cadillac SRX Owner Manual M
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70
Towing the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 10-74
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . 10-78
Service and Maintenance . . . 11-1
General Information . . . . . . . . . . 11-1
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . 11-1
Recommended Fluids,
Lubricants, and Parts . . . . . . . 11-5
Maintenance Records . . . . . . . . 11-7
Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1
Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . 12-1
Vehicle Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2
Customer Information . . . . . . . 13-1
Customer Information . . . . . . . . 13-1
Vehicle Data Recording and
Privacy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-1
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i-1
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Introduction
Please refer to the purchase
documentation relating to your
specific vehicle to confirm each of
the features found on your vehicle.
Keep this manual in the vehicle for
quick reference.
The names, logos, emblems,
slogans, vehicle model names, and
vehicle body designs appearing in
this manual including, but not limited
to, GM, the GM logo, CADILLAC,
the CADILLAC Crest and Wreath,
and SRX are trademarks and/or
service marks of General Motors
LLC, its subsidiaries, affiliates,
or licensors.
This manual describes features that
may or may not be on your specific
vehicle either because they are
options that you did not purchase or
due to changes subsequent to the
printing of this owner manual.
iii
{ Warning
Text marked { Warning provides
information on risk of accident or
injury. Disregarding this
information may lead to injury.
Using this Manual
To quickly locate information about
the vehicle, use the Index in the
back of the manual. It is an
alphabetical list of what is in the
manual and the page number where
it can be found.
Danger, Warnings, and
Cautions
{ Danger
Text marked { Danger provides
information on risk of fatal injury.
Disregarding this information may
endanger life.
{ Caution
Text marked { Caution provides
information that may indicate a
hazard that could result in injury
or death. It could also result in
possible damage to the vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
iv
Black plate (4,1)
Introduction
Vehicle Symbol Chart
Here are some additional symbols
that may be found on the vehicle
and what they mean. For more
information on the symbol, refer to
the Index.
A circle with a slash through it is a
safety symbol which means “Do
Not,” “Do not do this,” or “Do not let
this happen.”
Symbols
The vehicle has components and
labels that use symbols instead of
text. Symbols are shown along with
the text describing the operation or
information relating to a specific
component, control, message,
gauge, or indicator.
M : This symbol is shown when
you need to see your owner manual
for additional instructions or
information.
* : This symbol is shown when
you need to see a service manual
for additional instructions or
information.
9 : Airbag Readiness Light
# : Air Conditioning
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)
g : Audio Steering Wheel Controls
$ : Brake System Warning Light
" : Charging System
I : Cruise Control
B : Engine Coolant Temperature
O : Exterior Lamps
# : Fog Lamps
. : Fuel Gauge
+ : Fuses
3 : Headlamp Main/Dipped-Beam
Changer
(:
j:
Heated Steering Wheel
LATCH System Child
Restraints
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp
: : Oil Pressure
g : Outside Power Foldaway
Mirrors
O:
/:
>:
7:
d:
M:
Power
Remote Vehicle Start
Safety Belt Reminders
Tyre Pressure Monitor
Traction Control/StabiliTrak®
Windscreen Washer Fluid
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
In Brief
In Brief
Instrument Panel
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Initial Drive Information
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . .
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . .
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Features . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Heated and Ventilated
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Head Restraint Adjustment . . . .
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-4
1-4
1-5
1-5
1-6
1-7
1-7
1-8
1-8
1-9
1-9
Mirror Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
Steering Wheel
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
Throttle and Brake Pedal
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
Windscreen Wiper/Washer . . . 1-12
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
Vehicle Features
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . .
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Infotainment System . . . . . . . . .
Driver Information
Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Side Blind Zone
Alert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Vision
Camera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ultrasonic Parking Assist . . . .
Active Emergency Braking
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-1
1-16
1-16
1-16
1-16
1-16
1-16
Performance and Maintenance
1-14
1-14
1-15
1-15
1-15
Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tyre Pressure Monitor . . . . . . .
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . .
Driving for Better Fuel
Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-17
1-18
1-18
1-18
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-2
In Brief
Instrument Panel
Black plate (2,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
In Brief
1. Air Vents on page 8-7.
7. Infotainment on page 7-1.
2. Indicator Lever. See Indicator
and Lane-Change Signals on
page 6-7.
8. Light Sensor. See Twilight
Sentinel on page 6-6.
3. Cruise Control on page 9-32.
Adaptive Cruise Control on
page 9-34 (If Equipped).
Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
System on page 9-45.
9. Dual Automatic Climate Control
System on page 8-1.
Heated and Ventilated Front
Seats on page 3-8 (If Equipped).
10. Exterior Lamp Controls on
page 6-1.
4. Instrument Cluster on page 5-9.
Front Fog Lamps on page 6-8.
5. Steering Wheel Controls on
page 5-2.
Rear Fog Lamps on page 6-8.
Driver Information Centre (DIC)
Controls. See Driver Information
Centre (DIC) on page 5-25.
6. Windscreen Wiper/Washer on
page 5-3.
Rear Window Wiper/Washer on
page 5-4.
Instrument Panel Illumination
Control on page 6-9.
11. Bonnet Release. See Bonnet
on page 10-4.
12. Data Link Connector (DLC)
(Out of View). See Malfunction
Indicator Lamp on page 5-15.
1-3
13. Steering Wheel Adjustment on
page 5-2.
14. Horn on page 5-3.
15. Pedal Adjust Control (Out of
View). See Adjustable Throttle
and Brake Pedal on page 9-13
(If Equipped).
16. ENGINE START/STOP Button.
See Ignition Positions on
page 9-14.
17. Hazard Warning Flashers on
page 6-7.
18. Heated and Ventilated Front
Seats on page 3-8 (If
Equipped).
19. CD Player. See Infotainment
on page 7-1.
Blu-Ray® Optical Drive (If
Equipped). See Infotainment
on page 7-1.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-4
Black plate (4,1)
In Brief
20. Handbrake on page 9-27.
21. Shift Lever. See Automatic
Transmission on page 9-21.
22. Parking Assist. See Driver
Assistance Systems on
page 9-42.
Lane Departure Warning
Button (If Equipped). See Lane
Departure Warning (LDW) on
page 9-51.
23. Front Storage on page 4-2 (If
Equipped).
24. Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control on page 9-29.
Initial Drive
Information
This section provides a brief
overview about some of the
important features that may or may
not be on your specific vehicle.
For more detailed information, refer
to each of the features which can be
found later in this owner manual.
Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) System
The RKE transmitter may be used
to lock and unlock the doors from up
to 60 m (197 ft) away from the
vehicle.
Q:
K:
Press to lock all doors.
Press to unlock the driver door
or all doors depending on the
vehicle personalisation settings.
Lock and unlock feedback can be
personalised.
See “Remote Lock, Unlock, Start”
under Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
L : Press and release one time
to initiate vehicle locator.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
In Brief
Press and hold L for
three seconds to sound the panic
alarm.
h:
Press and hold to open or
close the tailgate.
Press the key release button near
the bottom of the transmitter to
remove the key. The key can be
used for the driver door and the
glove box.
See Keys on page 2-1 and Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation on page 2-3.
Remote Vehicle Start
If available, this feature allows the
engine to be started from outside of
the vehicle.
Starting the Vehicle
1. Press and release
RKE transmitter.
Q on the
2. Immediately press and hold /
for at least four seconds until the
indicator lamps flash.
When the vehicle starts, the parking
lamps will remain on as long as the
engine is running. The doors will be
locked and the climate control
system may come on.
1-5
Door Locks
Keyless Access
The engine will continue to run for
10 minutes. Repeat the steps for a
10-minute time extension. Remote
start can be extended only once.
Cancelling a Remote Start
To cancel a remote start, do any of
the following:
.
Press and hold / until the
parking lamps turn off.
.
Turn on the hazard warning
lights.
.
Turn the vehicle on and then off.
See Remote Vehicle Start on
page 2-7.
When the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft)
of the driver door, pressing the lock/
unlock button on that door handle
will lock/unlock the doors. If the
lock/unlock button is pressed again
within five seconds, all passenger
doors will unlock. See Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation on page 2-3.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-6
In Brief
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
Tailgate
To lock or unlock the doors from the
outside, press Q or K on the RKE
transmitter. See Remote Keyless
Entry (RKE) System Operation on
page 2-3.
Manual Tailgate Operation
Key
To lock or unlock the door, use the
key in the driver door. Turn the key
anticlockwise once to unlock the
driver door; turning the key again
will unlock the passenger doors.
Inside the Vehicle
To unlock a door from the inside,
pull once on the door handle to
unlock it, and a second time to
open it.
Power Door Locks
There is a power door lock switch
on the front door panels.
Q:
K:
Black plate (6,1)
Press to lock the doors.
Press to unlock the doors.
See Power Door Locks on page 2-9.
For vehicles without Keyless
Access, unlock the vehicle before
opening the tailgate.
Press the touch pad in the handle of
the tailgate, above the number
plate, and lift up to open.
Do not press the touch pad while
closing the tailgate. This will cause
the tailgate to be unlatched.
Power Tailgate Operation
On vehicles with a power tailgate,
the switch is on the driver door. The
vehicle must be in P (Park) to use
the power feature. The tail lamps
flash when the power tailgate
moves.
Choose a power tailgate mode by
turning the dial on the switch until
the indicator lines up with the
desired position. Press the centre of
the switch.
The three modes are:
MAX: The tailgate opens to the full
open height.
3/4: The tailgate opens to a
reduced height that can be set by
the vehicle operator in a range of
approximately three-quarters open
to full open.
OFF: The tailgate only operates
manually in this position.
See Tailgate on page 2-11.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
In Brief
Windows
1-7
Remote Window Operation
To adjust the seat:
If equipped, remote operating
windows will open all the windows
from outside the vehicle by pressing
and holding K on the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
.
Move the seat forward or
rearward by sliding the
control (1) forward or rearward.
.
Raise or lower the front part of
the seat cushion by moving the
front of the control (1) up
or down.
.
Raise or lower the entire seat by
moving the rear of the control (1)
up or down.
See Power Windows on page 2-21.
Seat Adjustment
See Power Seat Adjustment on
page 3-3.
Press or pull the switch part of the
way to open or close the window.
.
Fully press the front of the switch
down and release it to
express-down the window. Fully pull
the switch up and release it to
express-up the window.
Raise or recline the seatback by
tilting control (2) forward or
rearward.
See Reclining Seat backrests on
page 3-5.
.
Press Z { to activate the window
lockout on the rear doors.
1. Seat Position Control
See Power Windows on page 2-21.
2. Seatback Adjustment Control
3. Lumbar Adjustment Control
Increase or decrease the lumbar
support by pressing and holding
the front or rear of control (3).
See Lumbar Adjustment on
page 3-4.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-8
Black plate (8,1)
In Brief
Memory Features
The “1,” “2,” and MEM buttons on
the outboard side of the driver seat
are used to manually save and
recall the positions of the driver
seat, outside mirrors, and adjustable
throttle and brake pedal positions.
See Memory Seats on page 3-6 and
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Heated and Ventilated
Seats
Heated and Ventilated Seat
Buttons Shown, Heated Seat
Buttons Similar
The buttons are near the climate
controls on the centre stack. To
operate, the ignition must be in ON/
RUN/START.
Press M or L to heat the driver or
passenger seat.
Press C or {, if available, to
ventilate the driver or passenger
seat. A ventilated seat has a fan
that pulls or pushes air through the
seat. The air is not cooled.
Press the button once for the
highest setting. With each press of
the button, the seat will change to
the next lower setting, and then to
the off setting. The indicator lights
next to the buttons indicate three for
the highest setting and one for the
lowest. If the front heated seats are
on high, the level may automatically
be lowered after approximately
30 minutes.
See Heated and Ventilated Front
Seats on page 3-8.
The heated and ventilated front
seats can also be programmed to
come on during a remote start. See
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
In Brief
Head Restraint
Adjustment
Safety Belts
1-9
Mirror Adjustment
Exterior
Do not drive until the head restraints
for all occupants are installed and
adjusted properly.
To achieve a comfortable seating
position, change the seatback
recline angle as little as necessary
while keeping the seat and the head
restraint height in the proper
position.
See Head Restraints on page 3-2
and Power Seat Adjustment on
page 3-3.
Refer to the following sections for
important information on how to use
safety belts properly:
Manual Folding Mirrors Shown,
Power Folding Similar
.
Safety Belts on page 3-11.
To adjust the mirror:
.
How to Wear Safety Belts
Properly on page 3-13.
.
Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 3-14.
1. Move the selector switch to L
(Left) or R (Right) to choose the
driver or passenger mirror.
.
ISOFIX Child Restraint Systems
on page 3-40
2. Press the arrows on the control
pad to move each mirror to the
desired position.
3. Return the selector switch to the
centre position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-10
Black plate (10,1)
In Brief
See Folding Mirrors on page 2-19.
To adjust the steering wheel:
Automatic Dimming Mirror
1. Pull the lever down.
If equipped, the driver outside mirror
and the inside rearview mirror
automatically adjust for the glare of
headlamps behind you. See
Automatic Dimming Mirror on
page 2-20 or Automatic Dimming
Rearview Mirror on page 2-21.
2. Move the steering wheel up
or down.
Steering Wheel
Adjustment
3. Pull or push the steering wheel
closer or away from you.
4. Pull the lever up to lock the
steering wheel in place.
Do not adjust the steering wheel
while driving.
Throttle and Brake Pedal
Adjustment
If the vehicle has this feature, the
position of the throttle and brake
pedals can be adjusted.
The switch used to adjust the
pedals is located on the right side of
the steering column, below the
wiper stalk. Pull the switch toward
you to move the pedals further from
the floor, or push the switch away
from you to move the pedals closer
to the floor.
See Adjustable Throttle and Brake
Pedal on page 9-13.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
In Brief
Interior Lighting
Reading Lamps
Dome Lamp
There are reading lamps on the
overhead console and over the rear
passenger doors. These lamps
come on when any door is opened.
The interior light control is in the
overhead console.
1-11
Exterior Lighting
To manually turn the reading lamps
on or off:
.
For the overhead console
reading lamps, press the m or
n next to each lamp.
.
For the rear passenger reading
lamps, press the lamp lens.
For more information on interior
lighting, see Instrument Panel
Illumination Control on page 6-9.
To change the dome lamp settings,
press the following:
* : Turns the lamp off, even when
a door is open.
1:
The lamp comes on when a
door is opened.
+:
Turns the dome lamp on.
The exterior lamp control is on the
instrument panel to the left of the
steering column.
There are four positions:
O : Briefly turn to this position to
turn the automatic light control off or
on again.
AUTO: Turns the headlamps on
automatically at normal brightness,
together with the parking lamps, tail
lamps, number plate lamps, and
instrument panel lights.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-12
In Brief
; : Turns the parking lamps on
together with the tail lamps, number
plate lamps, and instrument panel
lights.
With the ignition in ACC/
ACCESSORY or ON/RUN/START,
move the windscreen wiper lever to
select the wiper speed.
3 : Turns the headlamps on
together with the parking lamps, tail
lamps, number plate lamps, and
instrument panel lights.
HI: Use for fast wipes.
#/s:
Black plate (12,1)
LO: Use for slow wipes.
on or off.
See:
Exterior Lamp Controls on
page 6-1
.
Front Fog Lamps on page 6-8
.
Rear Fog Lamps on page 6-8
Windscreen Wiper/
Washer
Pull the windscreen wiper lever
toward you to spray windscreen
washer fluid and activate the wipers.
Rainsense™
If equipped with Rainsense:
INT: Move the windscreen wiper
lever to INT. Turn the x INT band
on the wiper lever to adjust the
sensitivity.
Press to turn the fog lamps
.
Windscreen Washer
.
Turn the band up for more
sensitivity to moisture.
INT: Use for intermittent wipes. To
adjust wipe frequency, turn the x
INT band up for more frequent
wipes or down for less frequent
wipes. If the vehicle has
Rainsense™, see the following
Rainsense information.
.
Turn the band down for less
sensitivity to moisture.
.
Move the windscreen wiper lever
out of the INT position to
deactivate Rainsense.
OFF: Use to turn the wipers off.
The rear wiper controls are on the
end of the windscreen wiper lever.
1X : For a single wipe, briefly move
the wiper lever down. For several
wipes, hold the wiper lever down.
Rear Window Wiper/Washer
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (13,1)
In Brief
1-13
Climate Controls
The climate control buttons and the touch screen are used to adjust the
heating, cooling, and ventilation.
ON: Press the upper portion of the
button for continuous rear window
wipes.
OFF: The rear wiper turns off when
the button is returned to the middle
position.
INT: Press the lower portion of the
button to set a delay between
wipes.
Climate Control Buttons
a:
Push the windscreen wiper
lever forward to spray washer fluid
on the rear window.
See Windscreen Wiper/Washer on
page 5-3 and Rear Window Wiper/
Washer on page 5-4.
1. Driver and Passenger
Temperature Controls
5. AUTO (Automatic Operation)
2. Fan Control
7. Rear Window Demister
3. OFF (Fan)
8. Recirculation
4. Driver and Passenger Heated
and Ventilated Seats (If
Equipped)
6. Defrost
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-14
Black plate (14,1)
In Brief
7. Rear (Rear Climate Control
Touch Screen)
Vehicle Features
8. Air Delivery Mode Control
Steering Wheel Controls
See Dual Automatic Climate Control
System on page 8-1 and Rear
Climate Control System on page 8-6
(If Equipped).
The infotainment system can be
operated by using the steering
wheel controls. See "Steering
Wheel Controls" in the infotainment
manual.
Transmission
Driver Shift Control (DSC)
Climate Touch Screen Controls
1. Outside Temperature Display
2. Driver and Passenger
Temperature Controls
3. Fan Control
4. SYNC (Synchronised
Temperature)
5. AC Mode (Air Conditioning)
6. Climate Control Selection
(Application Tray Button)
Cruise Control
DSC allows you to shift an
automatic transmission similar to a
manual gearbox. To use the DSC
feature:
1. Move the shift lever to the left
from D (Drive) to Sport Mode.
2. To enter M (Manual Mode),
press the shift lever forward (+)
to upshift or rearward (−) to
downshift.
See Manual Mode on page 9-23.
J:
Press to turn the system on
and off. An indicator appears in the
instrument cluster when turned on.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (15,1)
In Brief
+RES: Move the control up briefly
to resume to a previously set speed
or to increase vehicle speed if the
cruise control is already activated.
SET−: Move the control down
briefly to set the speed and activate
cruise control or to decrease vehicle
speed if the cruise control is already
activated.
Driver Information
Center (DIC)
SEL: Press to open a menu or
select a menu item. Press and hold
to reset values on certain screens.
The DIC display is in the instrument
cluster. It shows the status of many
vehicle systems.
See Driver Information Centre (DIC)
on page 5-25.
Forward Collision Alert
(FCA) System
*:
Press to disengage cruise
control without erasing the set
speed from memory.
See Cruise Control on page 9-32 or
Adaptive Cruise Control on
page 9-34 (if equipped).
Infotainment System
See the infotainment manual for
information on the radio, audio
players, phone, navigation system,
and voice or speech recognition.
It also includes information on
settings and downloadable
applications (if equipped).
1-15
y or z : Move SEL up or down to
go to the previous or next selection.
S or T :
Press to move between
the interactive display zones in the
cluster. Press S to go back to the
previous menu.
If equipped, FCA may help avoid or
reduce the harm caused by
front-end crashes. FCA provides a
green indicator when a vehicle is
detected directly ahead. This
indicator displays amber if you
follow a vehicle much too closely.
It also provides a flashing red alert
on the windscreen and rapidly
beeps or pulses the driver seat,
when approaching a vehicle too
quickly.
See Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
System on page 9-45.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-16
Black plate (16,1)
In Brief
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW)
See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)
on page 9-50.
If equipped, LDW is intended to help
avoid unintentional lane departures
at speeds of 56 km/h (35 mph) or
greater. LDW uses a camera sensor
to detect the lane markings. The
LDW indicator, @, appears green if
a lane marking is detected. If the
vehicle departs the lane, the
indicator will change to amber and
flash. In addition, beeps will sound,
or the driver seat will pulse.
Rear Vision
Camera (RVC)
See Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
on page 9-51.
If equipped, Ultrasonic Rear Parking
Assist (URPA) uses sensors on the
rear bumper to assist with parking
and avoiding objects while in
R (Reverse). It operates at speeds
less than 8 km/h (5 mph). URPA
may display a warning triangle on
the Rear Vision Camera screen and
a graphic on the instrument cluster
to provide the object distance. In
addition, multiple beeps or seat
pulses may occur if very close to an
object.
Side Blind Zone
Alert (SBZA)
If equipped, SBZA will detect
vehicles in the next lane over in the
vehicle's side blind zone area.
When this happens, the SBZA
display will light up in the
corresponding outside side mirror
and will flash if the turn signal is on.
If equipped, RVC displays a view of
the area behind the vehicle, on the
centre stack display, when the
vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).
See Assistance Systems for Parking
or Backing on page 9-43.
Ultrasonic Parking Assist
The vehicle may also have the Front
Parking Assist system.
See Assistance Systems for Parking
or Backing on page 9-43.
Active Emergency
Braking System
If the vehicle has Adaptive Cruise
Control (ACC) it also has the Active
Emergency Braking System, which
includes Intelligent Brake Assist
(IBA) and the Automatic Collision
Preparation (ACP) System. These
systems can provide a boost to
braking or automatically brake the
vehicle to help avoid or lessen the
severity of crashes.
See Active Emergency Braking
System on page 9-48.
Power Outlets
The accessory power outlets can be
used to plug in electrical equipment,
such as a cell phone or MP3 player.
The vehicle may have up to five
accessory power outlets.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (17,1)
In Brief
The accessory power outlets are:
.
Below the climate control system
inside the front storage bin.
.
Inside the centre floor console.
.
On the rear of the centre floor
console. For vehicles with a rear
climate control system, there will
be two accessory power outlets
on the rear of the centre floor
console.
.
In the rear cargo area.
These are powered while the
vehicle is in ON/RUN/START or
ACC/ACCESSORY mode, or until
the driver door is opened within
10 minutes of turning off the vehicle.
The power outlet located in the rear
cargo area is powered at all times.
See Power Outlets on page 5-6.
Performance and
Maintenance
Traction Control/
Electronic Stability
Control
The traction control system limits
wheel spin. The system turns on
automatically when the vehicle is
started.
.
Press and release g again to
turn traction control back on. i
goes out in the instrument
cluster. The appropriate
message is displayed in the DIC.
See Ride Control System
Messages on page 5-35.
.
To turn off both Traction Control
and StabiliTrak, press and hold
g on the centre stack, until g
and i illuminate in the
instrument cluster. The
appropriate message is
displayed in the DIC. See Ride
Control System Messages on
page 5-35.
.
Press g again to turn on both
systems. g and i go out in the
instrument cluster. The
appropriate message is
displayed in the DIC. See Ride
Control System Messages on
page 5-35.
The StabiliTrak system assists with
directional control of the vehicle in
difficult driving conditions. The
system turns on automatically when
the vehicle is started.
.
To turn off traction control, press
and release g on the centre
stack. i illuminates in the
instrument cluster. The
appropriate message is
displayed in the DIC. See Ride
Control System Messages on
page 5-35.
1-17
See Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control on page 9-29.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-18
Black plate (18,1)
In Brief
Tyre Pressure Monitor
This vehicle may have a Tyre
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS).
tyre pressures are getting low and
the tyres need to be inflated to the
proper pressure.
Driving for Better Fuel
Economy
The TPMS does not replace normal
monthly tyre maintenance. Maintain
the correct tyre pressures.
Driving habits can affect fuel
mileage. Here are some driving tips
to get the best fuel economy
possible.
See Tyre Pressure Monitor System
on page 10-43.
Engine Oil Life System
The low tyre pressure warning light
alerts to a significant loss in
pressure of one of the vehicle's
tyres. If the warning light comes on,
stop as soon as possible and inflate
the tyres to the recommended
pressure shown on the Tyre and
Loading Information label. See
Vehicle Load Limits on page 9-8.
The warning light will remain on until
the tyre pressure is corrected.
The low tyre pressure warning light
may come on in cool weather when
the vehicle is first started, and then
turn off as the vehicle is driven. This
may be an early indicator that the
The engine oil life system calculates
engine oil life based on vehicle use
and displays the CHANGE ENGINE
OIL SOON message when it is time
to change the engine oil and filter.
The oil life system should be reset
to 100% only following an oil
change.
See “Oil Life” under Driver
Information Centre (DIC) on
page 5-25 for information on the
engine oil life monitor.
.
Avoid fast starts and accelerate
smoothly.
.
Brake gradually and avoid
abrupt stops.
.
Avoid idling the engine for long
periods of time.
.
When road and weather
conditions are appropriate, use
cruise control.
.
Always follow posted speed
limits or drive more slowly when
conditions require.
.
Keep vehicle tyres properly
inflated.
.
Combine several trips into a
single trip.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (19,1)
In Brief
.
Replace the vehicle's tyres with
the same TPC Spec number
moulded into the tyre's sidewall
near the size.
.
Follow recommended scheduled
maintenance.
1-19
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
1-20
In Brief
2 NOTES
Black plate (20,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Keys, Doors, and
Windows
Keys and Locks
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System Operation . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . 2-10
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Doors
Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Vehicle Security
Vehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle Alarm System . . . . . . .
Anti-theft Locking System . . . .
Immobiliser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Immobiliser Operation . . . . . . .
2-15
2-15
2-17
2-17
2-18
Exterior Mirrors
Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic Dimming Mirror . . .
Reverse Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . .
2-19
2-19
2-19
2-20
2-20
2-20
Interior Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirrors . . . . . 2-21
Manual Rearview Mirror . . . . . . 2-21
Automatic Dimming Rearview
Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Windows
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
Roof
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
2-1
Keys and Locks
Keys
{ Warning
Leaving children in a vehicle with
a Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
transmitter is dangerous and
children or others could be
seriously injured or killed. They
could operate the power windows
or other controls or make the
vehicle move. The windows will
function with the RKE transmitter
in the vehicle, and children or
others could be caught in the path
of a closing window. Do not leave
children in a vehicle with an RKE
transmitter.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-2
Black plate (2,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
This key, located inside the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, is
used for the driver door and
glove box.
Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) System
See Declaration of Conformity on
page 13-1.
If there is a decrease in the RKE
operating range:
To remove the key, press the button
near the bottom of the transmitter,
and pull the key out. Never pull the
key out without pressing the button.
If it becomes difficult to turn the key,
inspect the key blade for debris.
See your dealer if a new key is
needed.
.
Check the distance. The
transmitter may be too far from
the vehicle.
.
Check the location. Other
vehicles or objects may be
blocking the signal.
.
Check the transmitter's battery.
See “Battery Replacement” later
in this section.
.
If the transmitter is still not
working correctly, see your
dealer or a qualified technician
for service.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) System Operation
see “Remote Lock, Unlock, Start”
under Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
RKE transmitter functions may work
up to 60 m (197 ft) away from the
vehicle.
When the doors are locked the fuel
door will also be locked.
Keep in mind that other conditions,
such as those previously stated, can
impact the performance of the
transmitter.
If the driver door is open when Q is
pressed, all doors lock except the
driver door, if enabled through the
vehicle personalisation. If the
passenger door is open when Q is
pressed, all doors lock.
Pressing Q may also arm the
theft-deterrent system. See Vehicle
Alarm System on page 2-15.
Pressing Q will also lock the
fuel door.
With Remote Start and Power
Tailgate Shown, Without Similar
Q (Lock):
Press to lock all doors.
The indicators may flash and/or the
horn may sound to indicate locking,
K (Unlock): Press to unlock the
driver door or all doors, see
“Remote Lock, Unlock, Start” under
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38. When remotely
unlocking the vehicle at night the
fog lamps and reverse lamps will
come on for about 20 seconds to
light your approach to the vehicle.
2-3
The indicators may flash to indicate
unlocking. See “Remote Lock,
Unlock, Start” under Vehicle
Personalisation on page 5-38.
Memory seat positions may be
recalled when unlocking the vehicle.
See “Auto Memory Recall” under
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38 for more information.
Pressing K will disarm the
theft-deterrent system. See Vehicle
Alarm System on page 2-15.
On some models, pressing and
holding K will open all of the
windows.
Pressing K will also unlock the
fuel door.
/ (Remote Start):
For vehicles
with this feature, press and release
Q and then immediately press and
hold / for at least four seconds to
start the engine from outside the
vehicle using the RKE transmitter.
See Remote Vehicle Start on
page 2-7 for additional information.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-4
Black plate (4,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
L (Vehicle Locator/Panic
Alarm): Press and release one
time to initiate vehicle locator. The
exterior lamps flash and the horn
chirps three times. Press and hold
L for three seconds to sound the
panic alarm. The horn sounds and
the indicators flash for 30 seconds,
or until L is pressed again or the
vehicle is started.
h (Remote Tailgate
Release): Press and hold to open
or close the power tailgate.
Keyless Access Operation
With the Keyless Access system,
you can lock and unlock the doors
and access the hatch without
removing the RKE transmitter from
your pocket, purse, briefcase, etc.
The RKE transmitter should be
within 1 m (3 ft) of the door or hatch
being opened.
The Keyless Access can be
programmed to unlock all doors on
the first lock/unlock press from the
driver door. See Vehicle
Personalisation on page 5-38.
Keyless Unlocking/Locking from
the Driver Door
When the doors are locked and the
RKE transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft)
of the driver door handle, pressing
the lock/unlock button on the driver
door handle will unlock the driver
door. If the lock/unlock button is
pressed again within five seconds,
all passenger doors will unlock.
Passenger Shown, Driver Similar
Pressing the lock/unlock button will
cause all doors to lock if any of the
following occur:
.
It has been more than
five seconds since the first lock/
unlock button press.
.
Two lock/unlock button presses
were used to unlock all doors.
.
Any vehicle door has opened
and all doors are now closed.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
2-5
Keyless Unlocking/Locking from
Passenger Doors
Temporary Disable Passive
Locking Feature
Programming Transmitters to
the Vehicle
When the doors are locked and the
RKE transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft)
of the door handle, pressing the
lock/unlock button on that door
handle will unlock all doors.
Pressing the lock/unlock button will
cause all doors to lock if any of the
following occur:
Temporarily disable the passive
locking by pressing and holding K
on the interior door switch with a
door open for at least four seconds,
or until three chimes are heard.
Passive locking will then remain
disabled until Q on the interior door
is pressed, or until the vehicle is
switched on.
Only RKE transmitters programmed
to the vehicle will work. If a
transmitter is lost or stolen, a
replacement can be purchased and
programmed through your dealer.
When the replacement transmitter is
programmed to this vehicle, all
remaining transmitters must also be
reprogrammed. Any lost or stolen
transmitters will no longer work
once the new transmitter is
programmed. Each vehicle can
have up to eight transmitters
programmed to it. See your dealer
to program transmitters to this
vehicle.
.
The lock/unlock button was used
to unlock all doors.
.
Any vehicle door has opened
and all doors are now closed.
Passive Locking
If equipped with Keyless Access,
this feature will lock the vehicle
several seconds after all doors are
closed, if the vehicle is off and at
least one RKE transmitter has been
removed from the interior or none
remain in the interior. The fuel door
will also lock at this time.
To customise the doors to
automatically lock when exiting the
vehicle, see “Remote Lock, Unlock,
Start” under Vehicle Personalisation
on page 5-38.
Keyless Tailgate Opening
Press the touch pad on the tailgate
handle to open the tailgate if the
keyless entry transmitter is within
1 m (3 ft).
Starting the Vehicle with a Low
Transmitter Battery
When trying to start the vehicle,
if the transmitter battery is weak, the
DIC may display NO REMOTE
DETECTED or NO REMOTE KEY
WAS DETECTED. PLACE KEY IN
TRANSMITTER POCKET. THEN
START YOUR VEHICLE. The
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-6
Black plate (6,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTE
KEY message may also be
displayed at this time.
To start the vehicle:
1. Open the centre console storage
area and the storage tray.
3. With the vehicle in P (Park) or
N (Neutral), press the brake
pedal and the ENGINE START/
STOP button.
Replace the transmitter battery
as soon as possible.
Replace the battery if the REPLACE
BATTERY IN REMOTE KEY
message displays in the DIC.
1. Press the button near the bottom
of the transmitter and pull the
key out.
Battery Replacement
{ Warning
Make sure that you dispose of old
batteries in accordance with
environmental protection
regulations to help protect the
environment and your health.
{ Caution
2. Place the transmitter in the
transmitter pocket.
When replacing the battery, do
not touch any of the circuitry on
the transmitter. Static from your
body could damage the
transmitter.
2. Use the oval base of the key
blade to separate the two halves
of the transmitter.
3. Remove the old battery. Do not
use a metal object.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
4. Insert the new battery on the
back housing, positive side
facing down. Replace with a
CR2032 or equivalent battery.
If the vehicle has heated seats, they
may come on during a remote start.
See Heated and Ventilated Front
Seats on page 3-8
5. Align the key release button and
snap the transmitter back
together.
Laws in some local communities
may restrict the use of remote
starters. For example, some laws
may require a person using remote
start to have the vehicle in view.
Check local regulations for any
requirements.
Remote Vehicle Start
If available, this feature allows the
engine to be started from outside of
the vehicle.
/ (Remote Vehicle Start):
This
button will be on the RKE
transmitter if the vehicle has remote
start.
The climate control system will use
the previous settings during a
remote start. The rear demist may
come on during remote start based
on cold ambient conditions. The
rear fog indicator light does not
come on during remote start.
Other conditions can affect the
performance of the transmitter. See
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System on page 2-2 for additional
information.
Starting the Engine Using Remote
Start
1. Press and release
RKE transmitter.
Q on the
2-7
2. Immediately press and hold /
for at least four seconds or until
the indicator lamps flash. The
indicators flashing confirms the
request to remote start the
vehicle has been received.
During the remote start the
doors will be locked and the
parking lamps will remain on as
long as the engine is running.
The engine will shut off after
10 minutes unless a time
extension is done or the ignition
is put in ON/RUN/START.
3. Press the brake pedal and select
the ON/RUN/START ignition
mode to drive the vehicle.
Extending Engine Run Time
The engine run time can also be
extended by another 10-minutes,
if during the first 10 minutes
Steps 1–2 are repeated while the
engine is still running. This provides
a total of 20 minutes.
The remote start can only be
extended once.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-8
Black plate (8,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
When the remote start is extended,
the second 10-minute period is
added on to the first 10 minutes for
a total of 20 minutes.
A maximum of two remote starts,
or a remote start with an extension,
are allowed between ignition cycles.
Conditions in Which Remote Start
Will Not Work
The transmitter is in the vehicle.
.
The bonnet is not closed.
The vehicle's ignition must be
changed to ON/RUN/START and
then back to OFF before the remote
start procedure can be used again.
.
The hazard warning flashers
are on.
.
There is an emission control
system malfunction.
Shutting the Engine Off After a
Remote Start
.
The engine coolant temperature
is too high.
To cancel a remote start, do any of
the following:
.
The oil pressure is low.
.
Two remote vehicle starts or a
start with an extension have
already been used.
.
The vehicle is not in P (Park).
Press and hold / until the
parking lamps turn off.
.
Turn on the hazard warning
lights.
.
Turn the vehicle on and then off.
{ Warning
The remote start will not operate if
any of the following occur:
.
.
Door Locks
Unlocked doors can be
dangerous.
.
Passengers, especially
children, can easily open the
doors and fall out of a moving
vehicle. The chance of being
thrown out of the vehicle in a
crash is increased if the
doors are not locked. So, all
passengers should wear
safety belts properly and the
doors should be locked
whenever the vehicle is
driven.
.
Young children who get into
unlocked vehicles may be
unable to get out. A child can
be overcome by extreme heat
and can suffer permanent
injuries or even death from
heat stroke. Always lock the
vehicle whenever leaving it.
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Warning (Continued)
.
Outsiders can easily enter
through an unlocked door
when slowing or stopping the
vehicle. Lock the doors to
help prevent this from
happening.
Keyless Access
will lock/unlock the doors. If the
lock/unlock button is pressed again
within five seconds, all passenger
doors will unlock. See Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation on page 2-3.
2-9
Power Door Locks
Key
To lock or unlock the door, use the
key in the driver door. Turn the key
anticlockwise once to unlock the
driver door; turning the key again
will unlock the passenger doors.
Inside the Vehicle
To unlock a door from the inside,
pull once on the door handle to
unlock it, and a second time to
open it.
Q (Lock): Press to lock the doors.
K (Unlock): Press to unlock the
doors.
Delayed Locking
When the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft)
of the driver door, pressing the lock/
unlock button on that door handle
This feature delays the locking of
the doors until five seconds after all
doors are closed.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-10
Black plate (10,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
When Q is pressed on the power
door lock switch while the door is
open, a chime will sound three
times indicating delayed locking is
active.
The doors will lock automatically
five seconds after all doors are
closed. If a door is reopened before
that time, the five-second timer will
reset when all doors are closed
again.
Press Q on the door lock switch or
press Q on the RKE transmitter to
lock doors immediately.
This feature can also be
programmed. See Vehicle
Personalisation on page 5-38.
Automatic Door Locks
The doors will lock automatically
when all doors are closed, the
ignition is on, and the shift lever is
moved out of P (Park). The doors
will automatically unlock when the
vehicle is stopped and the shift
lever is moved into P (Park).
Use the manual or power door locks
to unlock the doors if someone
needs to exit and to lock the doors
again.
The power door locks can be
programmed through the Driver
Information Centre (DIC). See
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
START. See “Power Door Locks” in
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Safety Locks
The rear door safety locks prevent
passengers from opening the rear
doors from inside the vehicle.
Lockout Protection
Lockout protection decreases the
chances that the keys may be
accidentally locked in the vehicle.
When door locking is requested by
pressing Q on the front door panels
or the RKE transmitter and the
driver door is open, all doors will
lock and the driver door will
immediately unlock. The driver door
must be closed when Q is pressed
for all doors to remain locked.
This feature can be programmed to
provide the lockout protection
feature only when the ignition mode
is ACC/ACCESSORY, or ON/RUN/
Press Z { to activate the safety
locks. The indicator light comes on
when activated.
The rear door power windows are
also disabled. See Power Windows
on page 2-21.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Press Z { again to deactivate the
safety locks and power windows.
Doors
If a rear door handle is being pulled
when the safety lock is deactivated,
that door will remain locked and the
indicator light may flash. Release
the handle, then press the safety
lock twice to deactivate the safety
locks.
Tailgate
2-11
Warning (Continued)
.
Adjust the climate control
system to a setting that
brings in only outside air and
set the fan speed to the
highest setting. See “Climate
Control Systems” in the
Index.
.
If the vehicle is equipped with
a power tailgate, disable the
power tailgate function.
{ Warning
Exhaust gases can enter the
vehicle if it is driven with the
tailgate or boot/hatch open,
or with any objects that pass
through the seal between the
body and the boot/hatch or
tailgate. Engine exhaust contains
carbon monoxide (CO) which
cannot be seen or smelled. It can
cause unconsciousness and even
death.
If the vehicle must be driven with
the tailgate or boot/hatch open:
.
Close all of the windows.
.
Fully open the air outlets on
or under the instrument
panel.
(Continued)
See Engine Exhaust on
page 9-20.
{ Caution
To avoid damage to the tailgate or
tailgate glass, make sure the area
above and behind the tailgate is
clear before opening it.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-12
Black plate (12,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Manual Tailgate
Power Liftgate
For vehicles without Keyless
Access, unlock the vehicle before
opening the tailgate.
{ Warning
You, or others, could be injured if
caught in the path of the power
tailgate. Make sure there is no
one in the way of the tailgate as it
is opening and closing.
Press the touch pad in the handle of
the tailgate, above the license plate,
and lift up to open.
Do not press the touch pad while
closing the tailgate. This will cause
the tailgate to be unlatched.
Choose the power tailgate mode by
turning the dial on the switch until
the indicator lines up with the
desired position. Press the centre of
the switch.
Always close the tailgate before
driving.
On vehicles with a power tailgate,
the switch is on the driver door. The
vehicle must be in P (Park) to use
the power feature. The tail lamps
flash when the power tailgate
moves.
The three modes are:
MAX: The tailgate opens to the full
open height.
3/4: The tailgate opens to a
reduced height that can be set by
the vehicle operator in a range of
approximately three-quarters open
to full open. Use this setting to
prevent the tailgate from opening
into overhead obstructions such as
a garage door or roof mounted
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (13,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
cargo during power operation. The
tailgate can still be manually opened
all the way.
OFF: The tailgate only operates
manually in this position.
.
Pressing the touch pad button
on the tailgate outside handle,
with all doors unlocked, to open
the tailgate.
The power liftgate may be
temporarily disabled under extreme
temperatures or low battery
conditions. If this occurs, the tailgate
can still be operated manually.
In either the MAX or the 3/4 mode,
the tailgate can be power opened
and closed by:
.
Pressing h on the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
until the tailgate starts moving.
See Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) System Operation on
page 2-3.
Pressing 8 on the centre of
the mode switch on the driver
door, with the driver door
unlocked.
must already be open for the
system to hold it open. If movement
is stopped below that minimum, the
tailgate closes.
Do not force the tailgate open or
closed during a power cycle.
Manual operation of a tailgate that
also has power operation requires
more effort than with a standard
manual tailgate.
.
2-13
Press and release 8 on the
tailgate next to the latch to close the
tailgate.
Pressing any tailgate button, or the
touch pad button while the tailgate
is moving, stops it. Pressing the
button or pressing and holding the
RKE switch again reverses the
direction. There is a minimum
distance that the power tailgate
If you shift the transmission out of
P (Park) while the power function is
in progress, the tailgate power
function will continue to completion.
If you shift the transmission out of
P (Park) and accelerate before the
power tailgate latch is closed, the
tailgate may reverse to the open
position. Cargo could fall out of the
vehicle. Always make sure the
power tailgate is closed and latched
before you drive away.
If you power open the tailgate and
the tailgate support struts have lost
pressure, the indicators flash and a
chime sounds. The tailgate stays
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/15/13
2-14
Black plate (14,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
open temporarily, then slowly
closes. See your dealer for service
before using the tailgate.
open fully. The tailgate will remain
open until it is activated again or
closed manually.
Obstacle Detection Features
Setting the Power Tailgate
3/4 Mode
If the tailgate encounters an
obstacle during a power open or
close cycle, a warning chime will
sound and the tailgate will
automatically reverse direction to
the full closed or open position.
After removing the obstruction, the
power tailgate operation can be
used again. If the tailgate
encounters multiple obstacles on
the same power cycle, the power
function will deactivate. After
removing the obstructions, the
tailgate will resume normal power
operation.
The vehicle has pinch sensors
located on the side edges of the
tailgate. If an object is caught
between the tailgate and the body
and presses against this sensor, the
tailgate will reverse direction and
To change the tailgate stop position:
1. Turn the tailgate switch to the
MAX or 3/4 mode position and
power open the tailgate.
2. Stop the tailgate movement at
the desired height by pressing
any tailgate switch. Manually
adjust the tailgate position if
required.
3. Press and hold the button on the
tailgate next to the latch until the
indicators flash and a beep
sounds to indicate that the new
setting is recorded.
When power opened with the 3/
4 mode selected, the tailgate stops
at the new set position.
If you do not receive the audible and
visual feedback when setting the
intermediate stop position, you are
attempting to set the height below
the 3/4 open height minimum
(approximately 1.52 m or 5 ft). The
tailgate cannot be set below that
minimum and the new setting will
not be recorded.
Manual Operation of Power
Tailgate
To change the tailgate to manual
operation, turn the mode switch to
the OFF position.
With the power tailgate disabled and
all of the doors unlocked, the
tailgate can be manually opened
and closed. The effort required to
operate a power tailgate is greater
than the effort required to operate a
non-power tailgate.
To open the tailgate, press the touch
pad on the handle on the outside of
the tailgate, and lift the gate open.
To close the tailgate, use the pull
cup to lower the tailgate and close.
With the power tailgate disabled, the
tailgate electric latch will still power
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (15,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
latch once contact is made with the
striker. Always close the tailgate
before driving.
If the RKE button is pressed while
power operation is disabled, the
indicators flash and the tailgate will
not move.
The tailgate has an electric latch.
If the battery is disconnected or has
low voltage, the tailgate will not
open. The tailgate will resume
operation when the battery is
reconnected and charged.
Vehicle Security
This vehicle has theft-deterrent
features; however, they do not make
the vehicle impossible to steal.
2-15
Fast Flash: Vehicle is unsecured.
A door, the hood, or the tailgate
is open.
Slow Flash: Alarm system is
armed.
Vehicle Alarm System
Arming the Alarm System
This vehicle has an anti-theft alarm
system.
1. Close the tailgate and the hood.
Turn off the vehicle.
2. Lock the vehicle in one of
three ways:
The indicator light, on the
instrument panel near the
windscreen, indicates the status of
the system.
Off: Alarm system is Disarmed.
On Solid: Vehicle is secured
during the delay to arm the system.
.
Use the RKE transmitter.
.
Use the Keyless Access
system.
.
With a door open, press Q
on the interior of the door.
3. After 30 seconds the alarm
system will arm, and the
indicator light will begin to slowly
flash indicating the alarm system
is operating. Pressing Q on the
RKE transmitter a second time
will bypass the 30-second delay
and immediately arm the alarm
system.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-16
Black plate (16,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
The vehicle alarm system will not
arm if the doors are locked with
the key.
.
Unlock the vehicle using the
Keyless Access system.
Power Sounder Inclination
Sensor, and Intrusion Sensor
.
Start the vehicle.
If the driver door is opened without
first unlocking with the RKE
transmitter, the horn will chirp and
the lights will flash to indicate
pre-alarm. If the vehicle is not
started, or the door is not unlocked
by pressing K on the RKE
transmitter during the 10-second
pre-alarm, the alarm will be
activated.
To avoid setting off the alarm by
accident:
In addition to the standard
theft-deterrent system features, this
system also has an inclination
sensor and intrusion sensor.
The alarm will also be activated if a
passenger door, the tailgate, or the
hood is opened without first
disarming the system. When the
alarm is activated, the indicators
flash and the horn sounds for about
30 seconds. The alarm system will
then re-arm to monitor for the next
unauthorised event.
Disarming the Alarm System
To disarm the alarm system or turn
off the alarm if it has been activated:
.
Press
K on the RKE transmitter.
.
.
Lock the vehicle after all
occupants have left the vehicle
and all doors are closed.
Always unlock a door with the
RKE transmitter or use the
Keyless Access system.
Unlocking the driver door with the
key will not disarm the system or
turn off the alarm.
How to Detect a Tamper
Condition
If K is pressed and the horn chirps
three times, the alarm was activated
while the alarm system was armed.
If the alarm system has been
activated, a message will appear on
the DIC. See Security Messages on
page 5-36.
The power sounder provides an
audible alarm which is different from
the vehicle's horn. It has its own
power source, and can sound an
alarm when the vehicle's battery is
compromised.
The inclination sensor can set off
the alarm if it senses movement of
the vehicle, such as a change in
vehicle orientation.
The intrusion sensor monitors the
vehicle interior, and can set off the
alarm it if senses an unauthorised
entry into the vehicle's interior. Do
not allow passengers or pets to
remain in the vehicle when the
intrusion sensor is activated.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (17,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Before arming the theft-deterrent
system and activating the intrusion
sensor:
.
Make sure all doors and
windows are completely closed.
.
Secure any loose items such as
a sunvisors.
.
Make sure there are no
obstructions blocking the
sensors in the front overhead
console.
Inclination, and Intrusion
Sensors Disable Switch
It is recommended that the
inclination and intrusion sensors be
deactivated if pets are left in the
vehicle or the vehicle is being
transported.
With the vehicle turned off, press
o in the overhead console. The
indicator light will come on
momentarily, indicating that the
sensor has been disabled for the
next alarm system arming cycle.
Anti-theft Locking System
The vehicle is equipped with a
deadbolt locking feature in addition
to the standard door locks.
If the vehicle has the keyless
access system, the deadbolt is
engaged whenever you press Q on
the keyless access transmitter twice
within five seconds.
If the vehicle does not have keyless
access, use either the removable
key or the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter to lock or unlock
the doors and operate the deadbolt.
.
.
Hold the removable key in the
lock position for a few seconds
or quickly turn the key twice in
the lock cylinder to secure the
doors with the deadbolt.
Press Q on the RKE transmitter
once to lock all the doors.
Pressing the button again within
three seconds will secure the
deadbolt.
2-17
When the doors are secured with
the deadbolt, the manual door lock
controls will not unlock the doors.
Also, if the theft-deterrent system is
armed, the doors cannot be
unlocked using the power door lock
controls.
Press K on the transmitter once to
open the deadbolt and unlock the
driver door. Pressing the button
again within three seconds will
unlock all the doors.
If the vehicle does not have keyless
access, unlocking the driver door
from the outside with the removable
key disengages the deadbolt for all
doors. However, only the driver door
will be unlocked.
You must unlock the passenger
doors manually or with the power
door locks.
Immobiliser
See Declaration of Conformity on
page 13-1.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-18
Black plate (18,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Immobiliser Operation
This vehicle has a passive
theft-deterrent system.
The system does not have to be
manually armed or disarmed.
The vehicle is automatically
immobilised when the vehicle is
turned off.
The immobilisation system is
disarmed when the pushbutton start
is activated to enter the ACC/
ACCESSORY mode or the ON/
RUN/START mode and a valid
transmitter is present in the vehicle.
The security light, in the instrument
cluster, comes on if there is a
problem with arming or disarming
the theft-deterrent system.
The system has one or more RKE
transmitters matched to an
immobiliser control unit in your
vehicle. Only a correctly matched
RKE transmitter will start the
vehicle. If the transmitter is ever
damaged, you may not be able to
start your vehicle.
When trying to start the vehicle, the
security light comes on briefly when
the ignition is turned on.
If the engine does not start and the
security light stays on, there is a
problem with the system. Turn the
ignition off and try again.
If the vehicle will not change ignition
modes (ACC/ACCESSORY, ON/
RUN/START, OFF), and the RKE
transmitter appears to be
undamaged, try another transmitter.
Or, you may try placing the
transmitter in the transmitter pocket
located in the centre console. See
“NO REMOTE DETECTED” under
Key and Lock Messages on
page 5-32.
If the ignition modes will not change
with the other transmitter, your
vehicle needs service. If the ignition
does change modes, the first
transmitter may be faulty. See your
dealer who can service the
theft-deterrent system and have a
new RKE transmitter programmed to
the vehicle.
It is possible for the immobiliser
system to learn new or replacement
RKE transmitters. Up to eight
transmitters can be programmed for
the vehicle. To program additional
transmitters, see “Programming
Transmitters to the Vehicle” under
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System Operation on page 2-3.
Do not leave the key or device that
disarms or deactivates the
theft-deterrent system in the vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (19,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Exterior Mirrors
Power Mirrors
{ Warning
The passenger side mirror is convex
shaped. A convex mirror's surface is
curved so more can be seen from
the driver seat.
Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)
The vehicle may have side blind
zone alert. See Side Blind Zone
Alert (SBZA) on page 9-50.
Convex Mirrors
A convex mirror can make things,
like other vehicles, look farther
away than they really are. If you
cut too sharply into the right lane,
you could hit a vehicle on the
right. Check the inside mirror or
glance over your shoulder before
changing lanes.
2-19
Folding Mirrors
Manual Folding Mirrors
Manual Folding Mirrors Shown,
Power Folding Similar
To adjust the mirror:
1. Move the selector switch to L
(Left) or R (Right) to choose the
driver or passenger mirror.
2. Press the arrows on the control
pad to move each mirror in the
desired direction.
3. Return the selector switch to the
centre position.
If equipped, manually fold the
mirrors inward toward the vehicle to
prevent damage when going
through an automatic car wash.
Push the mirror outward to return it
to the original position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-20
Black plate (20,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Power Folding Mirrors
Resetting the Power Folding
Mirrors
Automatic Dimming
Mirror
Reset the power folding mirrors if:
If the vehicle has the automatic
dimming mirror, the driver outside
mirror automatically adjusts for the
glare of headlamps behind you.
.
The mirrors are accidentally
obstructed while folding.
.
They are accidentally manually
folded/unfolded.
.
The mirrors do not stay in the
unfolded position.
.
If equipped, to fold the mirrors:
1. With the selector switch in the )
position, press the down arrow
on the control pad. Both mirrors
will automatically fold.
2. Pressing the down arrow again
will return the mirrors to their
original position.
The mirrors vibrate at normal
driving speeds.
Fold and unfold the mirrors one time
using the mirror controls to reset
them to their normal position.
A noise may be heard during the
resetting of the power folding
mirrors. This sound is normal after a
manual folding operation.
Heated Mirrors
1 (Rear Window Demister):
Press to heat the mirrors.
See “Rear Window Demister” under
Dual Automatic Climate Control
System on page 8-1.
Reverse Tilt Mirrors
If the vehicle is equipped with
memory mirrors, there is an option
to have the mirrors tilt down, when
in R (Reverse), to more easily see
the ground near the vehicle.
When the vehicle is shifted to
R (Reverse), both the driver and
passenger mirrors will tilt downward.
They will return to their previous
position when the vehicle is shifted
out of R (Reverse), the ignition is
turned to OFF, or the vehicle is left
in R (Reverse) for an extended
period of time.
This feature can be turned on or off.
See Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (21,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Interior Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirrors
Adjust the rearview mirror for a clear
view of the area behind your
vehicle.
Do not spray glass cleaner directly
on the mirror. Use a soft towel
dampened with water.
Manual Rearview Mirror
Push the tab forward for daytime
use and pull it rearward for
nighttime use to avoid glare of the
headlamps from behind.
Automatic Dimming
Rearview Mirror
If equipped, automatic dimming
reduces the glare of headlamps
from behind. The dimming feature
comes on when the vehicle is
started.
Windows
{ Warning
Never leave a child, a helpless
adult, or a pet alone in a vehicle,
especially with the windows
closed in warm or hot weather.
They can be overcome by the
extreme heat and suffer
permanent injuries or even death
from heat stroke.
2-21
The vehicle aerodynamics are
designed to improve fuel economy
performance. This may result in a
pulsing sound when either rear
window is down and the front
windows are up. To reduce the
sound, open either a front window
or the sunroof, if equipped.
Power Windows
{ Warning
Children could be seriously
injured or killed if caught in the
path of a closing window. Never
leave the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter in a vehicle with
children. When there are children
in the rear seat, use the window
lockout switch to prevent
operation of the windows. See
Keys on page 2-1.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-22
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Express-Down/Up Windows
The power windows:
.
.
.
Black plate (22,1)
Windows that have the
express-down/up feature allow the
windows to be lowered and raised
fully without holding the window
switch. Press the window switch
fully and release it to activate the
express-down feature. Pull the
window switch fully up and release it
to activate the express-up feature.
The express mode can be cancelled
at any time by briefly pressing or
pulling the switch.
Obstacle Detection Feature
The Obstacle Detection Feature is
part of the express-up feature and is
active:
In the middle and upper portions
of the window opening.
.
During window up movements.
Programming the power windows
may be necessary if the vehicle's
battery has been disconnected or
discharged.
.
In ignition OFF during all window
up movements and during
express-up window movements
in ignition ON/RUN/START.
If the window will not express up
after power has been restored and a
message is displayed in the Driver
Information Centre:
If there is something blocking the
window during automatic closing,
the window will reverse direction for
a short distance. Weather conditions
such as extreme cold and/or ice
may cause the window to
Programming the Power
Windows
Can be operated within
10 minutes of switching the
ignition off. See Retained
Accessory Power (RAP) on
page 9-18.
Press or pull the switch part of the
way to open or close the window.
3. From any partial open position,
close the window and continue
to pull the switch briefly after the
window has fully closed.
.
Can be operated with the
ignition in ACC/ACCESSORY or
ON/RUN/START.
Will stop operation when any
door is opened.
2. Place the ignition in ACC/
ACCESSORY or ON/RUN/
START.
1. Close all doors.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (23,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
auto-reverse. The window will return
to normal operation once the object
or condition is removed.
If conditions prevent the window
from closing and the window
continues to auto-reverse, it is
possible to close the window with
the ignition in ON/RUN/START by
holding the window switch in the
partially or fully pulled up position.
Release of the switch from the
partially pulled up position will cause
the window to stop. Release of the
switch from the fully pulled up
position will activate the express-up
and related obstacle detection
features.
Remote Window Operation
If equipped, the remote operating
windows will open all the windows
from outside the vehicle by pressing
and holding K on the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
Window Lockout
Press Z { to activate the rear
window lockout, the indicator light in
the switch illuminates.
The rear door safety locks are also
enabled. See Safety Locks on
page 2-10.
Press Z { again to deactivate the
rear window lockout.
If an inside rear door handle is
being pulled at the same time a
safety lock is deactivated, only that
door will remain locked and the
indicator light may flash. Release
the handle, then press the safety
lock twice to deactivate the safety
locks.
Overload
If the windows are repeatedly
operated within a short time, the
window operation is disabled for a
short time.
2-23
This feature prevents the rear
passenger windows from operating,
except from the driver position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-24
Black plate (24,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Sun Visors
Roof
Sunroof
On vehicles with a sunroof, the
switches are on the overhead
console.
Pull the sun visor down to block
glare. If equipped, detach the sun
visor from the centre mount to pivot
to the side window or to extend
along the rod.
The sunroof only operates when the
ignition is in ON/RUN/START or
ACC/ACCESSORY, or in Retained
Accessory Power (RAP). See
Ignition Positions on page 9-14 and
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)
on page 9-18.
1. Sunroof Switch
2. Sunshade Switch
Sunroof Switch
Vent: To vent the sunroof, press
the rear of the sunroof switch (1) to
the first detent and release, the
sunroof will open to the vent
position.
Open/Close: To open or close the
sunroof, press the front or rear of
the sunroof switch (1) to the first
detent and hold, to open or close
the sunroof to a desired position.
Comfort Stop: The sunroof has a
comfort stop feature that stops the
sunroof from opening to the
full-open position. Press the rear of
the sunroof switch (1) to the second
detent and release to open the
sunroof to the comfort open
position. Press and release the rear
of the sunroof switch (1) again to
fully open the sunroof. Press the
front of the sunroof switch (1) to the
second detent and release, to
express close the sunroof.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (25,1)
Keys, Doors, and Windows
Sunshade Switch
Open/Close: To open or close the
sunshade, press the front or back of
the sunshade switch (2) to the first
detent and hold, to open or close
the sunshade to a desired position.
Express Open/Express Close: To
express open or close the
sunshade, press the sunshade
switch (2) to the second detent and
release.
Fully close the sunroof before fully
closing the sunshade.
Anti-Pinch Feature
If an object is in the path of the
sunroof when it is closing, the
anti-pinch feature detects the object
and stops the sunroof from closing
at the point of the obstruction. The
sunroof then returns to the full-open
position.
Dirt and debris may collect on the
sunroof seal or in the track. This
could cause an issue with sunroof
operation or noise. It could also plug
the water drainage system.
Periodically open the sunroof and
remove any obstacles or loose
debris. Wipe the sunroof seal and
roof sealing area using a clean
cloth, mild soap, and water. Do not
remove grease from the sunroof.
2-25
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
2-26
Keys, Doors, and Windows
2 NOTES
Black plate (26,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Seats and Restraints
Seats and
Restraints
Head Restraints
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Front Seats
Power Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . 3-3
Lumbar Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Thigh Support Adjustment . . . . 3-4
Reclining Seat Backrests . . . . . 3-5
Memory Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Heated and Ventilated Front
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Rear Seats
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Heated Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
Rear Seat
Pass-Through Door . . . . . . . . . 3-11
Safety Belts
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
How to Wear Safety Belts
Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14
Safety Belt Use During
Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Safety Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Safety System Check . . . . . . . . 3-17
Safety Belt Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18
Replacing Safety Belt System
Parts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . 3-18
Airbag System
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . .
When Should an Airbag
Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
What Makes an Airbag
Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How Does an Airbag
Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-19
3-20
3-22
3-23
3-23
3-1
What Will You See after an
Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23
Airbag On-Off Switch . . . . . . . . 3-25
Servicing the Airbag-Equipped
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
Adding Equipment to the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . 3-27
Airbag System Check . . . . . . . . 3-28
Replacing Airbag System
Parts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . 3-28
Child Restraints
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Infants and Young
Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Child Restraint Systems . . . . .
Where to Put the Restraint . . .
ISOFIX Child Restraint
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Securing Child Restraints
(Rear Seat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Securing Child Restraints
(Front Passenger Seat) . . . .
3-29
3-31
3-33
3-34
3-40
3-41
3-42
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-2
Black plate (2,1)
Seats and Restraints
Head Restraints
{ Warning
With head restraints that are not
installed and adjusted properly,
there is a greater chance that
occupants will suffer a neck/
spinal injury in a crash. Do not
drive until the head restraints for
all occupants are installed and
adjusted properly.
Adjust the head restraint so that the
top of the restraint is at the same
height as the top of the occupant's
head. This position reduces the
chance of a neck injury in a crash.
head restraint down, and release
the button. Pull and push on the
head restraint after the button is
released to make sure that it is
locked in place.
Front Seats
The front seat outboard head
restraints are not designed to be
removed.
The vehicle's front seats have
adjustable head restraints in the
outboard seating positions.
Rear Seats
The vehicle's rear seats have
adjustable head restraints in the
outboard seating positions.
The height of the head restraint can
be adjusted. To raise or lower the
head restraint, press the button
located on the side of the head
restraint, and pull up or push the
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Seats and Restraints
The height of the head restraint can
be adjusted. Pull the head restraint
up to raise it. Try to move the head
restraint to make sure that it is
locked in place.
The vehicle's rear seat has an
adjustable headrest in the centre
seating position that can be
adjusted the same way as the
outboard head restraints.
To lower the head restraint, press
the button, located on the top of the
seat backrest, and push the head
restraint down. Try to move the
head restraint after the button is
released to make sure that it is
locked in place.
The rear seat head restraints and
headrest are not designed to be
removed.
3-3
Front Seats
Power Seat Adjustment
{ Warning
You can lose control of the
vehicle if you try to adjust a driver
seat while the vehicle is moving.
Adjust the driver seat only when
the vehicle is not moving.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-4
Black plate (4,1)
Seats and Restraints
To adjust a power seat:
.
Move the seat forward or
rearward by sliding the control
forward or rearward.
.
Raise or lower the front part of
the seat cushion by moving the
front of the control up or down.
.
Raise or lower the entire seat by
moving the rear of the control up
or down.
Lumbar Adjustment
Power Lumbar
Thigh Support
Adjustment
Press and hold the front or rear of
the control to increase or decrease
lumbar support. Release the control
when the seatback reaches the
desired level of lumbar support.
Adjust the manual leg extension by
pulling up on the lever, and then
pulling or pushing on the support to
lengthen or shorten it. Release the
lever to lock it in place.
To adjust the seatback, see
Reclining Seatbacks on page 3-5.
To adjust the lumbar support, see
Lumbar Adjustment on page 3-4.
Some vehicles are equipped with a
feature that activates a vibration in
the driver seat to help the driver
avoid crashes. See Driver
Assistance Systems on page 9-42.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Seats and Restraints
Reclining Seat Backrests
Power Reclining Seatbacks
{ Warning
Sitting in a reclined position when
the vehicle is in motion can be
dangerous. Even when buckled
up, the safety belts cannot do
their job.
The shoulder belt will not be
against your body. Instead, it will
be in front of you. In a crash, you
could go into it, receiving neck or
other injuries.
To adjust the seatback:
.
Tilt the top of the control
rearward to recline.
.
Tilt the top of the control forward
to raise.
3-5
The lap belt could go up over
your abdomen. The belt forces
would be there, not at your pelvic
bones. This could cause serious
internal injuries.
For proper protection when the
vehicle is in motion, have the
seatback upright. Then sit well
back in the seat and wear the
safety belt properly.
Do not have a backrest reclined if
the vehicle is moving.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-6
Black plate (6,1)
Seats and Restraints
Memory Seats
Storing Memory Positions
To save positions to the “1” and “2”
buttons:
1. Adjust the driver seat, seatback
recliner, both outside mirrors,
and adjustable pedals to the
desired driving positions.
2. Press and hold MEM (Memory)
and “1” at the same time until a
beep sounds.
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 for a
second driver using “2.”
If equipped, the “1”, “2,” and MEM
buttons on the outboard side of the
driver seat are used to manually
save and recall the positions of the
driver seat, outside mirrors, and
adjustable throttle and brake pedal
positions.
Manually Recalling Memory
Positions
If the vehicle is off, or in ON/RUN/
START but not in P (Park), press
and hold "1" or "2" to manually
recall the previously stored memory
positions. Releasing "1” or "2"
before the stored positions are
reached stops the recall.
If the vehicle is in ON/RUN/START
and in P (Park), press and release
“1” or “2” to manually recall the
previously stored memory positions.
Placing the ignition in OFF before
the stored positions are reached
stops the recall.
If something has blocked the driver
seat and/or the adjustable pedals
while recalling a memory position,
the recall may stop. Remove the
obstruction; then press and hold the
appropriate manual control for the
memory item that is not recalling for
two seconds. Try recalling the
memory position again by pressing
the appropriate memory button.
If the memory position is still not
recalling, see your dealer for
service.
Automatically Recalling Memory
Positions (Auto Memory Recall)
The Auto (Automatic) Memory
Recall feature automatically recalls
the current driver's previously stored
“1” or “2” position when entering the
vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Seats and Restraints
When the Auto Memory Recall
feature is enabled in the vehicle
personalisation menu, memory “1”
or “2” positions are recalled in the
following ways:
To activate the recall when On Driver Door Open is selected in the
vehicle personalisation menu:
.
.
.
On vehicles with RKE, press K
on the RKE transmitter and open
the door.
On vehicles with keyless access,
press the lock/unlock button on
the outside driver door handle
and open the driver door. The
RKE transmitter must be present
for the recall to activate.
If the driver door is already
open, press K on the RKE
transmitter to activate the recall.
To activate the recall when On - At
Ignition On is selected in the vehicle
personalisation menu:
.
Place the ignition in ON/RUN/
START.
See Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
To stop recall movement, press one
of the memory, power mirror,
or power seat controls; or press the
adjustable pedal switch. If On - At
Ignition On is selected in the vehicle
personalisation menu, placing the
ignition in OFF also stops the recall.
If something has blocked the driver
seat and/or the adjustable pedals
while recalling a memory position,
the recall may stop. Remove the
obstruction; then press and hold the
appropriate manual control for the
memory item that is not recalling for
two seconds. Try recalling the
memory position again by opening
the driver door and pressing K on
the RKE transmitter. If the memory
position is still not recalling, see
your dealer for service.
Easy Exit Recall
If programmed on in the vehicle
personalisation menu, this feature
moves the seat approximately 7 cm
3-7
(3 in) rearward automatically
allowing the driver more room to exit
the vehicle.
Easy Exit recall activates when one
of the following occurs:
.
The vehicle is turned off and the
driver door is opened within a
short time.
.
The vehicle is turned off with the
driver door open.
See Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
To stop recall movement, press one
of the memory, power seat controls,
or the adjustable pedal switch.
If something has blocked the driver
seat while recalling the exit position,
the recall may stop. Remove the
obstruction; then press and hold the
power seat control rearward for
two seconds. Try recalling the exit
position again. If the exit position is
still not recalling, see your dealer for
service.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-8
Black plate (8,1)
Seats and Restraints
Heated and Ventilated
Front Seats
When this feature is off, the symbols
on the buttons are white. When a
heated seat is turned on, the symbol
turns red. When a ventilated seat (if
available) is turned on, the symbol
turns blue.
{ Warning
If you cannot feel temperature
change or pain to the skin, the
seat heater may cause burns. To
reduce the risk of burns, people
with such a condition should use
care when using the seat heater,
especially for long periods of
time. Do not place anything on
the seat that insulates against
heat, such as a blanket, cushion,
cover, or similar item. This may
cause the seat heater to
overheat. An overheated seat
heater may cause a burn or may
damage the seat.
Heated and Ventilated Seat
Buttons Shown, Heated Seat
Buttons Similar
The buttons are near the climate
controls on the centre stack. To
operate, the ignition must be in ON/
RUN/START.
Press M or L to heat the driver or
passenger seat.
Press C or {, if available, to
ventilate the driver or passenger
seat. A ventilated seat has a fan
that pulls or pushes air through the
seat. The air is not cooled.
Press the button once for the
highest setting. With each press of
the button, the seat will change to
the next lower setting, and then to
the off setting. The indicator lights
next to the buttons indicate three for
the highest setting and one for the
lowest. If the front heated seats are
on high, the level may automatically
be lowered after approximately
30 minutes.
The passenger seat may take
longer to heat up.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
Seats and Restraints
Remote Start Heated and
Ventilated Seats
During a remote start, the heated or
ventilated seats can be turned on
automatically. When it is cold
outside, the heated seats turn on,
and when it is hot outside the
ventilated seats turn on. This
feature is cancelled when the
ignition is turned on. Press the
button to use the heated or
ventilated seats after the vehicle is
started.
The heated or ventilated seat
indicator lights on the button do not
turn on during a remote start.
The temperature performance of an
unoccupied seat may be reduced.
This is normal.
The heated or ventilated seats will
not turn on during a remote start
unless they are enabled in the
vehicle personalisation menu. See
Remote Vehicle Start on page 2-7
and Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
3-9
Rear Seats
Split Folding Seatbacks
With this feature, either side of the
rear seatback can be folded down
for more cargo space.
Folding the Seatbacks
{ Caution
Folding a rear seat with the safety
belts still fastened may cause
damage to the seat or the safety
belts. Always unbuckle the safety
belts and return them to their
normal stowed position before
folding a rear seat.
To fold the seatback:
1. Unbuckle the rear safety belts
and move the front seatbacks to
the upright position. See
Reclining Seatbacks on
page 3-5.
2. Make sure that there is nothing
under, in front of, or on the seat.
3. Lift the lever on the top of the
seatback. A tab near the
seatback lever raises when the
seatback is unlocked.
4. Fold the backrest forward. A tab
near the seatback lever retracts
when the seatback is locked in
place.
Keep the seatback in the upright,
locked position when not in use.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-10
Black plate (10,1)
Seats and Restraints
Raising the Seatbacks
{ Warning
If either seatback is not locked, it
could move forward in a sudden
stop or crash. That could cause
injury to the person sitting there.
Always push and pull on the
seatbacks to be sure they are
locked.
{ Warning
A safety belt that is improperly
routed, not properly attached,
or twisted will not provide the
protection needed in a crash. The
person wearing the belt could be
seriously injured. After raising the
rear seatback, always check to be
sure that the safety belts are
properly routed and attached, and
are not twisted.
To raise the seat backrest:
Reclining the Seatbacks
1. Lift the lever on top of the
seatback. Raise the seatback
and release the lever. A tab near
the seatback lever raises when
the seatback is unlocked.
To recline the seat backrest:
2. Push the seatback rearward until
it locks in the upright position.
A tab near the seatback lever
retracts when the seatback is
locked in place.
3. Make sure the rear safety belts
are not twisted or caught
between the seat cushion and
the seatback.
1. Lift and hold the lever on top of
the seatback. A tab near the
seatback lever raises when the
seatback is unlocked.
2. Tilt the seatback rearward, and
then release the lever when the
seatback is in the desired
position. A tab near the seatback
lever retracts when the seatback
is locked in place.
Heated Rear Seats
{ Warning
If you cannot feel temperature
change or pain to the skin, the
seat heater may cause burns.
See the Warning under Heated
and Ventilated Front Seats on
page 3-8.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
Seats and Restraints
the off setting. Three lights indicate
the highest setting, and one light
indicates the lowest.
Rear Seat
Pass-Through Door
3-11
Safety Belts
This section of the manual
describes how to use safety belts
properly. It also describes some
things not to do with safety belts.
{ Warning
If available, the buttons are on the
rear climate control panel on the
rear of the centre console.
With the ignition in ON/RUN/START,
press M or L to heat the left or right
outboard seat cushion and
seatback. An indicator on the
climate control display appears
when this feature is on.
Press the button once for the
highest setting. With each press of
the button, the heated seat changes
to the next lower setting, and then
There is a rear seat pass-through
door in the centre of the rear
seatback. Fold down the centre
armrest and push down on the latch
to open the door.
Do not let anyone ride where a
safety belt cannot be worn
properly. In a crash, if you or your
passenger(s) are not wearing
safety belts, injuries can be much
worse than if you are wearing
safety belts. You can be seriously
injured or killed by hitting things
inside the vehicle harder or by
being ejected from the vehicle. In
addition, anyone who is not
buckled up can strike other
passengers in the vehicle.
It is extremely dangerous to ride
in a cargo area, inside or outside
of a vehicle. In a collision,
passengers riding in these areas
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-12
Black plate (12,1)
Seats and Restraints
Warning (Continued)
Why Safety Belts Work
are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed. Do not allow
passengers to ride in any area of
the vehicle that is not equipped
with seats and safety belts.
Questions and Answers About
Safety Belts
Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle
after a crash if I am wearing a
safety belt?
Always wear a safety belt, and
check that all passenger(s) are
restrained properly too.
This vehicle has indicators as a
reminder to buckle the safety belts.
See Safety Belt Reminders on
page 5-12.
safety belts. That is why wearing
safety belts makes such good
sense.
When riding in a vehicle, you travel
as fast as the vehicle does. If the
vehicle stops suddenly, you keep
going until something stops you.
It could be the windscreen, the
instrument panel, or the safety belts!
When you wear a safety belt, you
and the vehicle slow down together.
There is more time to stop because
you stop over a longer distance and,
when worn properly, your strongest
bones take the forces from the
A: You could be - whether you are
wearing a safety belt or not.
Your chances of being conscious
during and after a crash, so you
can unbuckle and get out, are
much greater if you are belted.
Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why
should I have to wear safety
belts?
A: Airbags are supplemental
systems only; so they work with
safety belts - not instead of
them. Whether or not an airbag
is provided, all occupants still
have to buckle up to get the
most protection.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (13,1)
Seats and Restraints
.
Also, in nearly all regions, the
law requires wearing safety
belts.
How to Wear Safety Belts
Properly
It is very important for all occupants
to buckle up. Statistics show that
unbelted people are hurt more often
in crashes than those who are
wearing safety belts.
There are important things to know
about wearing a safety belt properly.
Wear the shoulder belt over the
shoulder and across the chest.
These parts of the body are best
able to take belt restraining
forces. The shoulder belt locks if
there is a sudden stop or crash.
{ Warning
This section is only for people of
adult size.
There are special things to know
about safety belts and children. And
there are different rules for smaller
children and infants. If a child will be
riding in the vehicle, see Older
Children on page 3-29 or Infants
and Young Children on page 3-31.
Follow those rules for everyone's
protection.
3-13
You can be seriously injured,
or even killed, by not wearing
your safety belt properly.
.
Sit up straight and always keep
your feet on the floor in front
of you.
.
Never allow the lap or
shoulder belt to become
loose or twisted.
.
Always use the correct buckle
for your seating position.
.
.
Wear the lap part of the belt low
and snug on the hips, just
touching the thighs. In a crash,
this applies force to the strong
pelvic bones and you would be
less likely to slide under the lap
belt. If you slid under it, the belt
would apply force on your
abdomen. This could cause
serious or even fatal injuries.
Never wear the shoulder belt
under both arms or behind
your back.
.
Never route the lap or
shoulder belt over an
armrest.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-14
Black plate (14,1)
Seats and Restraints
Lap-Shoulder Belt
All seating positions in the vehicle
have a lap-shoulder belt.
The following instructions explain
how to wear a lap-shoulder belt
properly.
1. Adjust the seat, if the seat is
adjustable, so you can sit up
straight. To see how, see “Seats”
in the Index.
2. Pick up the latch plate and pull
the belt across you. Do not let it
get twisted.
3. Push the latch plate into the
buckle until it clicks.
The lap-shoulder belt may lock if
you pull the belt across you very
quickly. If this happens, let the
belt go back slightly to unlock it.
Then pull the belt across you
more slowly.
Pull up on the latch plate to
make sure it is secure.
If the shoulder portion of a
passenger belt is pulled out all
the way, the child restraint
locking feature may be engaged.
If this happens, let the belt go
back all the way and start again.
4. If equipped with a shoulder belt
height adjuster, move it to the
height that is right for you. See
“Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster”
later in this section for
instructions on use and
important safety information.
Position the release button on
the buckle so that the safety belt
could be quickly unbuckled if
necessary.
5. To make the lap part tight, pull
up on the shoulder belt.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (15,1)
Seats and Restraints
are part of the safety belt assembly.
They can help tighten the safety
belts during the early stages of a
moderate to severe frontal and near
frontal crash and will deploy in side,
rear and rollover events if the
threshold conditions for pretensioner
activation are met.
To unlatch the belt, just push the
button on the buckle.
Before a door is closed, be sure the
safety belt is out of the way. If a
door is slammed against a safety
belt, damage can occur to both the
safety belt and the vehicle.
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster
The vehicle has a shoulder belt
height adjuster for the driver and
right front passenger seating
positions.
Adjust the height so that the
shoulder portion of the belt is on the
shoulder and not falling off of it. The
belt should be close to, but not
contacting, the neck. Improper
shoulder belt height adjustment
could reduce the effectiveness of
the safety belt in a crash. See How
to Wear Safety Belts Properly on
page 3-13.
3-15
Move the height adjuster up to the
desired position by pushing up on
the height adjuster.
After the height adjuster is set to the
desired position, try to move it down
without pressing the release button
to make sure it has locked into
position. Press the release button to
lower the height adjuster.
Safety Belt Pretensioners
This vehicle has safety belt
pretensioners for front outboard
occupants. Although the safety belt
pretensioners cannot be seen, they
Pretensioners work only once. If the
pretensioners activate in a crash,
they will need to be replaced, and
probably other new parts for the
vehicle's safety belt system. See
Replacing Safety Belt System Parts
after a Crash on page 3-18.
Rear Safety Belt Comfort
Guides
This vehicle may have rear shoulder
belt comfort guides for the outboard
passenger positions in the rear seat.
If not, they are available through the
dealer. The guides may provide
added safety belt comfort for older
children who have outgrown booster
seats and for some adults. When
installed on a shoulder belt, and
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-16
Black plate (16,1)
Seats and Restraints
properly adjusted, the comfort guide
positions the belt away from the
neck and head.
Warning (Continued)
and across the chest. These parts
of the body are best able to take
belt restraining forces.
Here is how to install a comfort
guide to the safety belt:
1. Remove the guide from its
storage pocket on the side of
the seat.
3. Be sure that the belt is not
twisted and it lies flat. The
elastic cord must be under the
belt and the guide on top.
{ Warning
2. Place the guide over the belt,
and insert the two edges of the
belt into the slots of the guide.
A safety belt that is not properly
worn may not provide the
protection needed in a crash. The
person wearing the belt could be
seriously injured. The shoulder
belt should go over the shoulder
(Continued)
4. Buckle, position, and release the
safety belt as described
previously in this section. Make
sure that the shoulder portion of
the belt is on the shoulder and
not falling off of it. The belt
should be close to, but not
contacting the neck.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (17,1)
Seats and Restraints
Safety Belt Extender
To remove and store the comfort
guide, squeeze the belt edges
together so that the safety belt can
be removed from the guide. Slide
the guide back into its storage
pocket located on the side of
the seat.
If the vehicle's safety belt will fasten
around you, you should use it.
Safety Belt Use During
Pregnancy
Safety belts work for everyone,
including pregnant women. Like all
occupants, they are more likely to
be seriously injured if they do not
wear safety belts.
3-17
A pregnant woman should wear a
lap-shoulder belt, and the lap
portion should be worn as low as
possible, below the rounding,
throughout the pregnancy.
The best way to protect the foetus is
to protect the mother. When a safety
belt is worn properly, it is more likely
that the foetus will not be hurt in a
crash. For pregnant women, as for
anyone, the key to making safety
belts effective is wearing them
properly.
But if a safety belt is not long
enough, your dealer will order you
an extender. When you go in to
order it, take the heaviest coat you
will wear, so the extender will be
long enough for you. To help avoid
personal injury, do not let someone
else use it, and use it only for the
seat it is made to fit. The extender
has been designed for adults. Never
use it for securing child seats. To
wear it, attach it to the regular safety
belt. See the instruction sheet that
comes with the extender.
Safety System Check
Now and then, check that the safety
belt reminder light, safety belts,
buckles, latch plates, retractors, and
anchorages are all working properly.
Look for any other loose or
damaged safety belt system parts
that might keep a safety belt system
from doing its job. See your dealer
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-18
Black plate (18,1)
Seats and Restraints
to have it repaired. Torn or frayed
safety belts may not protect you in a
crash. They can rip apart under
impact forces. If a belt is torn or
frayed, get a new one right away.
Make sure the safety belt reminder
light is working. See Safety Belt
Reminders on page 5-12.
Keep safety belts clean and dry.
See Safety Belt Care on page 3-18.
Safety Belt Care
Keep belts clean and dry.
{ Warning
Do not bleach or dye safety belts.
It may severely weaken them. In
a crash, they might not be able to
provide adequate protection.
Clean safety belts only with mild
soap and lukewarm water.
Replacing Safety Belt
System Parts after a
Crash
{ Warning
A crash can damage the safety
belt system in the vehicle.
A damaged safety belt system
may not properly protect the
person using it, resulting in
serious injury or even death in a
crash. To help make sure the
safety belt systems are working
properly after a crash, have them
inspected and any necessary
replacements made as soon as
possible.
After a minor crash, replacement of
safety belts may not be necessary.
But the safety belt assemblies that
were used during any crash may
have been stressed or damaged.
See your dealer to have the safety
belt assemblies inspected or
replaced.
New parts and repairs may be
necessary even if the safety belt
system was not being used at the
time of the crash.
Have the safety belt pretensioners
checked if the vehicle has been in a
crash, or if the airbag readiness light
stays on after you start the vehicle
or while you are driving. See Airbag
Readiness Light on page 5-13.
{ Warning
Safety procedures must always
be observed when disposing of
the vehicle or vehicle parts.
Disposal should only be
performed by an authorised
service centre, to help protect the
environment and your health.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (19,1)
Seats and Restraints
Airbag System
The vehicle has the following
airbags:
.
A frontal airbag for the driver.
.
A frontal airbag for the front
outboard passenger.
.
A seat-mounted side impact
airbag for the driver.
.
A seat-mounted side impact
airbag for the front outboard
passenger.
.
A roof-rail airbag for the driver
and for the second row
passenger seated directly
behind the driver.
.
A roof-rail airbag for the front
outboard passenger and the
second row passenger seated
directly behind the front outboard
passenger.
All vehicle airbags have the word
AIRBAG on the trim or on an
attached label near the deployment
opening.
3-19
For frontal airbags, the word
AIRBAG is on the centre of the
steering wheel for the driver and on
the instrument panel for the front
outboard passenger.
Here are the most important things
to know about the airbag system:
For seat-mounted side impact
airbags, the word AIRBAG is on the
side of the seatback closest to
the door.
You can be severely injured or
killed in a crash if you are not
wearing your safety belt, even
with airbags. Airbags are
designed to work with safety
belts, not replace them. Also,
airbags are not designed to inflate
in every crash. In some crashes
safety belts are the only restraint.
See When Should an Airbag
Inflate? on page 3-22.
For roof-rail airbags, the word
AIRBAG is on the ceiling or trim.
Airbags are designed to supplement
the protection provided by safety
belts. Even though today's airbags
are also designed to help reduce
the risk of injury from the force of an
inflating bag, all airbags must inflate
very quickly to do their job.
{ Warning
Wearing your safety belt during a
crash helps reduce the chance of
hitting things inside the vehicle or
being ejected from it. Airbags are
“supplemental restraints” to the
safety belts. Everyone in the
vehicle should wear a safety belt
properly, whether or not there is
an airbag for that person.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-20
Black plate (20,1)
Seats and Restraints
{ Warning
{ Warning
Because airbags inflate with great
force and faster than the blink of
an eye, anyone who is up
against, or very close to any
airbag when it inflates can be
seriously injured or killed. Do not
sit unnecessarily close to any
airbag, as you would be if sitting
on the edge of the seat or leaning
forward. Safety belts help keep
you in position before and during
a crash. Always wear a safety
belt, even with airbags. The driver
should sit as far back as possible
while still maintaining control of
the vehicle.
Children who are up against,
or very close to, any airbag when
it inflates can be seriously injured
or killed. Always secure children
properly in the vehicle. To read
how, see Older Children on
page 3-29 or Infants and Young
Children on page 3-31.
Occupants should not lean on or
sleep against the door or side
windows in seating positions with
seat-mounted side impact airbags
and/or roof-rail airbags.
Where Are the Airbags?
The driver frontal airbag is in the
centre of the steering wheel.
There is an airbag readiness light
on the instrument cluster, which
shows the airbag symbol.
The system checks the airbag
electrical system for malfunctions.
The light tells you if there is an
electrical problem. See Airbag
Readiness Light on page 5-13 for
more information.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (21,1)
Seats and Restraints
The front outboard passenger
frontal airbag is in the passenger
side instrument panel.
Driver Side Shown, Passenger
Side Similar
The driver and front outboard
passenger seat-mounted side
impact airbags are in the sides of
the seatbacks closest to the door.
3-21
Driver Side Shown, Passenger
Side Similar
The roof-rail airbags for the driver,
front passenger, and second row
outboard passengers are in the
ceiling above the side windows.
{ Warning
If something is between an
occupant and an airbag, the
airbag might not inflate properly
or it might force the object into
that person causing severe injury
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-22
Black plate (22,1)
Seats and Restraints
Warning (Continued)
or even death. The path of an
inflating airbag must be kept
clear. Do not put anything
between an occupant and an
airbag, and do not attach or put
anything on the steering wheel
hub or on or near any other
airbag covering.
Do not use seat accessories that
block the inflation path of a
seat-mounted side impact airbag.
Never secure anything to the roof
of a vehicle with roof-rail airbags
by routing a rope or tie-down
through any door or window
opening. If you do, the path of an
inflating roof-rail airbag will be
blocked.
When Should an Airbag
Inflate?
It depends on what is hit, the
direction of the impact, and how
quickly the vehicle slows down.
This vehicle is equipped with
airbags. See Airbag System on
page 3-19. Airbags are designed to
inflate if the impact exceeds the
specific airbag system's deployment
threshold. Deployment thresholds
are used to predict how severe a
crash is likely to be in time for the
airbags to inflate and help restrain
the occupants. The vehicle has
electronic sensors that help the
airbag system determine the
severity of the impact. Deployment
thresholds can vary with specific
vehicle design.
Frontal airbags may inflate at
different crash speeds depending on
whether the vehicle hits an object
straight on or at an angle, and
whether the object is fixed or
moving, rigid or deformable, narrow
or wide.
Frontal airbags are designed to
inflate in moderate to severe frontal
or near frontal crashes to help
reduce the potential for severe
injuries, mainly to the driver's or
front outboard passenger's head
and chest.
Whether the frontal airbags will or
should inflate is not based primarily
on how fast the vehicle is travelling.
Frontal airbags are not intended to
inflate during vehicle rollovers, in
rear impacts, or in many side
impacts.
In addition, the vehicle has
advanced technology frontal
airbags. Advanced technology
frontal airbags adjust the restraint
according to crash severity.
Seat-mounted side impact airbags
are designed to inflate in moderate
to severe side crashes depending
on the location of the impact.
Seat-mounted side impact airbags
are not designed to inflate in frontal
impacts, near frontal impacts,
rollovers, or rear impacts.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (23,1)
Seats and Restraints
A seat-mounted side impact airbag
is designed to inflate on the side of
the vehicle that is struck.
Roof-rail airbags are designed to
inflate in moderate to severe side
crashes depending on the location
of the impact. In addition, these
roof-rail airbags are designed to
inflate during a rollover or in a
severe frontal impact. Roof-rail
airbags are not designed to inflate in
rear impacts. Both roof-rail airbags
will inflate when either side of the
vehicle is struck, if the sensing
system predicts that the vehicle is
about to roll over on its side, or in a
severe frontal impact.
In any particular crash, no one can
say whether an airbag should have
inflated simply because of the
vehicle damage or repair costs.
What Makes an Airbag
Inflate?
In a deployment event, the sensing
system sends an electrical signal
triggering a release of gas from the
inflator. Gas from the inflator fills the
airbag causing the bag to break out
of the cover. The inflator, the airbag,
and related hardware are all part of
the airbag module.
For airbag locations, see Where Are
the Airbags? on page 3-20.
How Does an Airbag
Restrain?
In moderate to severe frontal or
near frontal collisions, even belted
occupants can contact the steering
wheel or the instrument panel. In
moderate to severe side collisions,
even belted occupants can contact
the inside of the vehicle.
Airbags supplement the protection
provided by safety belts by
distributing the force of the impact
more evenly over the
occupant's body.
Rollover capable roof-rail airbags
are designed to help contain the
head and chest of occupants in the
outboard seating positions in the
3-23
first and second rows. The rollover
capable roof-rail airbags are
designed to help reduce the risk of
full or partial ejection in rollover
events, although no system can
prevent all such ejections.
But airbags would not help in many
types of collisions, primarily
because the occupant's motion is
not toward those airbags. See When
Should an Airbag Inflate? on
page 3-22.
Airbags should never be regarded
as anything more than a supplement
to safety belts.
What Will You See after
an Airbag Inflates?
After the frontal airbags and
seat-mounted side impact airbags
inflate, they quickly deflate, so
quickly that some people may not
even realise an airbag inflated.
Roof-rail airbags may still be at least
partially inflated for some time after
deployment. Some components of
the airbag module may be hot for
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-24
Black plate (24,1)
Seats and Restraints
several minutes. For location of the
airbags, see Where Are the
Airbags? on page 3-20.
The parts of the airbag that come
into contact with you may be warm,
but not too hot to touch. There may
be some smoke and dust coming
from the vents in the deflated
airbags. Airbag inflation does not
prevent the driver from seeing out of
the windscreen or being able to
steer the vehicle, nor does it prevent
people from leaving the vehicle.
{ Warning
When an airbag inflates, there
may be dust in the air. This dust
could cause breathing problems
for people with a history of
asthma or other breathing trouble.
To avoid this, everyone in the
vehicle should get out as soon as
it is safe to do so. If you have
breathing problems but cannot
get out of the vehicle after an
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
Warning (Continued)
airbag inflates, then get fresh air
by opening a window or a door.
If you experience breathing
problems following an airbag
deployment, you should seek
medical attention.
system, brake and steering
systems, etc. Even if the vehicle
appears to be drivable after a
moderate crash, there may be
concealed damage that could
make it difficult to safely operate
the vehicle.
The vehicle has a feature that may
automatically unlock the doors, turn
on the interior lamps and hazard
warning lights, and shut off the fuel
system after the airbags inflate. You
can lock the doors, turn off the
interior lamps and hazard warning
flashers by using the controls for
those features.
Use caution if attempting to
restart the vehicle after a crash
has occurred.
{ Warning
A crash severe enough to inflate
the airbags may have also
damaged important functions in
the vehicle, such as the fuel
(Continued)
In many crashes severe enough to
inflate the airbag, windscreens are
broken by vehicle deformation.
Additional windscreen breakage
may also occur from the front
passenger airbag.
.
Airbags are designed to inflate
only once. After an airbag
inflates, you will need some new
parts for the airbag system.
If you do not get them, the
airbag system will not be there
to help protect you in another
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (25,1)
Seats and Restraints
.
crash. A new system will include
airbag modules and possibly
other parts. The service manual
for your vehicle covers the need
to replace other parts.
.
.
The vehicle has a crash sensing
and diagnostic module which
records information after a
crash. See Vehicle Data
Recording and Privacy on
page 13-1.
Let only qualified technicians
work on the airbag systems.
Improper service can mean that
an airbag system will not work
properly. See your dealer for
service.
Airbag On-Off Switch
The vehicle has an airbag on-off
switch that you can use to manually
turn on or off the front outboard
passenger frontal airbag.
3-25
The infant has a medical
condition which, according to the
infant's physician, makes it
necessary for the infant to ride in
the front seat so that the driver
can constantly monitor the
child's condition.
Child age 1 to 12: A child age 1 to
12 must travel in the front seat
because:
This switch should only be turned to
the off position if the person in the
front outboard passenger position
falls under the conditions specified
in this manual as follows:
Infant: An infant (less than 1 year
old) must travel in the front seat
because:
.
My vehicle has no rear seat;
.
My vehicle has a rear seat too
small to accommodate a
rear-facing infant seat; or
.
My vehicle has no rear seat;
.
Although children ages 1 to 12
ride in the rear seat(s) whenever
possible, children ages 1 to 12
sometimes must travel in the
front because no space is
available in the rear seat(s) of
my vehicle; or
.
The child has a medical
condition which, according to the
child's physician, makes it
necessary for the child to travel
in the front seat so that the
driver can constantly monitor the
child's condition.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-26
Black plate (26,1)
Seats and Restraints
Medical Condition: A passenger
has a medical condition which,
according to his or her physician:
.
Causes the passenger airbag to
pose a special risk for the
passenger; and
.
Makes the potential harm from
the passenger airbag in a crash
greater than the potential harm
from turning off the airbag and
allowing the passenger, even if
belted, to hit the dashboard or
windscreen in a crash.
Warning (Continued)
Do not turn off the passenger
frontal airbag unless the person
sitting there is in a risk group
identified by the national
government.
{ Warning
If the airbag readiness light ever
comes on and stays on, it means
that something may be wrong
with the airbag system. For
example, the front passenger
frontal airbag could inflate even
though the airbag on-off switch is
turned off.
{ Warning
If the front passenger frontal
airbag is turned off for a person
who is not in a risk group
identified by the national
government, that person will not
have the extra protection of an
airbag. In a crash, the airbag will
not be able to inflate and help
protect the person sitting there.
(Continued)
passenger frontal airbag is off, after
the system check is completed. The
airbag off light will come on and stay
on to let you know that the front
outboard passenger frontal airbag is
off. See Airbag On-Off Light on
page 5-14.
To turn off the front outboard
passenger frontal airbag, insert any
key or a coin into the switch, push
in, and move the switch to the off
position.
The off symbol will come on in the
passenger airbag status indicator
located in the overhead console to
let you know that the front outboard
To help avoid injury to yourself or
others, have the vehicle serviced
right away. See Airbag Readiness
Light on page 5-13 for more
information, including important
safety information.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (27,1)
Seats and Restraints
dealer and the service manual have
information about servicing the
vehicle and the airbag system.
{ Warning
To turn the front outboard passenger
frontal airbag on again, insert any
key or a coin into the switch, push
in, and move the switch to the on
position.
The front outboard passenger
frontal airbag is now enabled (may
inflate). See Airbag On-Off Light on
page 5-14 for more information.
Servicing the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle
Airbags affect how the vehicle
should be serviced. There are parts
of the airbag system in several
places around the vehicle. Your
For up to 10 seconds after the
vehicle is turned off and the
battery is disconnected, an airbag
can still inflate during improper
service. You can be injured if you
are close to an airbag when it
inflates. Avoid yellow connectors.
They are probably part of the
airbag system. Be sure to follow
proper service procedures, and
make sure the person performing
work for you is qualified to do so.
Adding Equipment to the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle
Adding accessories that change the
vehicle's frame, bumper system,
height, front end or side sheet
metal, may keep the airbag system
from working properly.
3-27
The operation of the airbag system
can also be affected by changing or
moving any parts of the front seats,
safety belts, the airbag sensing and
diagnostic module, steering wheel,
instrument panel, any airbag
module, ceiling or pillar garnish trim,
overhead console, front sensors,
side impact sensors, or airbag
wiring.
Your dealer and the service manual
have information about the location
of the airbag sensors, sensing and
diagnostic module, and airbag
wiring.
If the vehicle has rollover roof-rail
airbags, see Different Size Tyres
and Wheels on page 10-52 for
additional important information.
If your vehicle needs to be modified
because you have a disability and
you have questions about whether
the modifications will affect the
vehicle's airbag system, or if you
have questions about whether the
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-28
Black plate (28,1)
Seats and Restraints
airbag system will be affected if the
vehicle is modified for any other
reason, contact your dealer.
Airbag System Check
The airbag system does not need
regularly scheduled maintenance or
replacement. Make sure the airbag
readiness light is working. See
Airbag Readiness Light on
page 5-13.
{ Caution
If an airbag covering is damaged,
opened, or broken, the airbag
may not work properly. Do not
open or break the airbag
coverings. If there are any
opened or broken airbag
coverings, have the airbag
covering and/or airbag module
replaced. For the location of the
airbags, see Where Are the
Airbags? on page 3-20. See your
dealer for service.
Replacing Airbag System
Parts after a Crash
If an airbag inflates, you will need to
replace airbag system parts. See
your dealer for service.
{ Warning
If the airbag readiness light stays on
after the vehicle is started or comes
on when you are driving, the airbag
system may not work properly. Have
the vehicle serviced right away. See
Airbag Readiness Light on
page 5-13 for more information.
A crash can damage the airbag
systems in the vehicle.
A damaged airbag system may
not work properly and may not
protect you and your
passenger(s) in a crash, resulting
in serious injury or even death. To
help make sure the airbag
systems are working properly
after a crash, have them
inspected and any necessary
replacements made as soon as
possible.
{ Warning
Safety procedures must always
be observed when disposing of
the vehicle or vehicle parts.
Disposal should only be
performed by an authorised
service centre, to help protect the
environment and your health.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (29,1)
Seats and Restraints
Child Restraints
Older Children
The manufacturer instructions that
come with the booster seat state the
weight and height limitations for that
booster. Use a booster seat with a
lap-shoulder belt until the child
passes the fit test below:
.
Sit all the way back on the seat.
Do the knees bend at the seat
edge? If yes, continue. If no,
return to the booster seat.
.
Fasten the lap-shoulder belt.
Does the shoulder belt rest on
the shoulder? If yes, continue.
If not, try using the rear safety
belt comfort guide. See “Rear
Safety Belt Comfort Guides”
under Lap-Shoulder Belt on
page 3-14. If the shoulder belt
still does not rest on the
shoulder, then return to the
booster seat.
.
Does the lap belt fit low and
snug on the hips, touching the
thighs? If yes, continue. If no,
return to the booster seat.
Older children who have outgrown
booster seats should wear the
vehicle safety belts.
.
3-29
Can proper safety belt fit be
maintained for the length of the
trip? If yes, continue. If no,
return to the booster seat.
Q: What is the proper way to
wear safety belts?
A: An older child should wear a
lap-shoulder belt and get the
additional restraint a shoulder
belt can provide. The shoulder
belt should not cross the face or
neck. The lap belt should fit
snugly below the hips, just
touching the top of the thighs.
This applies belt force to the
child's pelvic bones in a crash.
It should never be worn over the
abdomen, which could cause
severe or even fatal internal
injuries in a crash.
Also see “Rear Safety Belt Comfort
Guides” under Lap-Shoulder Belt on
page 3-14.
According to accident statistics,
children are safer when properly
restrained in a rear seating position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-30
Black plate (30,1)
Seats and Restraints
In a crash, children who are not
buckled up can strike other people
who are buckled up, or can be
thrown out of the vehicle. Older
children need to use safety belts
properly.
Warning (Continued)
belt. The belt force would then be
applied right on the abdomen.
That could cause serious or fatal
injuries. The shoulder belt should
go over the shoulder and across
the chest.
{ Warning
Never allow more than one child
to wear the same safety belt. The
safety belt cannot properly spread
the impact forces. In a crash, they
can be crushed together and
seriously injured. A safety belt
must be used by only one person
at a time.
{ Warning
Never allow a child to wear the
safety belt with the shoulder belt
behind their back. A child can be
seriously injured by not wearing
the lap-shoulder belt properly. In a
crash, the child would not be
restrained by the shoulder belt.
The child could move too far
forward increasing the chance of
head and neck injury. The child
might also slide under the lap
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (31,1)
Seats and Restraints
Infants and Young
Children
the vehicle's safety belt system nor
its airbag system is designed
for them.
Everyone in a vehicle needs
protection! This includes infants and
all other children. Neither the
distance travelled nor the age and
size of the traveller changes the
need, for everyone, to use safety
restraints.
Children who are not restrained
properly can strike other people,
or can be thrown out of the vehicle.
{ Warning
Children can be seriously injured
or strangled if a shoulder belt is
wrapped around their neck and
the safety belt continues to
tighten. Never leave children
unattended in a vehicle and never
allow children to play with the
safety belts.
Every time infants and young
children ride in vehicles, they should
have the protection provided by
appropriate child restraints. Neither
3-31
{ Warning
Never hold an infant or a child
while riding in a vehicle. Due to
crash forces, an infant or a child
will become so heavy it is not
possible to hold it during a crash.
For example, in a crash at only
40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb)
infant will suddenly become a
110 kg (240 lb) force on a
person's arms. An infant should
be secured in an appropriate
restraint.
{ Warning
Children who are up against,
or very close to, any airbag when
it inflates can be seriously injured
or killed. Never put a rear-facing
child restraint in the right front
seat. Secure a rear-facing child
restraint in a rear seat. It is also
better to secure a forward-facing
child restraint in a rear seat. If you
must secure a forward-facing
child restraint in the right front
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-32
Black plate (32,1)
Seats and Restraints
Warning (Continued)
seat, always move the front
passenger seat as far back as it
will go.
For most basic types of child
restraints, there are many different
models available. When purchasing
a child restraint, be sure it is
designed to be used in a motor
vehicle.
The restraint manufacturer's
instructions that come with the
restraint state the weight and height
limitations for a particular child
restraint.
{ Warning
Selection of a particular restraint
should take into consideration not
only the child's weight, height, and
age but also whether or not the
restraint will be compatible with the
motor vehicle in which it will
be used.
To reduce the risk of neck and
head injury during a crash, infants
need complete support. In a
crash, if an infant is in a
rear-facing child restraint, the
crash forces can be distributed
across the strongest part of an
infant's body, the back and
shoulders. Infants should always
be secured in rear-facing child
restraints.
{ Warning
A young child's hip bones are still
so small that the vehicle's regular
safety belt may not remain low on
the hip bones, as it should.
Instead, it may settle up around
the child's abdomen. In a crash,
the belt would apply force on a
body area that is unprotected by
any bony structure. This alone
could cause serious or fatal
injuries. To reduce the risk of
serious or fatal injuries during a
crash, young children should
always be secured in appropriate
child restraints.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (33,1)
Seats and Restraints
3-33
Child Restraint Systems
Rear-Facing Infant Seat
A rear-facing infant seat provides
restraint with the seating surface
against the back of the infant.
The harness system holds the infant
in place and, in a crash, acts to
keep the infant positioned in the
restraint.
Forward-Facing Child Seat
Booster Seats
A forward-facing child seat provides
restraint for the child's body with the
harness.
A booster seat is a child restraint
designed to improve the fit of the
vehicle's safety belt system.
A booster seat can also help a child
to see out the window.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-34
Black plate (34,1)
Seats and Restraints
Securing an Add-On Child
Restraint in the Vehicle
{ Warning
A child can be seriously injured or
killed in a crash if the child
restraint is not properly secured in
the vehicle. Secure the child
restraint properly in the vehicle
using the vehicle safety belt or
ISOFIX system, following the
instructions that came with that
child restraint and the instructions
in this manual.
To help reduce the chance of injury,
the child restraint must be secured
in the vehicle. Child restraint
systems must be secured in vehicle
seats by lap belts or the lap belt
portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by
the ISOFIX system. See ISOFIX
Child Restraint Systems on
page 3-40 for more information.
Children can be endangered in a
crash if the child restraint is not
properly secured in the vehicle.
When securing an add-on child
restraint, refer to the instructions
that come with the restraint which
may be on the restraint itself or in a
booklet, or both, and to this manual.
The child restraint instructions are
important, so if they are not
available, obtain a replacement
copy from the manufacturer.
Keep in mind that an unsecured
child restraint can move around in a
collision or sudden stop and injure
people in the vehicle. Be sure to
properly secure any child restraint in
the vehicle - even when no child is
in it.
Securing the Child within the
Child Restraint
{ Warning
A child can be seriously injured or
killed in a crash if the child is not
properly secured in the child
restraint. Secure the child
properly following the instructions
that came with that child restraint.
Where to Put the
Restraint
According to accident statistics,
children and infants are safer when
properly restrained in a child
restraint system or infant restraint
system secured in a rear seating
position.
Whenever possible, children age
12 and under should be secured in
a rear seating position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (35,1)
Seats and Restraints
If a child restraint is secured in the
front outboard passenger seat, there
is a switch on the instrument panel
to manually turn off the front
outboard passenger airbag. See
Airbag On-Off Switch on page 3-25
and Securing Child Restraints (Rear
Seat) on page 3-41 or Securing
Child Restraints (Front Passenger
Seat) on page 3-42 for more
information, including important
safety information.
Never put a rear-facing child seat in
the front. This is because the risk to
the rear-facing child is so great if the
airbag deploys.
DO NOT place rear-facing child seat
on this seat. DEATH OR SERIOUS
INJURY can occur. This is because
the risk to the rear-facing child is so
great, if the airbag deploys.
{ Warning
3-35
Warning (Continued)
deploy under some unusual
circumstance, even though it is
turned off.
Secure rear-facing child restraints
in a rear seat, even if the airbag
is off. If you secure a
forward-facing child restraint in
the front seat, always move the
front passenger seat as far back
as it will go. It is better to secure
the child restraint in a rear seat.
A child in a rear-facing child
restraint can be seriously injured
or killed if the front passenger
airbag inflates. This is because
the back of the rear-facing child
restraint would be very close to
the inflating airbag. A child in a
forward-facing child restraint can
be seriously injured or killed if the
front passenger airbag inflates
and the passenger seat is in a
forward position.
When securing a child restraint in a
rear seating position, study the
instructions that came with your
child restraint to make sure it is
compatible with this vehicle.
Even if the airbag switch has
turned off the right front
passenger frontal airbag, no
system is fail-safe. No one can
guarantee that an airbag will not
(Continued)
Child restraints and booster seats
vary considerably in size, and some
may fit in certain seating positions
better than others. Always make
sure the child restraint is properly
secured.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-36
Seats and Restraints
Depending on where you place the
child restraint and the size of the
child restraint, you may not be able
to access adjacent safety belt
assemblies or ISOFIX anchors for
additional passengers or child
restraints. Adjacent seating
positions should not be used if the
child restraint prevents access to or
interferes with the routing of the
safety belt.
If the vehicle does not have a rear
seat that will accommodate a
rear-facing child restraint, we
recommend that rear-facing child
restraints not be transported in the
vehicle, even if the airbag is off.
Wherever a child restraint is
installed, be sure to secure the child
restraint properly.
Keep in mind that an unsecured
child restraint can move around in a
collision or sudden stop and injure
people in the vehicle. Be sure to
properly secure any child restraint in
your vehicle - even when no child is
in it.
If you need to secure more than one
child restraint in the rear seat,
review the following illustrations.
Black plate (36,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (37,1)
Seats and Restraints
3-37
Configurations for Use of Child Restraints
Use the following chart to determine which seats in the vehicle are suitable for the carriage of child restraint
systems.
Mass Group
Passenger Seating Positions
Front Passenger
Rear Right Outboard
Rear Centre
Rear Left Outboard
Group 0
Up to 10 kg
X
U
U
U
Group 0 +
Up to 13 kg
X
U
U
U
Group I
9 to 18 kg
X
U
U
U
Group II
15 to 25 kg
X
U
U
U
Group III
22 to 36 kg
X
U
U
U
U: Suitable for universal category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
UF: Suitable for forward-facing universal category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
L: Suitable for particular child restraints given in the attached list. These restraints may be of the specific vehicle,
restricted, or semi-universal categories.
B: Built-in restraint approved for this mass group.
X: Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-38
Black plate (38,1)
Seats and Restraints
ISOFIX Child Restraint Systems Installation Suitability for Various Seating Positions
Use the following chart to determine which seats in the vehicle are suitable for the ISOFIX child restraint systems.
Mass Group
Class Size
Fixture
Vehicle ISOFIX Positions
Front
Passenger
Rear Right
Outboard
Rear Centre
Rear Left
Outboard
F
ISO/L1
X
X
X
X
G
ISO/L2
X
X
X
X
0
(up to 10 kg)
E
ISO/R1
X
IUF
X
IUF
E
ISO/R1
X
IUF
X
IUF
0+
(up to 13 kg)
D
ISO/R2
X
IUF
X
IUF
C
ISO/R3
X
IUF
X
IUF
D
ISO/R2
X
IUF
X
IUF
C
ISO/R3
X
IUF
X
IUF
B
ISO/F2
X
IUF
X
IUF
B1
ISO/F2X
X
IUF
X
IUF
A
ISO/F3
X
IUF
X
IUF
Infant Carbed
(Carrycot)
I
(9 to 18 kg)
II
(15 to 25 kg)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (39,1)
Seats and Restraints
Mass Group
Class Size
Fixture
3-39
Vehicle ISOFIX Positions
Front
Passenger
Rear Right
Outboard
Rear Centre
Rear Left
Outboard
III
(22 to 36 kg)
IUF: Suitable for ISOFIX forward-facing “universal” category child restraint systems approved for use in this mass
group.
IL: Suitable for particular ISOFIX child restraints given in the attached list. These ISOFIX child restraints are those
of the specific vehicle, restricted, or semi-universal categories.
X: Position not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems in this mass group and or size class.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-40
Black plate (40,1)
Seats and Restraints
Child restraint system size classes
and fixtures are as follows:
A - ISO/F3: Full-height
forward-facing toddler child restraint
system.
ISOFIX Child Restraint
Systems
No more than two ISOFIX child
restraint systems can be installed
on the rear seats at the same time,
though not right next to each other.
Top-Tether Fastening Eyes
B - ISO/F2: Reduced-height
forward-facing toddler child restraint
system.
B1 - ISO/F2X: Reduced-height
forward-facing toddler child restraint
system.
C - ISO/R3: Full-size rear-facing
toddler child restraint system.
D - ISO/R2: Reduced-size
rear-facing toddler child restraint
system.
E - ISO/R1: Rear-facing infant child
restraint system.
F - ISO/L1: Left side-facing position
carrycot.
G - ISO/L2: Right side-facing
position carrycot.
Rear Seat
ISOFIX mounting brackets are
marked by a j on the seatback.
Fasten vehicle-approved ISOFIX
child restraint systems to the
ISOFIX mounting brackets.
Specific vehicle ISOFIX child
restraint system positions are
marked in the “ISOFIX Child
Restraint Systems Suitability” table.
See Where to Put the Restraint on
page 3-34.
Top-tether fastening eyes are
marked with I for a child seat.
In addition to the ISOFIX mounting,
fasten the top-tether strap to the
top-tether fastening eyes.
ISOFIX child restraint systems of
universal category positions are
marked in the “ISOFIX Child
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (41,1)
Seats and Restraints
Restraint Systems Suitability” table
by IUF. See Where to Put the
Restraint on page 3-34.
Securing Child Restraints
(Rear Seat)
When securing a child restraint in a
rear seating position, study the
instructions that came with the child
restraint to make sure it is
compatible with this vehicle.
If the child restraint has the ISOFIX
system, see ISOFIX Child Restraint
Systems on page 3-40 for how and
where to install the child restraint
using ISOFIX. If a child restraint is
secured in the vehicle using a
safety belt and it uses a top tether,
see ISOFIX Child Restraint Systems
on page 3-40 for top tether anchor
locations.
Do not secure a child seat in a
position without a top tether anchor
if a national or local law requires
that the top tether be anchored, or if
3-41
the instructions that come with the
child restraint say that the top strap
must be anchored.
If the child restraint does not have
the ISOFIX system, you will be
using the safety belt to secure the
child restraint in this position. Be
sure to follow the instructions that
came with the child restraint. Secure
the child in the child restraint when
and as the instructions say.
If more than one child restraint
needs to be installed in the rear
seat, be sure to read Where to Put
the Restraint on page 3-34.
1. Put the child restraint on
the seat.
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run
the lap and shoulder portions of
the vehicle's safety belt through
or around the restraint. The child
restraint instructions will show
you how.
3. Push the latch plate into the
buckle until it clicks.
Position the release button on
the buckle so that the safety belt
could be quickly unbuckled if
necessary.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-42
Black plate (42,1)
Seats and Restraints
4. To tighten the belt, push down
on the child restraint, pull the
shoulder portion of the belt to
tighten the lap portion of the belt,
and feed the shoulder belt back
into the retractor. When installing
a forward-facing child restraint, it
may be helpful to use your knee
to push down on the child
restraint as you tighten the belt.
If the child restraint system has
a lock-off mechanism, use it to
secure the vehicle safety belt.
5. If the child restraint has a top
tether, follow the child restraint
manufacturer's instructions
regarding the use of the top
tether. See ISOFIX Child
Restraint Systems on page 3-40
for more information.
There is a switch on the instrument
panel that you can use to turn off
the right front passenger frontal
airbag. See Airbag On-Off Switch on
page 3-25 for more information,
including important safety
information.
6. Before placing a child in the
child restraint, make sure it is
securely held in place. Push and
pull the child restraint in different
directions to be sure it is secure.
Never put a rear-facing child seat in
the front. This is because the risk to
the rear-facing child is so great,
if the airbag deploys.
To remove the child restraint,
unfasten the vehicle safety belt and
let it return to the stowed position.
If the top tether is attached to a top
tether anchor, disconnect it.
Securing Child Restraints
(Front Passenger Seat)
This vehicle has airbags. A rear
seat is a safer place to secure a
forward-facing child restraint. See
Where to Put the Restraint on
page 3-34.
{ Warning
A child in a rear-facing child
restraint can be seriously injured
or killed if the front passenger
airbag inflates. This is because
the back of the rear-facing child
restraint would be very close to
the inflating airbag. A child in a
forward-facing child restraint can
be seriously injured or killed if the
front passenger airbag inflates
and the passenger seat is in a
forward position.
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (43,1)
Seats and Restraints
3-43
{ Warning
{ Warning
Even if the airbag switch has
turned off the right front
passenger frontal airbag, no
system is fail-safe. No one can
guarantee that an airbag will not
deploy under some unusual
circumstance, even though it is
turned off.
If the airbag readiness light ever
comes on and stays on, it means
that something may be wrong
with the airbag system. For
example, the right front
passenger airbag could inflate
even though the airbag on-off
switch is turned off.
Secure rear-facing child restraints
in a rear seat, even if the airbag
is off. If you secure a
forward-facing child restraint in
the front seat, always move the
front passenger seat as far back
as it will go. It is better to secure
the child restraint in a rear seat.
To help avoid injury to yourself or
others, have the vehicle serviced
right away. See Airbag Readiness
Light on page 5-13 for more
information, including important
safety information.
When using a child restraint
system on the front passenger
seat, the airbag system for the
front passenger seat must be
deactivated. If not, the triggering
of the airbags poses a risk of fatal
injury to the child. This is
especially the case if rear-facing
child restraint systems are used
on the front passenger seat.
Warning (Continued)
{ Warning
"Do not use a rearward facing
child restraint on a seat protected
by an airbag in front of it!"
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-44
Black plate (44,1)
Seats and Restraints
If the vehicle does not have a rear
seat that will accommodate a
rear-facing child restraint, a
rear-facing child restraint should not
be installed in the vehicle, even if
the airbag is off.
If the child restraint has the ISOFIX
system, see ISOFIX Child Restraint
Systems on page 3-40 for how and
where to install the child restraint
using ISOFIX. If a child restraint is
secured using a safety belt and it
uses a top tether, see ISOFIX Child
Restraint Systems on page 3-40 for
top tether anchor locations.
Do not secure a child seat in a
position without a top tether anchor
if a national or local law requires
that the top tether be anchored, or if
the instructions that come with the
child restraint say that the top strap
must be anchored.
You will be using the lap-shoulder
belt to secure the child restraint in
this position. Follow the instructions
that came with the child restraint.
1. Move the seat as far back as it
will go before securing the
forward-facing child restraint.
When the airbag on-off switch
has turned off the right front
passenger frontal airbag, the off
indicator in the airbag off light
should light and stay lit when
you start the vehicle. See Airbag
On-Off Light on page 5-14.
2. Put the child restraint on
the seat.
3. Pick up the latch plate, and run
the lap and shoulder portions of
the vehicle's safety belt through
or around the restraint. The child
restraint instructions will show
you how.
4. Push the latch plate into the
buckle until it clicks.
Position the release button on
the buckle, so that the safety
belt could be quickly unbuckled
if necessary.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (45,1)
Seats and Restraints
If the vehicle does not have a
rear seat and the child restraint
has a top tether, follow the child
restraint manufacturer's
instructions regarding the use of
the top tether. See ISOFIX Child
Restraint Systems on page 3-40
for more information.
5. To tighten the belt, push down
on the child restraint, pull the
shoulder portion of the belt to
tighten the lap portion of the belt
and feed the shoulder belt back
into the retractor. When installing
a forward-facing child restraint, it
may be helpful to use your knee
to push down on the child
restraint as you tighten the belt.
If the child restraint system has
a lock-off mechanism, use it to
secure the vehicle safety belt.
6. Before placing a child in the
restraint, make sure it is
securely held in place. To check,
push and pull the child restraint
in different directions to be sure
it is secure.
3-45
To remove the child restraint,
unfasten the vehicle safety belt and
let it return to the stowed position.
If you turned the airbag off with the
switch, turn on the right front
passenger airbag when you remove
the child restraint from the vehicle
unless the person who will be sitting
there is a member of a passenger
airbag risk group. See Airbag
On-Off Switch on page 3-25 for
more information, including
important safety information.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
3-46
Seats and Restraints
2 NOTES
Black plate (46,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Storage
Storage
Storage
Compartments
Storage Compartments
Storage Compartments . . . . . . .
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Armrest Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Centre Console Storage . . . . . .
4-1
4-1
4-1
4-2
4-2
4-2
4-3
Additional Storage Features
Cargo Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Cargo Tie-Downs . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
Cargo Management
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
Cargo Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Roof Rack System
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
{ Warning
Do not store heavy or sharp
objects in storage compartments.
In a crash, these objects may
cause the cover to open and
could result in injury.
Glove Box
Lift the glove box handle up to open
it. Use the key to lock and unlock
the glove box.
The glove box is air conditioned and
can be used to store items at a
lower temperature. The vehicle air
conditioning must be turned on for
the maximum cool air to enter the
glove box. Move the slide control to
allow cool air into the glove box.
After opening the air flow, close the
glove box door to keep the cold air
from entering the vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
4-2
Black plate (2,1)
Storage
Cupholders
The front cupholder has a divider
that can be adjusted to
accommodate large or small
containers.
For large containers, press the
button to move aside the divider
aside and make the cupholder
deeper. For small containers, push
down on the top edge of the divider
to lock it back in place and make
the cupholder shorter.
Front Storage
If equipped with storage behind the
climate control system, touch and
hold the chrome bar at the bottom of
the climate control system panel to
open. There is a USB port inside.
See “USB/SD Port” in the
infotainment manual.
Keep the storage area closed when
not in use.
Touch and hold the chrome bar at
the bottom of the climate control
system panel again to close.
A storage area is located in front of
the gear lever. Push upward on the
top of the door and release; the
door automatically opens.
There is an accessory power outlet
inside. See Power Outlets on
page 5-6.
Armrest Storage
For vehicles with a rear seat
armrest, pull the rear seat armrest
forward to access cupholders with
removable liners. For vehicles with
a rear storage area, pull the lever to
access.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Storage
Centre Console Storage
Additional Storage
Features
The centre console has an armrest,
upper storage tray, and lower
storage area.
Cargo Cover
The armrest can be adjusted. Slide
the top of the armrest to adjust to
the desired position.
For vehicles with the dual position
cargo cover, it can be used to cover
items in the cargo area of the
vehicle.
Press the driver side button to
access the upper storage tray.
Press the passenger side button to
access the lower storage area.
There is an accessory power outlet
inside the centre console and two
USB ports. If equipped, there is an
SD card reader and auxiliary jack.
See Power Outlets on page 5-6 and
the infotainment manual.
4-3
Press the button to open the
storage area on the rear of the
centre console. If equipped with rear
seat entertainment (RSE), the
audio/video jacks, USB port, and
SD port will be inside. See the
infotainment manual.
The shade can be set in two
positions. It can be set in a halfway
open (1) position for loading objects
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
4-4
Black plate (4,1)
Storage
into the rear compartment, or the
lower (2) position to conceal objects
in the rear compartment.
Install the Cargo Cover
1. Hold the cartridge so that the
pull-out shade faces the rear of
the vehicle.
5. Insert the shade pins in the
channels (3) on both sides.
2. Slide the button on the top to
release the cartridge.
6. Slide the shade to the lower (2)
position, or the halfway open (1)
position.
3. Pull up to remove the cartridge
from the pins.
Remove the Cargo Cover
2. Align the cartridge over the pins
on the trim panels of the vehicle.
3. Push down on the cartridge to
snap it into place.
4. Unroll the shade toward the rear
of the vehicle.
1. Remove the cover from the
channels and carefully roll it
back up.
{ Warning
An unsecured cargo cover could
strike people in a sudden stop or
turn, or in a crash. Store the
cargo cover securely or remove it
from the vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Storage
4-5
Cargo Tie-Downs
For vehicles equipped with cargo
tie-downs, the four tie-downs are
located in the rear compartment of
the vehicle. Use the tie-downs to
secure small loads.
Cargo Management
System
A prop rod locks to hold the cover
up when opened.
Press the red button on the prop rod
to close the cover.
Four hooks are located on the
inside cover and can be used for
storing items.
Rear Storage Area
There may be additional storage
compartments on each side of the
cargo management system. Lift the
panel up to open.
To open the cargo management
system, press the rear of the handle
to unlatch it and then lift the
handle up.
{ Warning
An improperly latched and closed
cargo cover, or cargo cover left in
the open position, could be
thrown about the vehicle during a
crash or sudden manoeuvre.
Someone could be injured. Be
sure to return the cover to the
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
4-6
Black plate (6,1)
Storage
Warning (Continued)
closed position and latch before
driving. If the cover is removed,
always store it outside of the
vehicle. When it is replaced,
always be sure that it is securely
reattached.
To access the rear storage areas of
the cargo management system, and
the tire sealant and compressor kit:
1. Remove the cargo cover,
if equipped.
2. Open the cargo management
system cover.
3. Release the prop rod from the
inside cover by sliding the red
clip down.
Unhook the prop rod from the
pin on the inside cover. Store the
unhooked prop rod by folding it
into the cargo management
compartment.
4. Store the cargo management
system cover by hooking it onto
the weatherstrip.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Storage
U-Rail
For vehicles with a u-rail system,
the fence can be moved to different
positions on the u-rail track to
secure cargo.
4-7
3. Reinstall the fence and lock both
latches (1) by turning to align Q
with the arrow on the
adapter (2).
Press both adapter buttons to move
the adapters (2) on the straight part
of the u-rail.
To move the fence around the u-rail,
disconnect one side:
1. Unlock by turning the latch (1) to
align K with the arrow on the
adapter (2).
2. Press the adapter button to
move the adapters (2) to the
desired position.
Use the fence to secure items in
place.
Removing the Fence
Unlock by turning both latches (1) to
align K with the arrow on the
adapter (2). Lift and remove the
fence.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
4-8
Black plate (8,1)
Storage
Installing the Fence
Insert the fence into the adapters
and lock both latches (1) by turning
to align Q with the arrow on the
adapter (2).
Storing the Fence
1. Lift the cargo management
system cover.
2. Release the cover from the prop
rod as described in the previous
steps.
3. Insert the top of the fence into
the lower two clips (1).
4. Turn the bottom of the fence up
and insert it into the upper two
clips (2).
D-Ring Sliders
For vehicles with a D-ring system,
there are four D-ring sliders that
move along rails. These can be
used as tie-downs when storing
cargo.
Insert the D-ring sliders (1) into the
channel (2) located in the middle of
the rail. Push the button to move the
D-ring slider along the rail.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
Storage
4-9
Warning (Continued)
net. If items are not properly
stored, damage to the net could
occur and items can be thrown
about the vehicle. You or others
could be injured. Always store
items behind the net.
The loop of the D-ring slider must
be facing inward toward the storage
area and the ring must be in the up
position for proper usage.
Cargo Net
{ Warning
Do not stack items higher than
the upper end of the cargo net or
hang anything from the net. Avoid
items that have sharp edges or
that apply excessive force to the
(Continued)
If equipped, the cargo net can be
used to store light loads, keeping
them from falling over or being
thrown into the cabin during heavy
braking.
The net should not be overloaded or
used to store heavy loads.
There are four openings in the
headliner: two behind the front seats
and two behind the rear seats.
1. Insert the top corners of the
cargo net into the large opening
in the headliner and secure by
sliding them into the small
opening.
2. The rear seatbacks should be
folded down when the net is
installed in the headliner
opening behind the front seats.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
4-10
Black plate (10,1)
Storage
3. Mount the cargo net to the rear
seat tethers on the back of the
folded down rear seats and pull
on the straps to tighten the net.
4. When the net is installed in the
headliner opening behind the
rear seats, the rear seatbacks
should be upright.
5. Mount the cargo net to the cargo
tie-downs on the lower side
panels.
6. Pull on the straps to tighten
the net.
Cargo Net Storage
The cargo net can be removed from
the vehicle and stored in the cargo
management system.
1. Disconnect the net from the roof
openings and the tethers.
2. Press the red button on the
centre of the net to fold it in half.
3. Roll up the cargo net and store
in the attached vinyl bag.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
Storage
4. Open the cargo management
system cover.
5. For vehicles with an inflator kit,
store the cargo net in the
available space next to the kit.
Convenience Net
This vehicle may have a
convenience net located in the rear
of the vehicle. Attach it to the cargo
tie-downs for storing small loads.
Do not use the net to store heavy
loads.
Roof Rack System
{ Warning
If something is carried on top of
the vehicle that is longer or wider
than the roof rack - like panelling,
plywood, or a mattress - the wind
can catch it while the vehicle is
being driven. The item being
carried could be violently torn off,
and this could cause a collision
and damage the vehicle. Never
carry something longer or wider
than the roof rack on top of the
vehicle unless using a GM
certified accessory carrier.
If equipped, the roof rack can be
used to load items. For roof racks
that do not have crossrails included,
GM Certified crossrails can be
purchased as an accessory. See
your dealer for additional
information.
4-11
{ Caution
Loading cargo on the roof rack
that weighs more than 100 kg
(220 lb) or hangs over the rear or
sides of the vehicle may damage
the vehicle. Load cargo so that it
rests evenly between the
crossrails, making sure to fasten
cargo securely.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
4-12
Storage
sudden starts, sharp turns, sudden
braking, or abrupt manoeuvres;
otherwise it may result in loss of
control. If driving for a long distance,
on rough roads, or at high speeds,
occasionally stop the vehicle to
make sure the cargo remains in its
place. Do not exceed the maximum
vehicle capacity when loading the
vehicle. For more information on
vehicle capacity and loading, see
Vehicle Load Limits on page 9-8.
To prevent damage or loss of cargo
when driving, check to make sure
crossrails and cargo are securely
fastened. Loading cargo on the roof
rack will make the vehicle's centre
of gravity higher. Avoid high speeds,
Black plate (12,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Instruments and Controls
Instruments and
Controls
Controls
Steering Wheel Adjustment . . . 5-2
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . 5-2
Heated Steering Wheel . . . . . . . 5-2
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Windscreen Wiper/Washer . . . . 5-3
Rear Window Wiper/
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4
Headlamp Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Power Sockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Ashtrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Warning Lights, Gauges, and
Indicators
Warning Lights, Gauges, and
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
Mileometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Rev Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Engine Coolant Temperature
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
Seat Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . 5-12
Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . 5-13
Airbag On-Off Light . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
Charging System Light . . . . . . 5-15
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15
Brake System Warning
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18
Electric Parking Brake
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18
Service Electric Parking Brake
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
Antilock Brake System (ABS)
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
Lane Departure Warning
(LDW) Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
Vehicle Ahead Indicator . . . . . . 5-20
Traction Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
StabiliTrak® OFF Light . . . . . . . 5-20
Traction Control System
(TCS)/StabiliTrak® Light . . . . 5-21
Engine Coolant Temperature
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21
Tyre Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . 5-22
Engine Oil Pressure Light . . . . 5-22
Fuel Economy Light . . . . . . . . . 5-22
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . 5-23
Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Main-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . .
Adaptive Forward Lighting
(AFL) Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . .
Rear Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . .
Lamps On Reminder . . . . . . . . .
Cruise Control Light . . . . . . . . .
5-1
5-23
5-23
5-24
5-24
5-24
5-24
5-25
Information Displays
Driver Information
Centre (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25
Vehicle Messages
Vehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery Voltage and Charging
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake System Messages . . . .
Compass Messages . . . . . . . . .
Cruise Control Messages . . . .
Door Ajar Messages . . . . . . . . .
Engine Cooling System
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Oil Messages . . . . . . . .
Engine Power Messages . . . .
Fuel System Messages . . . . . .
Key and Lock Messages . . . . .
Lamp Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-28
5-28
5-28
5-29
5-29
5-30
5-30
5-31
5-31
5-31
5-32
5-32
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-2
Black plate (2,1)
Instruments and Controls
Object Detection System
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ride Control System
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Airbag System Messages . . . .
Security Messages . . . . . . . . . .
Service Vehicle Messages . . .
Starting the Vehicle
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tyre Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transmission Messages . . . . .
Vehicle Reminder
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle Speed Messages . . . .
Washer Fluid Messages . . . . .
5-33
5-35
5-36
5-36
5-36
Controls
Do not adjust the steering wheel
while driving.
Steering Wheel
Adjustment
Steering Wheel Controls
5-36
5-37
5-37
The infotainment system can be
operated by using the steering
wheel controls. See "Steering
Wheel Controls" in the infotainment
manual.
Heated Steering Wheel
5-38
5-38
5-38
Vehicle Personalisation
Vehicle Personalisation . . . . . . 5-38
To adjust the steering wheel:
1. Pull the lever down.
2. Move the steering wheel up
or down.
3. Pull or push the steering wheel
closer or away from you.
4. Pull the lever up to lock the
steering wheel in place.
( (Heated Steering Wheel): For
vehicles equipped with a heated
steering wheel, press to turn on or
off. A light next to the button
displays when the feature is
turned on.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Instruments and Controls
5-3
The steering wheel takes about
three minutes to start heating.
Heavy snow or ice can overload the
wiper motor.
Horn
Press a on the steering wheel pad
Wipe Parking
to sound the horn.
Windscreen Wiper/
Washer
INT (Intermittent Wipes): Use for
intermittent wipes. To adjust wipe
frequency, turn the x INT band up
for more frequent wipes or down for
less frequent wipes. If the vehicle
has Rainsense™, see the following
Rainsense information.
OFF: Use to turn the wipers off.
With the ignition in ACC/
ACCESSORY or ON/RUN/START,
move the windscreen wiper stalk to
select the wiper speed.
HI: Use for fast wipes.
LO: Use for slow wipes.
1X (Mist): For a single wipe, briefly
move the wiper lever down. For
several wipes, hold the wiper
lever down.
Clear snow and ice from the wiper
blades before using them. If frozen
to the windscreen, carefully loosen
or thaw them. Damaged blades
should be replaced. See Wiper
Blade Replacement on page 10-23.
If the ignition is changed to
STOPPING THE ENGINE/OFF
mode while the wipers are on LO,
HI, or INT, they will
immediately stop.
If the windscreen wiper lever is then
moved to off before the driver door
is opened or within 10 minutes, the
wipers will restart and move to the
base of the windscreen.
If the ignition is changed to
STOPPING THE ENGINE/OFF
while the wipers are operating due
to windscreen washing, the wipers
continue to run until they reach the
base of the windscreen.
Rainsense™
If equipped with Rainsense, a
sensor located near the top centre
of the windscreen detects the
amount of water on the windscreen
and automatically controls the
frequency of the windscreen wiper.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-4
Black plate (4,1)
Instruments and Controls
Keep this area of the windscreen
clear of debris to allow for best
system performance.
INT (Rainsense Wipe Sensitivity
Control): Move the windscreen
wiper lever to INT. Turn the x INT
band on the wiper lever to adjust the
sensitivity.
.
Turn the band up for more
sensitivity to moisture.
.
Turn the band down for less
sensitivity to moisture.
.
Move the windscreen wiper lever
out of the INT position to
deactivate Rainsense.
Wiper Arm Assembly Protection
When using an automatic car wash,
move the windscreen wiper lever to
OFF. This disables the automatic
Rainsense windscreen wipers and/
or manual windscreen wipers.
With Rainsense, if the transmission
is in N (Neutral) and the vehicle
speed is very slow, the wipers will
automatically stop at the base of the
windscreen.
The wiper operations return to
normal when the transmission is no
longer in N (Neutral) or the vehicle
speed has increased.
Windscreen Washer
Pull the windscreen wiper lever
toward you to spray windscreen
washer fluid and activate the wipers.
The wipers will continue until the
lever is released or the maximum
wash time is reached. When the
windscreen wiper lever is released,
additional wipes may occur
depending on how long the
windscreen washer had been
activated. See Washer Fluid on
page 10-18 for information on filling
the windscreen washer fluid
reservoir.
{ Warning
In freezing weather, do not use
the washer until the windscreen is
warmed. Otherwise the washer
fluid can form ice on the
windscreen, blocking your vision.
Rear Window Wiper/
Washer
The rear wiper controls are on the
end of the windscreen wiper stalk.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Instruments and Controls
ON: Press the upper portion of the
button for continuous rear window
wipes.
OFF: The rear wiper turns off when
the button is returned to the middle
position.
INT (Intermittent Rear Wipes):
Press the lower portion of the button
to set a delay between wipes.
a (Rear Washer):
Push the
windscreen wiper lever forward to
spray washer fluid on the rear
window. The lever automatically
returns to its original position when
released.
Rear Wiper Arm Assembly
Protection
When using an automatic car wash,
move the rear wiper control to OFF.
This disables the rear wiper.
If the transmission is in N (Neutral)
and the vehicle speed is very slow,
the rear wiper will automatically stop
at the base of the rear window.
The wiper operations return to
normal when the transmission is no
longer in N (Neutral) or the vehicle
speed has increased.
Reverse Gear Wipes
If the rear wiper control is off, the
rear wiper will automatically operate
continuously when the gear lever is
in R (Reverse), and the front
windscreen wiper is performing low
or high speed wipes. If the rear
wiper control is off, the gear lever is
in R (Reverse), and the front
windscreen wiper is performing
interval wipes, then the rear wiper
automatically performs interval
wipes.
This feature can be changed. See
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
The windscreen washer reservoir is
used for the windscreen and the
rear window. Check the fluid level in
the reservoir if either washer is not
working. See Washer Fluid on
page 10-18.
5-5
Headlamp Washer
If equipped with headlamp washers,
they are located to the side of the
headlamps.
The headlamps must be on in order
to use the headlamp washers. If the
headlamps are not on, only the
windscreen will be washed.
Pull the wiper lever toward you and
hold briefly to activate. The
headlamp washers will spray once,
pause, and spray again. The
headlamp washer will spray again
after five windscreen wash cycles.
To refill the windscreen washer fluid,
see Washer Fluid on page 10-18.
Clock
The infotainment system controls
are used to access the time and
date settings through the menu
system. See “Home Page” in the
infotainment manual for information
about how to use the menu system.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-6
Black plate (6,1)
Instruments and Controls
Setting the Time
Power Sockets
To set the time:
The accessory power outlets can be
used to plug in electrical equipment,
such as a cell phone or MP3 player.
1. From the Home Page, press the
SETTINGS screen button and
press Time and Date.
2. Press Set Time and press + or −
to increase or decrease hours,
minutes, and AM or PM. Press
12Hr or 24Hr for 12 or 24 hour
clock.
3. Press } to go back to the
previous menu.
The vehicle may have five
accessory power outlets.
The accessory power outlets are:
.
Below the climate control system
inside the front storage bin.
.
Inside the centre floor console.
.
On the rear of the centre floor
console. For vehicles with a rear
climate control system, there will
be two accessory power outlets
on the rear of the centre floor
console.
.
In the rear cargo area.
If auto timing is set, the time
displayed on the clock may not
update immediately when driving
into a new time zone.
To set the date:
1. Press the SETTINGS screen
button and press Time and Date.
2. Press Set Date and press + or −
to increase or decrease month,
day, or year.
These are powered while the
vehicle is in ON/RUN/START or
ACC/ACCESSORY mode, or until
the driver door is opened within
10 minutes of turning off the vehicle.
3. Press } to go back to the
previous menu.
The power outlet located in the rear
cargo area is powered at all times.
There is a small cap that must be
removed to access the accessory
power outlet. When not using the
outlet be sure to cover it with the
protective cap.
{ Caution
Leaving electrical equipment
plugged in for an extended period
of time while the vehicle is off will
drain the battery. Power is always
supplied to the rear cargo outlet.
Always unplug electrical
equipment when not in use and
do not plug in equipment that
exceeds the maximum 20 ampere
rating.
Certain accessory power plugs may
not be compatible with the
accessory power outlet and could
overload vehicle or adapter fuses.
If a problem is experienced, see
your dealer.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Instruments and Controls
When adding electrical equipment,
ensure that you follow the proper
installation instructions included with
the equipment. See Add-On
Electrical Equipment on page 9-64.
{ Caution
Hanging heavy equipment from
the power outlet can cause
damage not covered by the
vehicle warranty. The power
outlets are designed for
accessory power plugs only, such
as mobile phone charge cords.
Cigarette Lighter
There may be a cigarette lighter
under the climate control system,
inside the front storage bin.
To activate the cigarette lighter,
push it in and release. The lighter
pops out when it is ready to
be used.
{ Caution
Holding a cigarette lighter in while
it is heating does not let the
lighter back away from the
heating element when it is hot.
Damage from overheating can
occur to the lighter or heating
element, or a fuse could be
blown. Do not hold a cigarette
lighter in while it is heating.
Ashtrays
There may be an ashtray under the
climate control system on the centre
stack. Press the door to release the
ashtray.
5-7
To empty the ashtray, remove it from
the instrument panel by holding the
edges and pulling straight out. To
reinstall, push the tray back into
place.
There may also be ashtrays on the
centre floor console behind the gear
lever and in the rear doors.
{ Caution
If papers, pins, or other
flammable items are put in the
ashtray, hot cigarettes or other
smoking materials could ignite
them and possibly damage the
vehicle. Never put flammable
items in the ashtray.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-8
Instruments and Controls
Warning Lights,
Gauges, and
Indicators
Gauges can indicate when there
could be a problem with a vehicle
function. Often gauges and warning
lights work together to indicate a
problem with the vehicle.
Warning lights and gauges can
signal that something is wrong
before it becomes serious enough
to cause an expensive repair or
replacement. Paying attention to the
warning lights and gauges could
prevent injury.
When one of the warning lights
comes on and stays on while
driving, or when one of the gauges
shows there may be a problem,
check the section that explains what
to do. Follow this manual's advice.
Waiting to do repairs can be costly
and even dangerous.
Warning lights come on when there
could be a problem with a vehicle
function. Some warning lights come
on briefly when the engine is started
to indicate they are working.
Black plate (8,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
Instruments and Controls
Instrument Cluster
5-9
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-10
Black plate (10,1)
Instruments and Controls
Cluster Application Displays
Audio
The cluster has three interactive
display zones.
While the Audio application page is
displayed, press SEL to enter the
Audio menu. In the Audio menu
search for music or change the
audio source.
Use the five-way control on the right
steering wheel control to move
between the different display zones
and scroll through the different
displays.
The left and right zones display
Driver Information Centre (DIC)
information. See Driver Information
Centre (DIC) on page 5-25.
The centre zone displays
application information for
navigation, audio, phone,
or settings. A speedometer can also
be displayed in this centre zone.
Navigation
If there is no active route, a
compass will be displayed. If there
is an active route, press SEL to end
route guidance or turn the voice
prompts on or off.
Phone
While the Phone application page is
displayed, press SEL to enter the
Phone menu. In the Phone menu,
if there is no active phone call, view
recent calls, or scroll through
contacts. If there is an active call,
mute the phone or switch to handset
operation.
Settings
Press SEL while the Settings
application page is displayed to
enter the Settings menu.
Units: Press SEL while Units is
highlighted to enter the Units menu.
Choose English or metric units by
pressing SEL while the desired item
is highlighted. A checkmark will be
displayed next to the selected item.
Info Pages: Press SEL while Info
Pages is highlighted to select the
items to be displayed in the DIC
information displays. See Driver
Information Centre (DIC) on
page 5-25.
Open Source Software: Press
SEL while Open Source Software is
highlighted to display open source
software information.
Speedometer
The speedometer shows the
vehicle's speed in either kilometres
per hour (km/h) or miles per
hour (mph).
Mileometer
The odometer shows how far the
vehicle has been driven, in either
kilometres or miles.
This vehicle has a tamper-resistant
odometer. If the vehicle needs a
new cluster installed, the new
odometer is set to the mileage of
the old odometer. If this is not
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
Instruments and Controls
possible, it is set at zero and a label
is put on the driver door to show the
old mileage reading.
Trip Odometer
The trip odometer can show how far
the vehicle has been driven since
the trip odometer was last reset.
The trip odometer is accessed and
reset through the Driver Information
Centre (DIC). See Driver
Information Centre (DIC) on
page 5-25.
Caution (Continued)
not be covered by the vehicle
warranty. Do not operate the
engine with the tachometer in the
shaded warning area.
Fuel Gauge
Rev Counter
There is an arrow near the fuel
gauge pointing to the side of the
vehicle the fuel door is on.
When the indicator nears empty, the
low fuel light comes on. There still is
a little fuel left, but the vehicle
should be refuelled soon.
Here are four things that some
owners ask about. None of these
show a problem with the fuel gauge:
.
At the service station, the fuel
pump shuts off before the gauge
reads full.
.
It takes a little more or less fuel
to fill up than the gauge
indicated. For example, the
gauge may have indicated the
tank was half full, but it actually
took a little more or less than
half the tank's capacity to fill
the tank.
.
The gauge moves a little while
turning a corner or speeding up.
The tachometer displays the engine
speed in revolutions per
minute (rpm).
{ Caution
If the engine is operated with the
tachometer in the shaded warning
area, the vehicle could be
damaged and the damage would
(Continued)
When the ignition is on, the fuel
gauge indicates about how much
fuel is left in the tank.
5-11
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-12
.
Black plate (12,1)
Instruments and Controls
The gauge takes a few seconds
to stabilise after the ignition is
turned on and goes back to
empty when the ignition is
turned off.
Engine Coolant
Temperature Gauge
This gauge measures the
temperature of the vehicle's engine.
While driving under normal
operating conditions, if the needle
moves into the shaded area, the
engine is too hot. Pull off the road,
stop the vehicle, and turn off the
engine as soon as possible.
If the driver safety belt is buckled,
neither the light nor chime
comes on.
Seat Belt Reminders
Passenger Seat Belt Reminder
Light
Driver Safety Belt Reminder
Light
There is a driver seat belt reminder
light on the instrument panel cluster.
There is a passenger safety belt
reminder light near the passenger
airbag status indicator. See Airbag
On-Off Switch on page 3-25.
When the vehicle is started this light
flashes and a chime comes on to
remind drivers to fasten their safety
belt. Then the light stays on solid
until the belt is buckled. This cycle
may continue several times if the
driver remains or becomes
unbuckled while the vehicle is
moving.
When the vehicle is started this light
flashes and a chime may come on
to remind the front passenger to
fasten their safety belt. Then the
light stays on solid until the belt is
buckled. This cycle may continue
several times if the passenger
remains or becomes unbuckled
while the vehicle is moving.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (13,1)
Instruments and Controls
If the front passenger safety belt is
buckled, neither the chime nor the
light comes on.
The front passenger safety belt
warning light and chime may turn on
if an object is put on the seat such
as a briefcase, handbag, shopping
bag, laptop, or other electronic
device. To turn off the warning light
and/or chime, remove the object
from the seat or fasten the seat belt.
Second Row Passenger Belt
Reminder Light
for several seconds in the
instrument cluster to alert the driver
that passengers may need to fasten
their safety belts. After the
passenger safety belt is buckled,
the corresponding safety belt
symbol in the instrument cluster
turns green. If a safety belt is not
initially buckled, the instrument
cluster displays a grey safety belt
symbol. While the vehicle is moving,
if a second row passenger that was
previously buckled becomes
unbuckled, the corresponding safety
belt symbol will change to flashing
red and a chime may sound.
Airbag Readiness Light
Second row seating positions
monitored for safety belt use are
represented by a coloured symbol in
the Driver information Centre (DIC)
indicating safety belt status. When
the vehicle is started, three safety
belt symbols come on and stay on
This light shows if there is an
electrical problem with the airbag
system. The system check includes
the airbag sensor(s), passenger
sensing system, the pretensioners,
the airbag modules, the wiring, and
the crash sensing and diagnostic
module. For more information on the
airbag system, see Airbag System
on page 3-19.
5-13
The airbag readiness light comes on
for several seconds when the
vehicle is started. If the light does
not come on then, have it fixed
immediately.
{ Warning
If the airbag readiness light stays
on after the vehicle is started or
comes on while driving, it means
the airbag system might not be
working properly. The airbags in
the vehicle might not inflate in a
crash, or they could even inflate
without a crash. To help avoid
injury, have the vehicle serviced
right away.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-14
Black plate (14,1)
Instruments and Controls
If there is a problem with the airbag
system, a Driver Information Centre
(DIC) message may also come on.
See Airbag System Messages on
page 5-36.
Airbag On-Off Light
If the vehicle has an airbag on-off
switch, it also has a passenger
airbag status indicator located in the
overhead console.
When the vehicle is started, the
passenger airbag status indicator
symbol for on and off will light for
several seconds as a system check.
Then, after several more seconds,
the status indicator on or off symbol
will light to let you know the status
of the front passenger frontal airbag.
When the front passenger frontal
airbag is manually turned off using
the airbag on-off switch on the side
of the instrument panel, the off
symbol will come on and stay on as
a reminder that the airbag has been
turned off. This light will go off when
the airbag has been turned on. See
Airbag On-Off Switch on page 3-25
for more information, including
important safety information.
{ Warning
If the front passenger frontal
airbag is turned off for a person
who is not in a risk group
identified by the national
government, that person will not
have the extra protection of an
airbag. In a crash, the airbag will
not be able to inflate and help
protect the person sitting there.
Do not turn off the passenger
frontal airbag unless the person
sitting there is in a risk group
identified by the national
government.
{ Warning
If the airbag readiness light ever
comes on and stays on, it means
that something may be wrong
with the airbag system. For
example, the front passenger
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (15,1)
Instruments and Controls
Warning (Continued)
Charging System Light
frontal airbag could inflate even
though the airbag on-off switch is
turned off.
To help avoid injury to yourself or
others, have the vehicle serviced
right away. See Airbag Readiness
Light on page 5-13 for more
information, including important
safety information.
If the on symbol is lit, it means that
the front passenger frontal airbag is
enabled (may inflate). See Airbag
On-Off Switch on page 3-25 for
more information, including
important safety information.
If, after several seconds, both status
indicator lights remain on, or if there
are no lights at all, there may be a
problem with the lights or the airbag
on-off switch. See your retailer for
service.
5-15
If a short distance must be driven
with the light on, be sure to turn off
all accessories, such as the radio
and air conditioner.
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
The charging system light comes on
briefly when the ignition is turned
on, but the engine is not running, as
a check to show the light is working.
It should go out when the engine is
started.
If the light stays on, or comes on
while driving, there may be a
problem with the electrical charging
system. Have it checked by your
dealer. Driving while this light is on
could drain the battery.
When this light comes on, or is
flashing, the Driver Information
Centre (DIC) also displays a
message.
See Battery Voltage and Charging
Messages on page 5-28.
A computer system called OBD II
(On-Board Diagnostics-Second
Generation) monitors the operation
of the vehicle to ensure emissions
are at acceptable levels, helping to
maintain a clean environment. The
malfunction indicator lamp comes
on when the vehicle is placed in
Service Only Mode, as a check to
show it is working. If it does not,
have the vehicle serviced by your
dealer. See Ignition Positions on
page 9-14.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-16
Black plate (16,1)
Instruments and Controls
If the malfunction indicator lamp
comes on while the engine is
running, this indicates that the OBD
II system has detected a problem
and diagnosis and service might be
required.
Malfunctions often are indicated by
the system before any problem is
apparent. Being aware of the light
can prevent more serious damage
to the vehicle. This system also
assists the service technician in
correctly diagnosing any
malfunction.
{ Caution
If the vehicle is continually driven
with this light on, the emission
controls might not work as well,
the vehicle fuel economy might
not be as good, and the engine
might not run as smoothly. This
could lead to costly repairs that
might not be covered by the
vehicle warranty.
{ Caution
Modifications made to the engine,
transmission, exhaust, intake,
or fuel system of the vehicle or
the replacement of the original
tyres with other than those of the
same Tyre Performance Criteria
(TPC) can affect the vehicle's
emission controls and can cause
this light to come on.
Modifications to these systems
could lead to costly repairs not
covered by the vehicle warranty.
This could also result in a failure
to pass a required Emission
Inspection/Maintenance test. See
Accessories and Modifications on
page 10-2.
This light comes on during a
malfunction in one of two ways:
Light Flashing: A misfire condition
has been detected. A misfire
increases vehicle emissions and
could damage the emission control
system on the vehicle. Diagnosis
and service might be required.
To prevent more serious damage to
the vehicle:
.
Reduce vehicle speed.
.
Avoid hard accelerations.
.
Avoid steep uphill grades.
.
If towing a trailer, reduce the
amount of cargo being hauled as
soon as it is possible.
If the light continues to flash, find a
safe place to stop and park the
vehicle. Turn the vehicle off, wait at
least 10 seconds, and restart the
engine. If the light is still flashing,
follow the previous steps and see
your dealer for service as soon as
possible.
Light On Steady: An emission
control system malfunction has
been detected on the vehicle.
Diagnosis and service might be
required.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (17,1)
Instruments and Controls
The following may correct an
emission control system
malfunction:
.
.
Check that the fuel cap is fully
installed. See Filling the Tank on
page 9-55. The diagnostic
system can determine if the fuel
cap has been left off or
improperly installed. A loose or
missing fuel cap allows fuel to
evaporate into the atmosphere.
A few driving trips with the cap
properly installed should turn the
light off.
Check that good quality fuel is
used. Poor fuel quality causes
the engine not to run as
efficiently as designed and may
cause stalling after start-up,
stalling when the vehicle is
changed into gear, misfiring,
hesitation on acceleration,
or stumbling on acceleration.
These conditions might go away
once the engine is warmed up.
5-17
If one or more of these conditions
occurs, change the fuel brand used.
It may require at least one full tank
of the proper fuel to turn the light off.
See Recommended Fuel on
page 9-54.
If none of the above have made the
light turn off, your dealer can check
the vehicle. The dealer has the
proper test equipment and
diagnostic tools to fix any
mechanical or electrical problems
that might have developed.
The DLC is under the instrument
panel to the left of the steering
wheel. See your dealer if assistance
is needed.
The vehicle may not pass
inspection if:
.
The malfunction indicator lamp is
on with the engine running, or if
the vehicle is placed in Service
Only Mode and the malfunction
indicator lamp does not come
on. See your dealer for
assistance in verifying proper
operation of the malfunction
indicator lamp.
.
The OBD II (On-Board
Diagnostics) system determines
that critical emission control
systems have not been
completely diagnosed. The
vehicle would be considered not
Emissions Inspection and
Maintenance Programs
Depending on where you live, your
vehicle may be required to
participate in an emission control
system inspection and maintenance
program. For the inspection, the
emission system test equipment will
likely connect to the vehicle's Data
Link Connector (DLC).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-18
Black plate (18,1)
Instruments and Controls
ready for inspection. This can
happen if the 12-volt battery has
recently been replaced or run
down. The diagnostic system is
designed to evaluate critical
emission control systems during
normal driving. This can take
several days of routine driving.
If this has been done and the
vehicle still does not pass the
inspection for lack of OBD II
system readiness, your dealer
can prepare the vehicle for
inspection.
Brake System Warning
Light
The vehicle brake system consists
of two hydraulic circuits. If one
circuit is not working, the remaining
circuit can still work to stop the
vehicle. For normal braking
performance, both circuits need to
be working.
If the warning light comes on, there
is a brake problem. Have the brake
system inspected immediately.
Electric Parking Brake
Light
This light comes on briefly when the
vehicle is turned on. If it does not
come on then, have it fixed so it will
be ready to warn if there is a
problem.
If the light comes on and stays on,
there is a basic braking system
problem.
{ Warning
The brake system might not be
working properly if the brake
system warning light is on.
Driving with the brake system
warning light on can lead to a
crash. If the light is still on after
the vehicle has been pulled off
the road and carefully stopped,
have the vehicle towed for
service.
The parking brake status light
comes on when the parking brake is
applied. If the light continues
flashing after the parking brake is
released, or while driving, there is a
problem with the electric parking
brake system or another system.
A message may also display in the
Driver Information Centre (DIC).
See Brake System Messages on
page 5-28.
If the light does not come on,
or remains flashing, see your dealer.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (19,1)
Instruments and Controls
Service Electric Parking
Brake Light
This light should come on briefly
when the vehicle is in ON/RUN. If it
does not come on, have it fixed so it
will be ready to warn if there is a
problem.
If this light stays on, there is a
problem with the Electric Parking
Brake system or another system on
the vehicle that is causing the
parking brake system to work at a
reduced level. The vehicle can still
be driven, but should be taken to a
dealer as soon as possible. See the
information for the Electric Parking
Brake under Parking Brake on
page 9-27. If a message displays in
5-19
the Driver Information Centre (DIC),
see Brake System Messages on
page 5-28.
vehicle needs service. A chime may
also sound when the light comes on
steady.
Antilock Brake System
(ABS) Warning Light
If the ABS light is the only light on,
the vehicle has regular brakes, but
the anti-lock brakes are not
functioning.
If both the ABS and the brake
system warning light are on, the
vehicle's anti-lock brakes are not
functioning and there is a problem
with the regular brakes. See your
retailer for service.
This light comes on briefly when the
engine is started.
If it does not, have the vehicle
serviced by your dealer.
If the ABS light stays on, turn the
ignition off.
If the light comes on while driving,
stop as soon as it is safely possible
and turn off the vehicle. Then start
the engine again to reset the
system. If the ABS light stays on,
or comes on again while driving, the
See Brake System Warning Light on
page 5-18 and Brake System
Messages on page 5-28.
Lane Departure Warning
(LDW) Light
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-20
Black plate (20,1)
Instruments and Controls
If equipped, this light briefly comes
on while starting the vehicle.
If it does not, have the vehicle
serviced by your dealer. If the
system is working normally, the
indicator light then turns off.
This light comes on green when the
system is on and ready to operate.
When the system determines that
the vehicle is leaving its lane
without using the indicator, this light
will change to amber and flash.
See Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
on page 9-51.
Vehicle Ahead Indicator
If equipped, this light in the Driver
Information Centre (DIC) displays
green when a vehicle is detected
ahead.
This light will display amber when
you are following a vehicle ahead
much too closely.
This light and the StabiliTrak OFF
light come on when StabiliTrak is
turned off.
See Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
System on page 9-45.
If the TCS is off, wheel spin is not
limited. Adjust driving accordingly.
Traction Off Light
See Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control on page 9-29.
StabiliTrak® OFF Light
This light comes on briefly while
starting the engine. If it does not,
have the vehicle serviced by your
dealer. If the system is working
normally, the indicator light then
turns off.
The traction off light comes on when
the Traction Control System (TCS)
has been turned off by pressing and
releasing the TCS/StabiliTrak
button.
This light comes on briefly while
starting the engine. If it does not,
have the vehicle serviced by your
dealer.
This light comes on when the
StabiliTrak system is turned off.
If StabiliTrak is off, the Traction
Control System (TCS) is also off.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (21,1)
Instruments and Controls
If the StabiliTrak and TCS are off,
the system does not assist in
controlling the vehicle. Turn on the
TCS and the StabiliTrak systems
and the warning light turns off.
message may display. Check the
DIC messages to determine which
feature(s) is no longer functioning
and whether the vehicle requires
service.
See Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control on page 9-29.
If the indicator/warning light is on
and flashing, the TCS and/or the
StabiliTrak system is actively
working.
Traction Control System
(TCS)/StabiliTrak® Light
See Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control on page 9-29.
Engine Coolant
Temperature Warning
Light
5-21
If it does not, have the vehicle
serviced by the dealer. If the system
is working normally the indicator
light goes off.
{ Caution
The engine coolant temperature
warning light indicates that the
vehicle has overheated. Driving
with this light on can damage the
engine and it may not be covered
by the vehicle warranty. See
Engine Overheating on
page 10-16.
This light comes on briefly when the
engine is started.
The engine coolant temperature
warning light comes on when the
engine has overheated.
If the light does not come on, have
the vehicle serviced by your dealer.
If the system is working normally,
the indicator light turns off.
If this happens, pull over and turn
off the engine as soon as possible.
See Engine Overheating on
page 10-16.
If the light is on and not flashing, the
TCS, and potentially the StabiliTrak
system have been disabled. A DIC
This light comes on briefly while
starting the vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-22
Black plate (22,1)
Instruments and Controls
Tyre Pressure Light
For vehicles with the Tyre Pressure
Monitor System (TPMS), this light
comes on briefly when the engine is
started. It provides information
about tyre pressures and the TPMS.
When the Light Is On Steady
This indicates that one or more of
the tyres are significantly
underinflated.
A Driver Information Centre (DIC)
tyre pressure message may also
display. See Tyre Messages on
page 5-37. Stop as soon as
possible, and inflate the tyres to the
pressure value shown on the Tyre
and Loading Information label. See
Tyre Pressure on page 10-42.
When the Light Flashes First and
Then Is On Steady
If the light flashes for about a minute
and then stays on, there may be a
problem with the TPMS. If the
problem is not corrected, the light
will come on at every ignition cycle.
See Tyre Pressure Monitor
Operation on page 10-45.
Engine Oil Pressure Light
{ Caution
Lack of proper engine oil
maintenance can damage the
engine. Driving with the engine
oil low can also damage the
engine. The repairs would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty.
Check the oil level as soon as
possible. Add oil if required, but if
the oil level is within the operating
range and the oil pressure is still
low, have the vehicle serviced.
Always follow the maintenance
schedule for changing engine oil.
This light should come on briefly as
the engine is started. If it does not
come on, have the vehicle serviced
by your dealer.
If the light comes on and stays on, it
means that oil is not flowing through
the engine properly. The vehicle
could be low on oil and might have
some other system problem. See
your dealer.
Fuel Economy Light
This light is in the Driver Information
Centre (DIC) display.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (23,1)
Instruments and Controls
For vehicles with the fuel economy
mode light, it comes on when the
eco (economy) button, located next
to the shift lever, is pressed. Press
the button again to turn off the light
and exit the fuel economy mode.
See Driving for Better Fuel
Economy on page 1-18 and Fuel
Economy Mode on page 9-24 for
more information.
Low Fuel Warning Light
This light is near the fuel gauge and
comes on briefly when the ignition is
turned on as a check to show it is
working.
It also comes on when the fuel tank
is low on fuel. The light turns off
when fuel is added. If it does not,
have the vehicle serviced.
5-23
Security Light
Main-Beam On Light
The security light should come on
briefly as the engine is started. If it
does not come on, have the vehicle
serviced by your dealer. If the
system is working normally, the
indicator light turns off.
This light comes on when the
high-beam headlamps are in use.
See Headlamp Main/Dipped-Beam
Changer on page 6-3.
IntelliBeam® Light
If the light stays on and the engine
does not start, there could be a
problem with the theft-deterrent
system. See Immobiliser Operation
on page 2-18.
This light comes on when the
IntelliBeam system is enabled.
See Exterior Lamp Controls on
page 6-1.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-24
Black plate (24,1)
Instruments and Controls
Adaptive Forward
Lighting (AFL) Light
This light should come on briefly as
the vehicle is started. If it does not
come on, have the vehicle serviced
by your dealer.
This light comes on solid when
there is a problem with the AFL
system. It flashes when the system
is switching between lighting
modes. See Adaptive Forward
Lighting (AFL) on page 6-4.
Front Fog Lamp Light
Rear Fog Lamp Light
The fog lamp light comes on when
the fog lamps are in use.
This light comes on when the rear
fog lamps are in use.
The light goes out when the fog
lamps are turned off. See Front Fog
Lamps on page 6-8 for more
information.
For more information see Rear Fog
Lamps on page 6-8.
Lamps On Reminder
This light comes on when the
exterior lamps are in use. See
Exterior Lamp Controls on page 6-1.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (25,1)
Instruments and Controls
Cruise Control Light
Information Displays
Driver Information
Centre (DIC)
The cruise control light is white
when the cruise control is on and
ready, and turns green when the
cruise control is set and active.
The DIC displays are shown in the
left and right interactive display
zones on the instrument cluster. The
displays show the status of many
vehicle systems. The controls for
the DIC are on the right steering
wheel control.
See Cruise Control on page 9-32.
Adaptive Cruise Control Light
5-25
S or T :
Press the five-way control
to move between the interactive
display zones in the cluster. Press
S to go back to the previous menu.
SEL (Select): Press the centre to
open a menu or select a menu item.
Press and hold to reset values on
certain screens.
DIC Information Display
Options
The information displays on the DIC
can be turned on or off through the
Settings menu.
1. Press SEL while viewing the
Settings page in the centre
display zone on the cluster.
2. Scroll to Info Pages and
press SEL.
This light in the Driver Information
Centre (DIC) comes on when the
Adaptive Cruise Control (if
equipped) is active. See Adaptive
Cruise Control on page 9-34.
3. Press y or z to move through
the list of possible information
displays.
y or z : Press the five-way
control to move up or down in a list.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-26
Black plate (26,1)
Instruments and Controls
4. Press SEL while an item is
highlighted to select or deselect
that item. When an item is
selected, a checkmark will
appear next to it.
DIC Information Displays
The following is the list of all
possible DIC information displays.
Some of the information displays
may not be available for your
particular vehicle.
Speed: The digital speedometer
shows the vehicle speed in either
kilometres per hour (km/h) or miles
per hour (mph).
Trip 1 and Trip 2: Shows the
current distance travelled, in either
kilometers (km) or miles (mi), since
the trip odometer was last reset.
The trip odometer can be reset by
pressing and holding SEL while this
display is active.
Fuel Range: Shows the
approximate distance the vehicle
can be driven without refuelling.
LOW will be displayed when the
vehicle is low on fuel. The fuel
range estimate is based on an
average of the vehicle's fuel
economy over recent driving history
and the amount of fuel remaining in
the fuel tank.
Average Fuel Economy: Shows
the approximate average litres per
100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles
per gallon (mpg). This number is
calculated based on the number of
L/100 km (mpg) recorded since the
last time this menu item was reset.
The Average Fuel Economy can be
reset by pressing and holding SEL
while this display is active.
Instantaneous Fuel Economy:
Shows the current fuel economy in
either litres per 100 kilometers
(L/100 km) or miles per gallon
(mpg). This number reflects only the
fuel economy that the vehicle has
right now and changes frequently as
driving conditions change.
Average Speed: Shows the
average speed of the vehicle in
kilometers per hour (km/h) or miles
per hour (mph). This average is
calculated based on the various
vehicle speeds recorded since the
last reset of this value. The average
speed can be reset by pressing and
holding SEL while this display is
active.
Timer: This display can be used as
a timer. To start the timer, press SEL
while this display is active. The
display will show the amount of time
that has passed since the timer was
last reset. To stop the timer, press
SEL briefly while this display is
active and the timer is running. To
reset the timer to zero, press and
hold SEL while this display is active.
Compass: Shows the direction the
vehicle is driving.
Turn Arrow: Shows the next
manoeuvre when using route
guidance.
Travel Time: Shows the estimated
time duration remaining for the
current route.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (27,1)
Instruments and Controls
Distance to Destination: Shows
the distance to the destination when
using route guidance.
Traffic Sign Memory: Shows traffic
signs. The information for this page
comes from a roadway database.
Speed Warning: Allows the driver
to set a speed that they do not want
to exceed. To set the Speed
Warning, press SEL when Speed
Warning is displayed. Press y or
z to adjust the value. This feature
can be turned off by pressing and
holding SEL while viewing this
page. If the selected speed limit is
exceeded, a pop-up warning is
displayed with a chime.
Cruise Set Speed: Shows the
speed the cruise control or Adaptive
Cruise Control (ACC) is set to.
Follow Distance: Shows the
current following distance to the
vehicle ahead.
Battery Voltage: Shows the
current battery voltage.
Oil Life: Shows an estimate of the
oil's remaining useful life.
If REMAINING OIL LIFE 99% is
displayed, that means 99% of the
current oil life remains.
When the remaining oil life is low,
the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON
message will appear on the display.
See Engine Oil Messages on
page 5-31. The oil should be
changed as soon as possible. See
Engine Oil on page 10-6. In addition
to the engine oil life system
monitoring the oil life, additional
maintenance is recommended in the
Maintenance Schedule. See
Scheduled Maintenance on
page 11-1.
The Oil Life display must be reset
after each oil change. It will not
reset itself. Do not to reset the Oil
Life display accidentally at any time
other than when the oil has just
been changed. It cannot be reset
accurately until the next oil change.
To reset the engine oil life system,
see your dealer.
5-27
Tyre Pressure: Shows the
approximate pressures of all four
tyres. Tyre pressure is displayed in
either kilopascal (kPa) or in pounds
per square inch (psi). If the pressure
is low, the value for that tyre is
shown in amber. See Tyre Pressure
Monitor System on page 10-43 and
Tyre Pressure Monitor Operation on
page 10-45.
Vehicle Odometer: Shows the
odometer.
Blank Page: Allows for no
information to be displayed in the
DIC display zone(s).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-28
Black plate (28,1)
Instruments and Controls
Vehicle Messages
Messages displayed on the DIC
indicate the status of the vehicle or
some action that may be needed to
correct a condition. Multiple
messages may display one after the
other.
The messages that do not require
immediate action can be
acknowledged and cleared by
pressing SET/CLR. The messages
that require immediate action cannot
be cleared until that action is
performed. All messages should be
taken seriously and clearing the
messages does not correct the
problem.
The following are some of the
vehicle messages that may be
displayed depending on your
vehicle content.
Battery Voltage and
Charging Messages
BATTERY SAVER ACTIVE
This message displays when the
vehicle has detected that the battery
voltage is dropping beyond a
reasonable point. The battery saver
system starts reducing features of
the vehicle that may be noticed. At
the point that features are disabled,
this message displays. Turn off
unnecessary accessories to allow
the battery to recharge.
TRANSPORT MODE ON
This message is displayed when the
vehicle is in transport mode. Some
features can be disabled while in
this mode, including Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE), remote start,
and the vehicle alarm system. Take
the vehicle to your dealer for service
to turn transport mode off.
Brake System Messages
BRAKE FLUID LOW
LOW BATTERY
This message is displayed when the
brake fluid level is low. See Brake
Fluid on page 10-20.
This message is displayed when the
battery voltage is low. See Battery
on page 10-21.
STEP ON BRAKE TO
RELEASE PARK BRAKE
SERVICE BATTERY
CHARGING SYSTEM
This message is displayed when
there is a fault in the battery
charging system. Take the vehicle to
your dealer for service.
This message is displayed if you
attempt to release the Electric
Parking Brake without the brake
pedal applied. See Parking Brake
on page 9-27.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (29,1)
Instruments and Controls
RELEASE PARKING BRAKE
Compass Messages
This message is displayed if the
Electric Parking Brake is on while
the vehicle is in motion. See Parking
Brake on page 9-27.
Dashes may be displayed if the
vehicle temporarily loses
communication with the Global
Positioning System (GPS).
SERVICE BRAKE ASSIST
This message may be displayed
when there is a problem with the
brake boost assist system. When
this message is displayed, the brake
boost assist motor might be heard
operating and you might notice
pulsation in the brake pedal. This is
normal under these conditions. Take
the vehicle to your dealer for
service.
SERVICE HAND BRAKE
This message is displayed when
there is a problem with the parking
brake. Take the vehicle to your
dealer for service.
Cruise Control Messages
ADAPTIVE CRUISE SET
TO XXX
5-29
.
The radar is not clean. Keep the
radar sensors free of mud, dirt,
snow, ice, and slush. Clean the
entire front and/or rear of the
vehicle. For cleaning
instructions, see Exterior Care
on page 10-78.
.
Heavy rain or snow is interfering
with the radar object detection or
camera performance.
This message displays when the
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
speed is set. See Adaptive Cruise
Control on page 9-34.
CRUISE SET TO XXX
ADAPTIVE CRUISE
TEMPORARILY UNAVAILABLE
No Cruise Braking Gas Pedal
Applied
This message displays when
attempting to activate Adaptive
Cruise Control (ACC) when it is
temporarily unavailable. The ACC
system does not need service.
This message displays when
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is
active and the driver is pressing the
accelerator pedal. When this occurs,
ACC will not brake. See Adaptive
Cruise Control on page 9-34.
This can occur under the following
conditions:
This message displays when the
cruise control speed is set. See
Cruise Control on page 9-32.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-30
Black plate (30,1)
Instruments and Controls
SERVICE ADAPTIVE CRUISE
CONTROL
This message displays when the
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
needs service. Take the vehicle to
your dealer.
SHIFT TO PARK BEFORE
EXITING
This message may display if
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is
engaged holding the vehicle at a
stop, and the driver attempts to exit
the vehicle. Put the vehicle in
P (Park) before exiting.
Door Ajar Messages
DOOR OPEN
A door open symbol will be
displayed on the DIC showing which
door is open. If the vehicle has been
shifted out of P (Park), a DOOR
OPEN message will also be
displayed. Close the door
completely.
HOOD OPEN
This message will display along with
a bonnet open symbol when the
bonnet is open. Close the bonnet
completely.
If this message continues to appear,
have the system repaired by your
dealer as soon as possible to avoid
damage to the engine.
REAR ACCESS OPEN
COOLANT LEVEL LOW ADD
COOLANT
This message will display along with
a symbol when the tailgate is open.
Close the tailgate completely.
This message will display if the
coolant is low. See Engine Coolant
on page 10-12.
Engine Cooling System
Messages
A/C OFF DUE TO HIGH
ENGINE TEMP
This message displays when the
engine coolant becomes hotter than
the normal operating temperature.
To avoid added strain on a hot
engine, the air conditioning
compressor automatically turns off.
When the coolant temperature
returns to normal, the air
conditioning compressor turns back
on. The vehicle can continue to be
driven.
ENGINE OVERHEATED - IDLE
ENGINE
This message displays when the
engine coolant temperature is too
hot. Stop and allow the vehicle to
idle until it cools down.
Engine Overheated - Turn
Vehicle Off
This message displays and a
continuous chime sounds if the
engine cooling system reaches
unsafe temperatures for operation.
Stop and turn off the vehicle as
soon as it is safe to do so to avoid
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (31,1)
Instruments and Controls
severe damage. This message
clears when the engine has cooled
to a safe operating temperature.
HIGH COOLANT
TEMPERATURE
This message displays if the coolant
temperature is hot. See Engine
Overheating on page 10-16.
Engine Oil Messages
CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON
This message displays when the
engine oil needs to be changed.
When you change the engine oil, be
sure to reset the Oil Life System.
See Engine Oil Life System on
page 10-9, Driver Information
Centre (DIC) on page 5-25, Engine
Oil on page 10-6 and Scheduled
Maintenance on page 11-1.
ENGINE OIL HOT, IDLE
ENGINE
This message displays when the
engine oil temperature is too hot.
Stop and allow the vehicle to idle
until it cools down.
ENGINE OIL LOW - ADD OIL
On some vehicles, this message
displays when the engine oil level
may be too low. Check the oil level
before filling to the recommended
level. If the oil is not low and this
message remains on, take the
vehicle to your dealer for service.
See Engine Oil on page 10-6.
Engine Overheated - Turn
Vehicle Off
This message displays if low oil
pressure levels occur. Stop the
vehicle as soon as safely possible
and do not operate it until the cause
of the low oil pressure has been
corrected. Check the oil as soon as
possible and have the vehicle
serviced by your dealer.
5-31
Engine Power Messages
ENGINE POWER IS REDUCED
This message displays when the
vehicle's engine power is reduced.
Reduced engine power can affect
the vehicle's ability to accelerate.
If this message is on, but there is no
reduction in performance, proceed
to your destination. The
performance may be reduced the
next time the vehicle is driven. The
vehicle may be driven at a reduced
speed while this message is on, but
maximum acceleration and speed
may be reduced. Anytime this
message stays on, the vehicle
should be taken to your dealer for
service as soon as possible.
Fuel System Messages
FUEL LEVEL LOW
This message displays when the
vehicle is low on fuel. Refuel as
soon as possible
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-32
Black plate (32,1)
Instruments and Controls
TIGHTEN GAS CAP
This message displays when the
fuel cap is not on tight. Tighten the
fuel cap.
Key and Lock Messages
NO REMOTE DETECTED
This message displays when the
transmitter battery may be weak.
See “Starting the Vehicle with a Low
Transmitter Battery” under Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation on page 2-3.
NO REMOTE KEY WAS
DETECTED PLACE KEY IN
TRANSMITTER POCKET THEN
START YOUR VEHICLE
This message displays when trying
to start the vehicle if an RKE
transmitter is not detected. The
transmitter battery may be weak.
See “Starting the Vehicle with a Low
Transmitter Battery” under Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation on page 2-3.
NO REMOTE PRESS BRAKE
TO RESTART
This message is displayed if the
remote is no longer detected in the
vehicle. Press the brake pedal to
restart the vehicle.
NUMBER OF KEYS
PROGRAMMED
This message displays when
programming new keys to the
vehicle.
REMOTE LEFT IN VEHICLE
Lamp Messages
AFL (ADAPTIVE FORWARD
LIGHTING) LAMPS NEED
SERVICE
This message displays when the
AFL system is disabled and needs
service. See your dealer. See
Adaptive Forward Lighting (AFL) on
page 6-4.
AUTOMATIC LIGHT
CONTROL ON
This message displays when
leaving the vehicle with the RKE
transmitter still inside.
This message is displayed when the
exterior lamp control is in AUTO and
the lights have turned on. See
Twilight Sentinel on page 6-6.
REPLACE BATTERY IN
REMOTE KEY
AUTOMATIC LIGHT
CONTROL OFF
This message displays when the
battery in the RKE transmitter needs
to be replaced.
This message is displayed when the
exterior lamp control is in AUTO and
the lights have turned off. See
Twilight Sentinel on page 6-6.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (33,1)
Instruments and Controls
XXX INDICATOR FAILURE
When one of the indicators is out,
this message displays to show
which bulb needs to be replaced.
See Bulb Replacement on
page 10-25 and Replacement Bulbs
on page 10-31.
Turn Signal On
This message is displayed if the
indicator has been left on. Turn off
the indicator.
Object Detection System
Messages
AUTOMATIC COLLISION
PREP OFF
This message displays when the
Active Emergency Braking System
has been turned off. See Active
Emergency Braking System on
page 9-48.
AUTOMATIC COLLISION PREP
REDUCED
This message displays when the
Active Emergency Braking System
has been set to the "Alert" setting.
This setting disables most automatic
braking functions of the Auto
Collision Preparation feature. Some
last-second automatic braking
capability is still provided with the
"Alert" setting, but braking is less
likely to occur. See Active
Emergency Braking System on
page 9-48.
AUTOMATIC COLLISION PREP
UNAVAILABLE
This message displays when the
Active Emergency Braking System
has been unavailable for some time.
The Active Emergency Braking
System does not need service.
This can occur under the following
conditions:
.
The radar is not clean. Keep the
radar sensors free of mud, dirt,
snow, ice, and slush. Clean the
5-33
entire front and/or rear of the
vehicle. For cleaning
instructions, see Exterior Care
on page 10-78.
.
Heavy rain or snow is interfering
with the radar object detection or
camera performance.
This message may also be
displayed if there is a problem with
the StabiliTrak system.
FORWARD COLLISION
ALERT OFF
This message displays when the
Forward Collision Alert has been
turned off.
Front Camera Blocked Clean
Windscreen
This message displays when the
camera is blocked. Cleaning the
outside of the windscreen behind
the rearview mirror may correct the
issue. The Lane Departure Warning
system will not operate. Adaptive
Cruise Control (ACC), Forward
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-34
Black plate (34,1)
Instruments and Controls
Collision Alert (FCA), and the Active
Emergency Braking System may not
work or may not work as well.
LANE DEPARTURE WARNING
UNAVAILABLE
SERVICE AUTOMATIC
COLLISION PREP
If this message displays, take the
vehicle to your dealer to repair the
system.
This message displays when
attempting to activate the Lane
Departure Warning (LDW) system
when it is temporarily unavailable.
The LDW system does not need
service.
SERVICE DRIVER ASSIST
SYSTEM
This message could be due to the
camera being blocked. Cleaning the
outside of the windscreen behind
the rearview mirror may correct the
issue.
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC),
Forward Collision Alert (FCA),
Active Emergency Braking System,
Assistance Systems for Parking or
Reversing, and/or Lane Departure
Warning (LDW) system may not
work. Do not use these systems
until the vehicle has been repaired.
PARK ASSIST OFF
This message displays when the
Parking Assist system has been
turned off or when there is a
temporary condition causing the
system to be disabled.
If this message displays, take the
vehicle to your dealer to repair the
system.
SERVICE FRONT CAMERA
If this message remains on after
continued driving, the vehicle needs
service. Do not use the Lane
Departure Warning (LDW) and
Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
features. Take the vehicle to your
dealer.
SERVICE PARK ASSIST
This message displays if there is a
problem with the Parking Assist
system. Do not use this system to
help you park. See your retailer for
service.
SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT OFF
This message indicates that the
driver has turned the Side Blind
Zone Alert (SBZA) system off.
SERVICE SIDE DETECTION
SYSTEM
If this message remains on after
continued driving, the vehicle needs
service. Side Blind Zone Alert
(SBZA) and Rear Cross Traffic Alert
(RCTA) features will not work. Take
the vehicle to your dealer.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (35,1)
Instruments and Controls
SIDE DETECTION SYSTEM
UNAVAILABLE
This message indicates that Side
Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) and Rear
Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) are
disabled either because the sensor
is blocked and cannot detect
vehicles in the blind zone, or the
vehicle is passing through an open
area, such as the desert, where
there is insufficient data for
operation. This message may also
activate during heavy rain or due to
road spray. The vehicle does not
need service. For cleaning, see
"Washing the Vehicle" under
Exterior Care on page 10-78.
Ride Control System
Messages
SERVICE ALL WHEEL DRIVE
This message displays when there
is a problem with the All Wheel
Drive (AWD) system. This message
could be set by a number of issues.
Some may require service of the
AWD system some will not. The
vehicle will run in normal two-wheel
drive mode when this message has
been set. This could be caused by:
5-35
the dealer. If the message still
displays or appears again when you
begin driving, the system needs
service. See your dealer.
SERVICE STABILITRAK
This message displays if there is a
problem with the StabiliTrak system.
See Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control on page 9-29.
SERVICE SUSPENSION
SYSTEM
.
A vehicle or an AWD system
electronics problem.
.
Various vehicle electrical issues.
This message displays if there is a
problem with the selective ride
control. See Selective Ride Control
on page 9-31.
.
Worn out or overheated clutch
plates.
SERVICE TRACTION
CONTROL
Loss of fluids.
This message displays when there
is a problem with the Traction
Control System (TCS). See Traction
Control/Electronic Stability Control
on page 9-29.
.
If this message appears, stop when
convenient and turn off the ignition
for 30 seconds. Restart the vehicle
and check for the message on the
DIC display. If the message has
gone off and stays off, it is not
necessary to take your vehicle to
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-36
Black plate (36,1)
Instruments and Controls
SPORT MODE ON
Security Messages
SERVICE VEHICLE SOON
This message displays when Sport
Mode has been activated. See
Selective Ride Control on page 9-31
and Manual Mode on page 9-23.
THEFT ATTEMPTED
This message displays if there is a
problem with the vehicle. Take the
vehicle to your dealer for service.
TRACTION CONTROL OFF
Service Vehicle Messages
This message displays when the
Traction Control System (TCS) has
been turned off. See Traction
Control/Electronic Stability Control
on page 9-29.
TRACTION CONTROL ON
This message displays if the vehicle
detects a tamper condition.
SERVICE AC SYSTEM
This message displays if there is a
problem with the air conditioning
system. Take the vehicle to your
dealer for service.
This message displays when the
Traction Control System (TCS) has
been turned on. See Traction
Control/Electronic Stability Control
on page 9-29.
SERVICE POWER STEERING
Airbag System Messages
SERVICE STEERING
COLUMN LOCK
SERVICE AIRBAG
This message displays if there is a
problem with the airbag system.
Take the vehicle to your dealer for
service.
This message displays if there is a
problem with the power steering
system. Take the vehicle to your
dealer for service.
This message displays if there is a
problem with the steering column
lock. Take the vehicle to your dealer
for service.
Starting the Vehicle
Messages
PRESS BRAKE TO START
VEHICLE
This message is displayed when
attempting to start the vehicle
without first pressing the brake
pedal.
SERVICE KEYLESS START
SYSTEM
This message is displayed if there is
a problem with the pushbutton start
system. Take the vehicle to your
dealer for service.
TURN STEERING WHEEL
START VEHICLE AGAIN
This message may display when
you try to start the vehicle, but the
column remains locked. Try turning
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (37,1)
Instruments and Controls
the steering wheel while starting the
vehicle to unlock the steering
column. If the vehicle still does not
start, turn the steering wheel the
other way, and try starting the
vehicle again.
Tyre Messages
SERVICE TYRE MONITOR
SYSTEM
This message displays if there is a
problem with the Tyre Pressure
Monitor System (TPMS). See Tyre
Pressure Monitor Operation on
page 10-45.
TYRE LEARNING ACTIVE
This message displays when the
system is learning new tyres. See
Tyre Pressure Monitor Operation on
page 10-45.
TYRE LOW ADD AIR TO TYRE
This message displays when the
pressure in one or more of the tyres
is low.
This message also displays LEFT
FRONT, RIGHT FRONT, LEFT
REAR, or RIGHT REAR to indicate
the location of the low tyre.
The low tyre pressure warning light
will also come on. See Tyre
Pressure Light on page 5-22.
If a tyre pressure message appears
on the DIC, stop as soon as you
can. Inflate the tyres by adding air
until the tyre pressure is equal to the
values shown on the Tyre and
Loading Information label. See
Tyres on page 10-40, Vehicle Load
Limits on page 9-8, and Tyre
Pressure on page 10-42.
You can receive more than one tire
pressure message at a time. The
DIC also shows the tire pressure
values. See Driver Information
Centre (DIC) on page 5-25.
5-37
Transmission Messages
SERVICE TRANSMISSION
This message displays if there is a
problem with the transmission. See
your dealer.
SHIFT DENIED
This message displays when using
the Driver Shift Control (DSC) and
attempting to shift to a gear not
appropriate for the vehicle speed
and engine revolutions per minute
(rpm). See Manual Mode on
page 9-23.
SHIFT TO PARK
This message displays when the
transmission needs to be shifted to
P (Park). This may appear when
attempting to remove the key from
the vehicle if the vehicle is not in
P (Park).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-38
Black plate (38,1)
Instruments and Controls
TRANSMISSION HOT - IDLE
ENGINE
This message displays and a chime
sounds if the transmission fluid in
the vehicle gets hot. Driving with the
transmission fluid temperature high
can cause damage to the vehicle.
Stop the vehicle and let it idle to
allow the transmission to cool. This
message clears when the fluid
temperature reaches a safe level.
Vehicle Reminder
Messages
ICE POSSIBLE DRIVE
WITH CARE
This message is displayed when ice
conditions are possible.
TURN WIPER CONTROL TO
INTERMITTENT FIRST
This message is displayed when
attempting to adjust the intermittent
wiper speed without intermittent
selected on the wiper control. See
Windscreen Wiper/Washer on
page 5-3.
Vehicle
Personalisation
Vehicle Speed Messages
Use the audio system controls to
access the personalisation menus
for customising vehicle features.
SELECTED SPEED LIMIT
EXCEEDED
This message is displayed when the
vehicle speed is greater than the set
speed. See "Speed Warning" under
Driver Information Centre (DIC) on
page 5-25.
The following are all possible
personalisation features. Depending
on the vehicle, some may not be
available.
Infotainment System Audio
System Controls
Washer Fluid Messages
To access the
personalisation menu:
WASHER FLUID LOW ADD
FLUID
1. Press SETTINGS on the Home
page on the infotainment system
display.
This message may display when the
washer fluid level is low. See
Washer Fluid on page 10-18.
2. Press the desired feature to
display a list of available
options.
3. Press to select the desired
feature setting.
4.
Press the [ Back screen button
to return to the previous menu.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (39,1)
Instruments and Controls
Personalisation Menus
The following list of menu items may
be available:
.
Time and Date
.
Language [Language]
.
Valet Mode
.
Radio
.
Vehicle
.
Bluetooth
.
Voice
.
Display
.
Rear Camera
.
Return to Factory Settings
.
Software Information
Each menu is detailed in the
following information.
Time and Date
Manually set the time and date. See
Clock on page 5-5.
Language [Language]
Select Language, then select from
the available language(s).
The selected language will display
on the system, and voice
recognition will reflect the selected
language.
Valet Mode
This will lock the infotainment
system, the infotainment controls,
and screen storage location.
To turn Valet Mode on and off, Enter
a four-digit code on the keypad.
Press Enter to go to the
confirmation screen. Re-enter the
four-digit code. Press LOCK to lock
the system. Enter the four-digit code
to unlock the system. Press the
Back screen button to go back to
the previous menu.
Radio
Press to display the Radio Menu
and the following may display:
.
Manage Favourites
5-39
.
Number of Favourites Pages
.
Audible Touch Feedback
.
Bose Audio Pilot
.
Maximum Start Up Volume
Manage Favourites
This allows favourites to be edited.
See “Manage Favourites in
“Settings” under “Radio” in the
infotainment manual.
Number of Favourites Pages
Press to set the number of
favourites to display.
Select the desired number or select
Auto and the infotainment system
will automatically adjust the number
of favourite shown.
Audible Touch Feedback
This allows Audible Touch
Feedback to be turned on or off.
Select Off or On.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-40
Black plate (40,1)
Instruments and Controls
Remote Lock, Unlock, Start
Bose Audio Pilot
.
This feature adjusts the volume
based on the noise in the vehicle.
See “Bose AudioPilot Noise
Compensation Technology” under
“Infotainment System Settings” in
the infotainment manual.
Climate and Air Quality
Select and the following may
display:
Auto Compartment Zone Temp
This feature allows for selection of
the compartment zone temperature
setting when the vehicle is
restarted.
.
Auto Fan Max Speed
.
Air Quality Sensor
Select Single Zone, Dual Zone,
or Last Setting.
Maximum Startup Volume
.
Auto Compartment Zone Temp
Remote Start Auto Seat Cool
This feature sets the maximum
startup volume. If the vehicle is
started and the volume is greater
than this level, the volume is
adjusted to this level. To set the
maximum startup volume, press +
or − to increase or decrease.
.
Remote Start Auto Seat Cool
.
Remote Start Auto Heated Seats
.
Auto Demist
When on, this feature will turn the
cooled seats on when using remote
start on warm days.
Vehicle
Select and the following may
display:
.
Climate and Air Quality
.
Collision/Detection Systems
.
Comfort and Convenience
.
Lighting
.
Power Door Locks
Auto Fan Max Speed
This feature will set the maximum
auto fan speed.
Select Low, Medium, or High.
Air Quality Sensor
This allows for selection of air
quality sensor operation at high or
low sensitivity.
Select Off, Low Sensitivity, or High
Sensitivity.
Select Off or On.
Remote Start Auto Heated Seats
When on, this feature will turn the
heated seats on when using remote
start on cold days.
Select Off or On.
Auto Demist
When set to On, the front defog will
automatically come on when the
vehicle is started.
Select Off or On.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (41,1)
Instruments and Controls
Collision/Detection Systems
Select the Collision/Detection
Systems menu and the following
may display, if equipped:
.
Alert Type
.
Auto Collision Preparation
.
Go Notifier
.
Side Blind Zone Alert
.
Rear Cross Traffic Alert
Alert Type
This feature will set crash alerts to
beeps or seat vibrations. This
setting affects all crash alerts
including Forward Collision , Lane
Departure Warning , Adaptive
Cruise Control , Parking Assist , and
Reversing Warning alerts.
Select Beeps or Safety Alert Seat.
See Driver Assistance Systems on
page 9-42.
Auto Collision Preparation
This feature will turn on or off the
Forward Collision Alert feature as
well as the Automatic Braking
capability of the Auto Collision
Preparation feature. With the Alert &
Brake setting, both Forward
Collision Alert as well as the
Automatic Braking capability of the
Auto Collision Preparation feature
are available. The Alert setting
disables most automatic braking
functions of the Auto Collision
Preparation feature. Some
last-second automatic braking
capability is still provided with the
Alert setting, but it is much less
likely to be triggered by most driving
conditions. Off disables all Forward
Collision Alert and Automatic
Braking capabilities of the Auto
Collision Preparation feature. See
Active Emergency Braking System
on page 9-48.
Select Off, Alert & Brake, or Alert.
Go Notifier
This feature will give a reminder that
Adaptive Cruise Control provides
when it has brought the vehicle to a
complete stop behind another
5-41
stopping vehicle, and then that
vehicle drives on. See Adaptive
Cruise Control on page 9-34.
Select Off or On.
Side Blind Zone Alert
This allows the Side Blind Zone
Alert feature to be turned on or off.
See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)
on page 9-50.
Select Off or On.
Rear Cross Traffic Alert
This allows the Rear Cross Traffic
Alert feature to be turned on or off.
See Assistance Systems for Parking
or Reversing on page 9-43.
Select Off or On.
Comfort and Convenience
Select the Comfort and
Convenience menu and the
following may display:
.
Auto Memory Recall
.
Easy Exit Options
.
Chime Volume
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-42
Black plate (42,1)
Instruments and Controls
.
Reverse Tilt Mirror
.
Rain Sense Wipers
.
Auto Wipe in Reverse Gear
Auto Memory Recall
This allows the Auto Memory Recall
feature to be turned on or off.
Select Off, On, On - Driver Door
Open, or On - At Ignition On. See
Memory Seats on page 3-6.
Easy Exit Options
This allows the Easy Exit Options
feature to be turned on or off.
shifted to R (Reverse) to improve
visibility of the ground near the rear
wheels. They will return to their
previous driving position when the
vehicle is shifted out of R (Reverse)
or the engine is turned off.
Select Off, On, On - Driver and
Passenger, On - Driver, or On Passenger.
Rain Sense Wipers
This allows the Rain Sense Wipers
feature to be disabled or enabled.
Select Disabled or Enabled.
Select Off or On.
Auto Wipe in Reverse Gear
See Memory Seats on page 3-6.
This allows the selection of the
chime volume level.
When on, and the front windscreen
wipers are on, the rear window
wiper will turn on automatically
when the vehicle is shifted into
R (Reverse).
Press + or − to adjust the volume.
Select On or Off.
Reverse Tilt Mirror
Lighting
When on, both the driver and
passenger outside mirrors will tilt
downward when the vehicle is
Select the Lighting menu and the
following may display:
Chime Volume
.
Vehicle Locator Lights
.
Exit Lighting
.
Auto Main Beam Assist
Vehicle Locator Lights
This feature will flash the exterior
lamps when K on the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter is
pressed to locate the vehicle.
Select Off or On.
Exit Lighting
This allows the selection of how
long the exterior lamps stay on
when leaving the vehicle when it is
dark outside.
Select Off, 30 Seconds, 60
Seconds, or 120 Seconds.
Auto Main Beam Assist
When on, the IntelliBeam system
will turn the vehicle's main beam
headlamps on and off according to
the surrounding traffic conditions.
See “IntelliBeam System” in Exterior
Lamp Controls on page 6-1.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (43,1)
Instruments and Controls
Select Off or On. On some vehicles
select Off, Normal Sensitivity,
or Low Sensitivity.
Power Door Locks
Select Power Door Locks and the
following may display:
5-43
Delayed Door Lock
Remote Lock Feedback
When on, this feature will delay the
locking of the doors. To override the
delay, press the power door lock
switch on the door.
This allows selection of what type of
feedback is given when locking the
vehicle with the RKE transmitter.
Select Off or On.
Select Off, Lights and Horn, Lights
Only, or Horn Only.
.
Unlocked Door Anti Lock Out
Remote Lock, Unlock, Start
Remote Door Unlock
.
Auto Door Unlock
.
Delayed Door Lock
Select Remote Lock, Unlock, Start
and the following may display:
This allows selection of which doors
will unlock when pressing K on the
RKE transmitter.
Unlocked Door Anti Lock Out
When on, this feature will keep the
driver door from locking when the
door is open. If Off is selected, the
Delayed Door Lock menu will be
available.
Select Off or On.
Auto Door Unlock
This allows selection of which of the
doors will automatically unlock when
the vehicle is shifted into P (Park).
Select Off, All Doors, or Driver Door.
.
Remote Unlock Light Feedback
.
Remote Lock Feedback
.
Remote Door Unlock
.
Remote Start Auto Cool Seats
.
Remote Start Auto Heat Seats
.
Passive Door Unlock
.
Passive Door Lock
.
Remote Left in Vehicle Reminder
Remote Unlock Light Feedback
When on, the exterior lamps will
flash when unlocking the vehicle
with the RKE transmitter.
Select Off or Flash Lights.
Select All Doors or Driver
Door Only.
Remote Start Auto Cool Seats
If equipped and turned on, this
feature will turn the ventilated seats
on when using remote start on
warm days.
Select Off or On. On some vehicles
select Off, On - Driver and
Passenger, or On - Driver.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-44
Black plate (44,1)
Instruments and Controls
Remote Start Auto Heat Seats
Remote Left in Vehicle Reminder
Ringtones
If equipped and turned on, this
feature will turn the heated seats on
when using remote start on
cold days.
This feature sounds an alert when
the RKE transmitter is left in the
vehicle.
Press to change the ring tone for
the specific phone. The phone does
not need to be connected to change
the ring.
Select Off or On. On some vehicles
select Off, On - Driver and
Passenger, or On - Driver.
Passive Door Unlock
This allows the selection of what
doors will unlock when using the
button on the driver door to unlock
the vehicle.
Select All Doors or Driver
Door Only.
Passive Door Lock
This feature can be turned on or off
or used to select feedback when
using the button on the driver door
to lock the vehicle. See Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation on page 2-3.
Select On, On with Horn Chirp,
or Off.
Select Off or On.
Bluetooth
Voice Mail Numbers
.
Pair New Device
.
Device Management
.
Ringtones
This feature displays the voice mail
number for all connected phones.
The voice mail number may be
changed by selecting EDIT or
pressing the EDIT button and typing
in a new number, then select SAVE
or press the SAVE button.
.
Voice Mail Numbers
Voice
Select and the following may
display:
Pair New Device
Select to pair a new device. See
“Pairing” in “Infotainment Controls”
under Bluetooth in the infotainment
manual.
Device Management
Select to connect to a different
phone source, disconnect a phone,
or delete a phone.
Select and the following may
display:
.
Confidence Threshold
.
Prompt Length
.
Audio Feedback Speed
Confidence Threshold
This feature allows the adjustment
of the sensitivity of the speech
recognition system.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (45,1)
Instruments and Controls
Select Confirm More or
Confirm Less.
5-45
Calibrate Touchscreen
Restore Vehicle Settings
Select to calibrate the touchscreen,
then follow the prompts.
This allows selection of restoring
vehicle settings.
Turn Display Off
Select Cancel or Restore.
Clear All Private Data
Audio Feedback Speed
Select to turn the display off. Press
anywhere on the display area or any
faceplate button to turn the
display on.
This feature adjusts the audio
feedback speed.
Rear Camera
Prompt Length
This feature adjusts the voice
prompt length.
Select Short or Long.
Select Slow, Medium, or Fast.
Display
Select and the following may
display:
.
Mode
.
Calibrate Touchscreen
.
Turn Display Off
Mode
Select to change the display screen
for day or night driving.
Select Auto, Day, or Night.
This allows for Rear Camera
Display, Rear Park Assist Symbols,
Guidance Lines, and Rear Cross
Traffic Alert to be turned off or on.
Select Off or On for the desired
feature.
See Driver Assistance Systems on
page 9-42.
Return to Factory Settings
Select and the following may
display:
.
Restore Vehicle Settings
.
Clear All Private Data
.
Restore Radio Settings
This allows selection to clear all
private information from the vehicle.
Select Cancel or Delete.
Restore Radio Settings
This allows selection to restore
radio settings.
Select Cancel or Restore.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
5-46
Instruments and Controls
2 NOTES
Black plate (46,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Lighting
Lighting
Interior Lighting
Exterior Lighting
Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . .
Headlamp Main/Dipped-Beam
Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Daytime Running
Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adaptive Forward
Lighting (AFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Headlamp Levelling Control . . .
Twilight Sentinel . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hazard Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Turn and Lane-Change
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-1
6-3
6-3
6-4
6-4
6-5
6-6
6-7
6-7
6-8
6-8
Instrument Panel Illumination
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Cargo Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Courtesy Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
6-1
Exterior Lighting
Exterior Lamp Controls
Lighting Features
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Battery Load Management . . . 6-10
Battery Power Protection . . . . 6-11
Exterior Lighting Battery
Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
The exterior lamp control is on the
instrument panel to the outboard
side of the steering column.
Turn the control to the following
positions:
O (Off): Briefly turn to this position
to turn the automatic light control off
or on again.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
6-2
Black plate (2,1)
Lighting
AUTO (Automatic): Automatically
turns the exterior lamps on and off,
depending on outside lighting.
; (Parking Lamps):
Turns on the
parking lamps including all lamps,
except the headlamps.
3 (Headlamps): Turns on the
headlamps together with the parking
lamps and instrument panel lights.
A warning chime sounds if the driver
door is opened when the ignition
switch is off and the headlamps
are on.
# / s (Front and Rear Fog
The system turns the main beam
headlamps on when it is dark
enough and there is no other traffic
present.
This light comes on in the
instrument cluster when the
IntelliBeam system is enabled.
Turning On and Enabling
IntelliBeam
See Front Fog Lamps on page 6-8
and Rear Fog Lamps on page 6-8.
To enable the IntelliBeam system,
with the indicator lever in the neutral
position, turn the exterior lamp
control to AUTO. The blue main
beam on light appears on the
instrument cluster when the main
beams are on.
IntelliBeam System
If equipped, this system turns the
vehicle's main beam headlamps on
and off according to surrounding
traffic conditions.
The system only activates the main
beams when driving over 40 km/h
(25 mph).
There is a sensor near the top
centre of the windscreen that
automatically controls the system.
Keep this area of the windscreen
clear of debris to allow for best
system performance.
Lamps): Press to turn the fog
lamps on or off.
®
Driving with IntelliBeam
The main beam headlamps remain
on, under the automatic control,
until one of the following situations
occurs:
.
The system detects an
approaching vehicle's
headlamps.
.
The system detects a preceding
vehicle's tail lamps.
.
The outside light is bright
enough that main beam
headlamps are not required.
.
The vehicle's speed drops below
20 km/h (12 mph).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Lighting
.
The IntelliBeam system can be
disabled by the Main/dipped
beam Changer or the
Flash-to-Pass feature. If this
happens, the Main/dipped beam
Changer must be activated two
times within five seconds to
reactivate the IntelliBeam
system. The instrument cluster
light will come on to indicate the
IntelliBeam is reactivated. See
Headlamp Main/dipped beam
Changer on page 6-3 or
Flash-to-Pass on page 6-3.
The main beams may not turn off
automatically if the system cannot
detect another vehicle's lamps
because of any of the following:
.
.
The other vehicle's lamps are
missing, damaged, obstructed
from view, or otherwise
undetected.
The other vehicle's lamps are
covered with dirt, snow, and/or
road spray.
.
The other vehicle's lamps cannot
be detected due to dense
exhaust, smoke, fog, snow, road
spray, mist, or other airborne
obstructions.
.
The vehicle's windscreen is dirty,
cracked, or obstructed by
something that blocks the view
of the light sensor.
.
The vehicle is loaded such that
the front end points upward,
causing the light sensor to aim
high and not detect headlamps
and tail lamps.
.
Driving on winding or hilly roads.
The main beam headlamps may
need to be disabled if any of the
above conditions exist.
This feature can be turned on or off
in vehicle personalisation. See
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
6-3
Headlamp Main/
Dipped-Beam Changer
Push the indicator lever away from
you and release to turn the main
beams on. To return to dipped
beams, push the stalk again or pull
it toward you and release.
This indicator light turns on in the
instrument cluster when the
high-beam headlamps are on.
Flash-to-Pass
The flash-to-pass feature works with
the dipped beams on or off.
To flash the main beams, pull the
indicator lever all the way toward
you, then release it.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
6-4
Black plate (4,1)
Lighting
Daytime Running
Lamps (DRL)
on. The main beam headlamps, tail
lamps, sidemarker, instrument panel
and other lamps will not be on.
headlamps to provide greater road
illumination in various driving
conditions.
If equipped, DRL can make it easier
for others to see the front of your
vehicle during the day.
The headlamps automatically
change from DRL to the regular
headlamps depending on the
darkness of the surroundings. The
other lamps that come on with the
headlamps will also come on.
To enable AFL, set the exterior lamp
control to the AUTO position. To
disable, move the control out of
AUTO. AFL will operate when the
vehicle speed is greater than 3 km/h
(2 mph). AFL will not operate in
R (Reverse). The vehicle must be
driven a short distance for AFL to
operate. See Exterior Lamp
Controls on page 6-1.
A light sensor on top of the
instrument panel makes the DRL
work, so be sure it is not covered.
The DRL system makes the dipped
beam headlamps come on at a
reduced brightness or for vehicles
with High Intensity Discharge (HID)
headlamps, the DRL lights will come
on when the following conditions
are met:
.
The ignition is in the ON/
RUN mode.
.
The exterior lamp control is
in AUTO.
.
The engine is running.
.
The vehicle is not in P (Park).
When the DRL are on, only the
dipped beam headlamps, at a
reduced level of brightness, will be
When it is bright enough outside,
the headlamps go off and the DRL
come on.
To turn the DRL lamps off or on
again, turn the exterior lamp control
to the off position and then release.
This vehicle may have a DRL
disabling function. When the DRL
are on and an indicator is activated,
the DRL on that side will be off until
the indicator goes off.
Adaptive Forward
Lighting (AFL)
For vehicles with uplevel
headlamps, the Adaptive Forward
Lighting System (AFL) adjusts the
Curve Lighting
The light beam pivots based on the
steering wheel position and vehicle
speed of at least 10 km/h (6 mph).
The headlamps shine at an angle of
up to 15 degrees to the right or left
of the direction of travel.
Motorway Lighting
If the vehicle is travelling straight
continuously at high speeds, the
light beam automatically raises
slightly to increase the headlamp
range.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Lighting
City Lighting
If the vehicle speed is less than
50 km/h (31 mph), the headlamp
range is automatically reduced.
Headlamp Levelling
Control
For reducing glare to oncoming
traffic when driving a left hand drive
vehicle in a right hand drive country
or vice versa. To activate tourist
lighting:
1. Pull the indicator lever toward
you and hold.
2. Turn the ignition on.
4. Release the stalk.
Each time the ignition is turned on,
the AFL indicator will flash.
To deactivate tourist lighting, repeat
the steps. The AFL indicator will not
flash when tourist lighting has been
deactivated.
9 (Headlamp Levelling):
Move
the thumbwheel up or down to
adjust the headlamps.
Correct adjustment of the headlamp
level can reduce the glare for other
drivers.
Tourist Lighting
3. Wait for three seconds or until
the AFL indicator flashes and a
sound is heard.
6-5
Manual Headlamp Levelling
Control
For vehicles with manual headlamp
levelling control, the thumbwheel is
on the exterior lamp control. This
feature lets the headlamp level be
adjusted to suit the vehicle load.
The dipped beam headlamps must
be on to adjust the headlamp level.
.
Front seats occupied = 0.
.
All seats occupied = 1.
.
All seats occupied and luggage
compartment load = 2.
.
Driver seat occupied and
luggage compartment load = 3.
Automatic Headlamp Levelling
Control
For vehicles with High Intensity
Discharge (HID) headlamps, the
level of the headlamps is adjusted
automatically based on vehicle load.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
6-6
Lighting
Twilight Sentinel
This feature automatically turns the
lamps on and off. A light sensor on
top of the instrument panel makes
the Twilight Sentinel® work, so be
sure it is not covered.
With Twilight Sentinel the following
will happen:
.
.
Black plate (6,1)
When it is dark enough outside,
the headlamps and parking
lamps come on. The other lamps
that come on with the
headlamps also come on.
When it is bright enough outside,
the headlamps go off, as long as
the exterior lamp switch is in the
AUTO position.
If the vehicle is started in a dark
garage, the automatic headlamp
system comes on immediately. If it
is light outside when the vehicle
leaves the garage, there is a slight
delay before the automatic
headlamp system changes. During
that delay, the instrument panel
cluster may not be as bright as
usual. Make sure the instrument
panel brightness control is in full
bright position. See Instrument
Panel Illumination Control on
page 6-9.
The vehicle can be idled with the
lamps off, even when it is dark
outside. After starting the vehicle,
turn the exterior lamp control to off,
then release it. The lamps will
remain off until the control is turned
to off again.
Twilight Sentinel also provides
exterior illumination as you leave
the vehicle until:
.
The exterior lamp control is
moved from O to the parking
lamp position, or
.
The delay time selected has
elapsed.
See Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38 to select the delay time
or no delay time.
If the ignition is turned off with the
exterior lamp control in the parking
lamp or headlamp position, the
Twilight Sentinel delay will not
occur. The lamps will turn off as
soon as the control is turned off.
The regular headlamp system
should be turned on when needed.
Lights On with Wipers
If the windscreen wipers are
activated in daylight with the engine
on, and the exterior lamp control is
in AUTO, the headlamps, parking
lamps, and other exterior lamps
come on. The transition time for the
lamps coming on varies based on
wiper speed. When the wipers are
not operating, these lamps turn off.
Move the exterior lamp control to P
or ; to disable this feature.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Lighting
Hazard Lights
Turn and Lane-Change
Signals
6-7
Raise or lower the lever until the
arrow starts to flash to signal a lane
change. The indicator flashes three
times.
The stalk returns to its starting
position when it is released.
If after signalling a turn or lane
change the arrow flashes rapidly or
does not come on, a signal bulb
may be burned out.
Move the lever all the way up or
down to signal a turn.
| (Hazard Warning Indicators):
Press this button on the instrument
panel, to make the front and rear
indicator lamps flash on and off.
This warns others that you are
having trouble. Press again to turn
the flashers off.
An arrow on the instrument cluster
will flash in the direction of the turn
or lane change.
Replace any burned out bulbs. If a
bulb is not burned out, check the
fuse. See Fuses and Circuit
Breakers on page 10-32.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
6-8
Black plate (8,1)
Lighting
Front Fog Lamps
# (Front Fog Lamps): Press to
turn the fog lamps on or off. An
indicator light on the instrument
cluster comes on when the fog
lamps are on.
Rear Fog Lamps
The fog lamps come on together
with the parking lamps.
In Scandinavian countries, the front
fog lamps will turn off while the
dipped beam headlamps are in use.
The front fog lamp button is on the
exterior lamp control, on the
outboard side of the steering wheel.
The ignition and the dipped beam
headlamps must be on to turn on
the fog lamps.
Some localities have laws that
require the headlamps to be on
along with the fog lamps.
The rear fog lamp button is on the
exterior lamp control, on the
outboard side of the steering wheel.
The ignition and the front fog lamps
or headlamps must be on to turn the
rear fog lamps on.
s (Rear Fog Lamps):
Press to
turn the rear fog lamps on or off. An
indicator light on the instrument
cluster comes on when the rear fog
lamps are on.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
Lighting
Interior Lighting
Cargo Lamp
Instrument Panel
Illumination Control
The cargo lamp is located in the
rear compartment and is controlled
by the dome lamp. See Dome
Lamps on page 6-9.
6-9
Courtesy Lamps
The courtesy lamps come on
automatically when any door is
opened and the dome lamp is in the
door position.
The brightness of the instrument
panel lights and steering wheel
controls can be adjusted.
D (Instrument Panel
Brightness): Move and hold the
thumbwheel up or down to brighten
or dim the lights.
Dome Lamps
To change the dome lamp settings,
press the following:
The dome lamp is in the overhead
console.
* (Dome Lamp Override): Turns
the lamp off, even when a door
is open.
1 (Door): The lamp comes on
when a door is opened.
+ (On):
Turns the dome lamp on.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
6-10
Black plate (10,1)
Lighting
Reading Lamps
There are reading lamps in the
overhead console and over the rear
passenger doors. These lamps
come on automatically when any
door is opened.
To manually turn the reading lamps
on or off:
.
Press m or n next to each
overhead console reading lamp.
.
Press the lamp lens on the rear
passenger reading lamps.
Lighting Features
Entry Lighting
The headlamps, tail lamps, number
plate lamps, interior lamps, and
most of the interior lights turn on
briefly at night, or in areas with
limited lighting, when K is pressed
on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
transmitter. After about 30 seconds
the exterior lamps turn off, and then
the dome and remaining interior
lights dim to off. The entry lighting
can be manually turned off by
changing the ignition out of the off
position, or by pressing Q on the
RKE transmitter.
This feature can be changed. See
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Exit Lighting
The headlamps, tail lamps, parking
lamps, and number plate lamps
come on at night, or in areas with
limited lighting, when a door is
opened after the ignition is turned
off. The dome lamps also come on
when the driver door is opened after
the ignition is changed to the off
position.
The exterior lamps and dome lamp
remain on after the door is closed
for a set amount of time, then
automatically turn off.
The exterior lamps turn off
immediately by turning the exterior
lamps control to off.
This feature can be changed. See
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Battery Load
Management
The vehicle has Electric Power
Management (EPM) that estimates
the battery's temperature and state
of charge. It then adjusts the voltage
for best performance and extended
life of the battery.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
Lighting
When the battery's state of charge
is low, the voltage is raised slightly
to quickly bring the charge back up.
When the state of charge is high,
the voltage is lowered slightly to
prevent overcharging. If the vehicle
has a voltmeter gauge or a voltage
display on the Driver Information
Centre (DIC), you may see the
voltage move up or down. This is
normal. If there is a problem, an
alert will be displayed.
The battery can be discharged at
idle if the electrical loads are very
high. This is true for all vehicles.
This is because the generator
(alternator) may not be spinning fast
enough at idle to produce all of the
power needed for very high
electrical loads.
A high electrical load occurs when
several of the following are on, such
as: headlamps, high beams, fog
lamps, rear window defogger,
climate control fan at high speed,
heated seats, engine cooling fans,
trailer loads, and loads plugged into
accessory power outlets.
EPM works to prevent excessive
discharge of the battery. It does this
by balancing the generator's output
and the vehicle's electrical needs.
It can increase engine idle speed to
generate more power whenever
needed. It can temporarily reduce
the power demands of some
accessories.
Normally, these actions occur in
steps or levels, without being
noticeable. In rare cases at the
highest levels of corrective action,
this action may be noticeable to the
driver. If so, a DIC message might
be displayed and it is recommended
that the driver reduce the electrical
loads as much as possible. See
Battery Voltage and Charging
Messages on page 5-28.
Battery Power Protection
The battery saver feature is
designed to protect the vehicle's
battery.
6-11
If some interior lamps are left on
and the ignition is turned off, the
battery rundown protection system
automatically turns the lamp off after
some time.
Exterior Lighting Battery
Saver
The exterior lamps turn off about
10 minutes after the ignition is
turned off, if the parking lamps or
headlamps have been manually left
on. This protects against draining
the battery. To restart the 10-minute
timer, turn the exterior lamp control
to the off position and then back to
the parking lamp or headlamp
position.
To keep the lamps on for more than
10 minutes, the ignition must be in
the ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN
position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
6-12
Lighting
2 NOTES
Black plate (12,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Infotainment System
Infotainment
System
Introduction
Infotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
Introduction
Infotainment
See the infotainment manual for
information on the radio, audio
players, phone, navigation system,
and voice or speech recognition.
It also includes information on
settings and downloadable
applications (if equipped).
7-1
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
7-2
Infotainment System
2 NOTES
Black plate (2,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Climate Controls
Climate Controls
Climate Control Systems
Dual Automatic Climate Control System
Climate Control Systems
Dual Automatic Climate Control
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
Rear Climate Control
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
The climate control buttons and the touch screen are used to adjust the
heating, cooling, and ventilation.
Air Vents
Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Maintenance
Passenger Compartment Air
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Climate Control Buttons
1. Driver and Passenger
Temperature Controls
5. AUTO (Automatic Operation)
2. Fan Control
7. Rear Window Demister
3. OFF (Fan)
8. Recirculation
4. Driver and Passenger Heated
and Ventilated Seats (If
Equipped)
6. Defrost
8-1
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
8-2
Black plate (2,1)
Climate Controls
Climate Control Touch Screen
The fan, air delivery mode, air
conditioning, driver and passenger
temperatures and SYNC settings
can be controlled by pressing
CLIMATE on the infotainment home
screen or the climate button in the
touch screen application tray.
A selection can then be made on
the front climate control page
displayed. See the infotainment
manual.
Climate Touch Screen Controls
1. Outside Temperature Display
2. Driver and Passenger
Temperature Controls
3. Fan Control
4. SYNC (Synchronised
Temperature)
5. A/C Mode (Air Conditioning)
6. Climate Control Selection
(Application Tray Button)
7. Rear (Rear Climate Control
Touch Screen)
8. Air Delivery Mode Control
Climate Control Status Screen
The climate control status screen
appears briefly when the climate
control buttons on the faceplate are
adjusted. The air delivery mode can
be adjusted on the climate control
status screen.
Automatic Operation
The system automatically controls
the fan speed, air delivery, air
conditioning, and recirculation in
order to heat or cool the vehicle to
the desired temperature.
When the indicator light is on or
AUTO is displayed on the touch
screen, the system is in full
automatic operation. If the air
delivery mode or fan setting is
manually adjusted, the auto
indicator turns off and the display
will show the selected settings. Auto
operation can be turned off
individually for climate settings.
For automatic operation:
1. Press AUTO.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Climate Controls
2. Set the temperature. Allow the
system time to stabilise. Then
adjust the temperature as
needed for best comfort.
To improve fuel efficiency and to
cool the vehicle faster, recirculation
may be automatically selected in
warm weather. The recirculation
light will not come on. Press ^
to select recirculation; press it again
to select outside air.
OFF (Fan): Press to turn the fan on
or off. The temperature control and
air delivery mode can still be
adjusted.
w / x (Driver and Passenger
Temperature Controls): The
temperature can be adjusted
separately for the driver and the
passenger. Press to increase or
decrease the temperature. Press
and hold to rapidly increase or
decrease the temperature.
The driver and passenger
temperatures can also be adjusted
by pressing the controls on the
touch screen.
SYNC (Synchronised
Temperature): Press SYNC on the
touch screen to link all climate zone
settings to the driver settings. Adjust
the driver side temperature control
to change the linked temperature.
When the passenger settings are
adjusted, the SYNC button is
displayed when the temperatures
are unlinked.
Manual Operation
z 9 or 9 y (Fan Control):
Press the fan control buttons or the
touch screen fan control, to increase
or decrease the fan speed. Press
and hold the buttons or the touch
screen control to adjust speed more
quickly. The fan speed setting
displays. Pressing either button
cancels automatic fan control and
the fan can be controlled manually.
Press AUTO to return to automatic
operation. To turn off the fan and
climate control system, press and
hold the fan down button or touch
screen fan control until it is off.
8-3
Air Delivery Mode Control: When
the climate information is displayed,
press the desired air delivery mode
on the touch screen to change the
direction of the airflow. The selected
air delivery mode button is lit.
Pressing any of the air delivery
buttons cancels automatic air
delivery control and the direction of
the airflow can be controlled
manually. Press AUTO to return to
automatic operation.
To change the current mode, select
one of the following:
Y (Vent): Air is directed to the
instrument panel outlets.
\ (Bi-Level):
Air is divided
between the instrument panel
outlets and the floor outlets.
[ (Floor):
Air is directed to the
floor outlets.
- (Demist):
Clears the windows of
mist or moisture. Air is directed to
the windscreen and floor outlets.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
8-4
Black plate (4,1)
Climate Controls
0 (Defrost): Clears the
windscreen of mist or frost more
quickly. Air is directed to the
windscreen. Press the 0 button to
turn on or off. Changing the air
delivery mode also turns the
defrost off.
AC Mode (Air Conditioning):
Press the AC Mode touch screen
control to turn the automatic air
conditioning on or off. If the fan is
turned off or the outside
temperature falls below freezing, the
air conditioner will not run.
Press AUTO to return to automatic
operation and the air conditioner
runs as needed.
Automatic Air Recirculation:
When the AUTO indicator light is
on, the air inside the vehicle may
automatically recirculate as needed
to help quickly cool the inside of the
vehicle.
If equipped, an air quality sensor
may also activate recirculation when
it detects increasing levels of poor
quality air outside the vehicle. The
air quality sensor will not maintain
recirculation for an extended period
and may not activate during cold
weather. To adjust the sensitivity of
the air quality sensor, see “Climate
and Air Quality” under Vehicle
Personalisation on page 5-38.
The air quality sensor system does
not protect against carbon monoxide
(CO), which cannot be seen or
smelled. See Engine Exhaust on
page 9-20.
^ (Recirculation): Press to
alternate between recirculating air
inside the vehicle or pulling in
outside air. The indicator light on the
button is lit when recirculation mode
is active. This helps to quickly cool
the air inside the vehicle or prevent
outside air and odours from
entering.
Pressing this button cancels
automatic recirculation. Press AUTO
to return to automatic operation;
recirculation runs automatically as
needed.
Manual recirculation mode is not
available when in Defrost or Defog
modes.
Auto Defog: The climate control
system may have a sensor to
automatically detect high humidity
inside the vehicle. When high
humidity is detected, the climate
control system may adjust to
outside air supply and turn on the
air conditioner. If the climate control
system does not detect possible
window misting, it returns to normal
operation. To turn Auto Demist off or
on, see "Climate and Air Quality"
under Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Rear Window Demister
= (Rear Window Demister):
Press to turn the rear window
demister on or off.
The rear window demister turns off
automatically after about
10 minutes. If turned on again, it
runs for about five minutes before
turning off.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Climate Controls
The heated outside mirrors turn on
when the rear window demister
button is on and help to clear mist
or frost from the surface of the
mirrors.
{ Caution
Do not try to clear frost or other
material from the inside of the
front windscreen and rear window
with a razor blade or anything
else that is sharp. This may
damage the rear window demister
grid and affect the radio's ability
to pick up stations clearly. The
repairs would not be covered by
the vehicle warranty.
Driver and Passenger Heated and
Ventilated Seats (If Equipped):
Press J or z to heat the driver or
passenger seat cushion and
backrest.
Press C or { to ventilate the driver
or passenger seat. See Heated and
Ventilated Seats on page 1-8.
Remote Start Climate Control
Operation: If equipped, the climate
control system may run when the
vehicle is started remotely. The
system uses the driver's previous
settings to heat or cool the inside of
the vehicle. The rear demist may
come on during remote start based
on cold ambient conditions. The
rear demist indicator light does not
come on during a remote start. If the
vehicle has heated or ventilated
seats, they may come on during a
remote start. See Remote Vehicle
Start on page 2-7 and Heated and
Ventilated Seats on page 1-8.
The rear window demister turns on
if it is cold outside.
8-5
Sensor
The solar sensor, located on top of
the instrument panel near the
windscreen, monitors the solar heat.
The climate control system uses the
sensor information to adjust the
temperature, fan speed,
recirculation, and air delivery mode
for best comfort.
If the sensor is covered, the
automatic climate control system
may not work properly.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
8-6
Black plate (6,1)
Climate Controls
Rear Climate Control
System
5.
O (On/Off)
6. TEMP (Temperature Control)
If equipped with a rear climate
control system, the settings can be
adjusted with the rear climate
control buttons and the touch
screen.
6. Rear AUTO (Automatic
Operation)
7. Front (Front Climate Control
Touch Screen)
8. Rear Control Lockout
9. Air Delivery Mode Control
Rear: Press this button on the front
climate control touch screen to open
the rear climate control screen. The
rear climate control settings can
now be adjusted from the front
passenger area.
O (On/Off):
Rear Climate Touch Screen
Controls
1. Outside Temperature Display
Rear Climate Control Buttons
2. Rear Climate Temperature
Control
1. Heated Rear Seats (If Equipped)
3. Fan Control
2. AUTO (Automatic Operation)
4. SYNC (Synchronised
Temperatures)
3. Air Delivery Mode Control
4. Fan Control
5. REAR
O (On/Off)
Press O or REAR O to
turn the rear climate control on or
off. The rear climate control system
can also be turned off by pressing
the fan down button until the system
turns off. If the rear climate control
is turned off using REARO on the
touch screen, the O button on the
rear climate control faceplate must
be pressed twice to turn the system
back on.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Climate Controls
SYNC: Press the SYNC button on
the touch screen to match the rear
climate control temperature to the
front climate control driver
temperature. The SYNC button will
be lit. Press the TEMP, MODE,
or AUTO button twice to unlink the
set driver and rear temperatures.
The SYNC button turns off.
Rear Control Lockout: Press to
lock or unlock control of the rear
climate control system from the rear
seat passengers. When locked the
rear climate control can only be
adjusted from the front seat.
Automatic Operation
Rear AUTO: Press to turn on or off.
The air delivery and fan speed are
controlled automatically. The AUTO
indicator appears on the display.
If any of the climate control settings
are manually adjusted, this cancels
full automatic operation.
Manual Operation
S A T (Fan Control):
Press
briefly or press and hold the rear
climate control buttons or touch
screen to increase or decrease the
airflow. Pressing A T when the
system is off will turn the system on.
The air delivery mode remains in its
previous setting.
+/- (Temperature Control): Press
briefly or press and hold the rear
temperature control buttons or touch
screen to adjust the rear passenger
temperature. Press + for warmer air
and press - for cooler air.
Air Vents
Move the sliding knob on the air
outlets up and down or left and right
to direct the airflow. Use the
thumbwheels near the air outlets to
open or close off the airflow.
Operation Tips
.
Clear away any ice, snow,
or leaves from air inlets at the
base of the windscreen that
could block the flow of air into
the vehicle.
.
Keep the path under the front
seats clear of objects to help
circulate the air inside the
vehicle more effectively.
.
Use of non-GM approved bonnet
air flow deflectors can adversely
affect the performance of the
system. Check with your dealer
before adding equipment to the
outside of the vehicle.
.
Do not insert any objects in the
outlets, as failure of the
mechanism may occur.
Y / \ /Y (Air Delivery Mode
Control): Press the desired mode
button on the touch screen or the
MODE button on the rear faceplate
to change the direction of the airflow
in the rear seating area.
M or L (Heated Rear Seats, If
Equipped): Press M or L to heat
the left or right outboard seat
cushion and seatback. See Heated
Rear Seats on page 3-10.
8-7
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
8-8
Black plate (8,1)
Climate Controls
Maintenance
Passenger Compartment
Air Filter
The filter removes dust, pollen, and
other airborne irritants from outside
air that is pulled into the vehicle.
The filter should be replaced as part
of routine scheduled maintenance,
see Scheduled Maintenance on
page 11-1. To find out what type of
filter to use, see Maintenance
Replacement Parts on page 11-6.
4. Release the two latches holding
the service door. Lower the
service door.
5. Remove the old air filter.
6. Install the new air filter.
1. Open the glove box completely
and remove the four screws
along the upper portion of the
glove box.
7. Close the service door and
latches.
2. When released, lower the upper
portion of the glove box.
See your dealer if additional
assistance is needed.
3. Locate the service door for the
passenger compartment air filter.
8. Reinstall the upper portion of the
glove box.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Driving and Operating
Driving and
Operating
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18
Shifting out of Park . . . . . . . . . . 9-19
Parking over Things
That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20
Engine Exhaust
Driving Information
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Driving on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . 9-5
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
If the Vehicle Is Stuck . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Starting and Operating
New Vehicle Run-In . . . . . . . . . .
Adjustable Throttle and Brake
Pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . .
Starting the Petrol Engine . . .
Engine Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Retained Accessory
Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9-13
9-13
9-14
9-15
9-17
9-18
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20
Running the Vehicle While
Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21
Automatic Transmission
Automatic Transmission . . . . . 9-21
Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23
Fuel Economy Mode . . . . . . . . . 9-24
Drive Systems
All-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25
Brakes
Antilock Brake
System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . .
9-26
9-27
9-28
9-28
Ride Control Systems
Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-29
Limited-Slip Rear Axle . . . . . . . 9-31
Selective Ride Control . . . . . . . 9-31
9-1
Cruise Control
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32
Adaptive Cruise Control . . . . . 9-34
Driver Assistance Systems
Driver Assistance
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-42
Assistance Systems for
Parking or Reversing . . . . . . . 9-43
Assistance Systems for
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45
Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45
Active Emergency Braking
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-48
Side Blind Zone
Alert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-50
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-51
Fuel
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-54
Recommended Fuel . . . . . . . . . 9-54
Fuel Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-54
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-55
Filling a Portable Fuel
Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-56
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-2
Black plate (2,1)
Driving and Operating
Trailer Towing
General Towing
Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driving Characteristics and
Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Towing Equipment . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Sway
Control (TSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driving Information
9-57
Defensive Driving
9-57
9-60
9-61
Defensive driving means "always
expect the unexpected." The first
step in driving defensively is to wear
the safety belt. See Safety Belts on
page 3-11.
9-64
Conversions and Add-Ons
.
Add-On Electrical
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-64
Assume that other road users
(pedestrians, bicyclists, and
other drivers) are going to be
careless and make mistakes.
Anticipate what they might do
and be ready.
Braking
Braking action involves perception
time and reaction time. Deciding to
push the brake pedal is perception
time. Actually doing it is
reaction time.
Average driver reaction time is
about three-quarters of a second. In
that time, a vehicle moving at
100 km/h (60 mph) travels 20 m
(66 ft), which could be a lot of
distance in an emergency.
Helpful braking tips to keep in mind
include:
.
Allow enough following distance
between you and the driver in
front of you.
.
Keep enough distance between
you and the vehicle in front
of you.
.
Focus on the task of driving.
.
Avoid needless heavy braking.
.
Keep pace with traffic.
Control of a Vehicle
Braking, steering, and accelerating
are important factors in helping to
control a vehicle while driving.
If the engine ever stops while the
vehicle is being driven, brake
normally but do not pump the
brakes. Doing so could make the
pedal harder to push down. If the
engine stops, there will be some
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Driving and Operating
.
power brake assist but it will be
used when the brake is applied.
Once the power assist is used up, it
can take longer to stop and the
brake pedal will be harder to push.
Caution (Continued)
damage may occur to the power
steering system and there may be
loss of power steering assist.
9-3
Antilock Brake System (ABS)
allows steering while braking.
Off-Road Recovery
Steering
Hydraulic Power Steering
This vehicle has hydraulic power
steering. It may require
maintenance. See Power Steering
Fluid on page 10-17.
If power steering assist is lost
because the engine stops or
because of a system malfunction,
the vehicle can be steered but may
require increased effort. See your
dealer if there is a problem.
{ Caution
If the steering wheel is turned
until it reaches the end of its
travel, and is held in that position
for more than 15 seconds,
(Continued)
Bend Tips
.
Take bends at a reasonable
speed.
.
Reduce speed before entering
a bend.
.
Maintain a reasonable steady
speed through the bend.
.
Wait until the vehicle is out of
the bend before accelerating
gently into the straight.
Steering in Emergencies
.
.
There are some situations when
steering around a problem may
be more effective than braking.
Holding both sides of the
steering wheel allows you to turn
180 degrees without removing
a hand.
The vehicle's right wheels can drop
off the edge of a road onto the
shoulder while driving. Follow
these tips:
1. Ease off the accelerator and
then, if there is nothing in the
way, steer the vehicle so that it
straddles the edge of the
pavement.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-4
Driving and Operating
2. Turn the steering wheel about
one-eighth of a turn, until the
right front tyre contacts the
pavement edge.
3. Turn the steering wheel to go
straight down the roadway.
Loss of Control
Defensive drivers avoid most skids
by taking reasonable care suited to
existing conditions, and by not
overdriving those conditions. But
skids are always possible.
If the vehicle starts to slide, follow
these suggestions:
.
Skidding
There are three types of skids that
correspond to the vehicle's three
control systems:
.
Braking Skid - wheels are not
rolling.
.
Steering or Cornering Skid - too
much speed or steering in a
bend causes tyres to slip and
lose cornering force.
.
Black plate (4,1)
Acceleration Skid - too much
throttle causes the driving
wheels to spin.
.
Ease your foot off the
accelerator pedal and steer the
way you want the vehicle to go.
The vehicle may straighten out.
Be ready for a second skid if it
occurs.
Slow down and adjust your
driving according to weather
conditions. Stopping distance
can be longer and vehicle
control can be affected when
traction is reduced by water,
snow, ice, gravel, or other
material on the road. Learn to
recognise warning clues - such
as enough water, ice, or packed
snow on the road to make a
mirrored surface - and slow
down when you have any doubt.
.
Try to avoid sudden steering,
acceleration, or braking,
including reducing vehicle speed
by shifting to a lower gear. Any
sudden changes could cause
the tyres to slide.
Remember: Antilock brakes help
avoid only the braking skid.
Driving on Wet Roads
Rain and wet roads can reduce
vehicle traction and affect your
ability to stop and accelerate.
Always drive slower in these types
of driving conditions and avoid
driving through large puddles and
deep-standing or flowing water.
{ Warning
Wet brakes can cause crashes.
They might not work as well in a
quick stop and could cause
pulling to one side. You could
lose control of the vehicle.
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Driving and Operating
Warning (Continued)
After driving through a large
puddle of water or a car/vehicle
wash, lightly apply the brake
pedal until the brakes work
normally.
Flowing or rushing water creates
strong forces. Driving through
flowing water could cause the
vehicle to be carried away. If this
happens, you and other vehicle
occupants could drown. Do not
ignore police warnings and be
very cautious about trying to drive
through flowing water.
Aquaplaning
Aquaplaning is dangerous. Water
can build up under the vehicle's
tyres so they actually ride on the
water. This can happen if the road is
wet enough and you are going fast
enough. When the vehicle is
aquaplaning, it has little or no
contact with the road.
There is no hard and fast rule about
aquaplaning. The best advice is to
slow down when the road is wet.
9-5
Other driving tips include:
.
Keep the vehicle well ventilated.
.
Keep the interior
temperature cool.
Besides slowing down, other wet
weather driving tips include:
.
Keep your eyes moving - scan
the road ahead and to the sides.
.
Allow extra following distance.
.
.
Overtake with caution.
Check the rearview mirror and
vehicle instruments often.
.
Keep windscreen wiping
equipment in good condition.
Hill and Mountain Roads
.
Keep the windscreen washer
fluid reservoir filled.
.
Have good tyres with proper
tread depth. See Tyres on
page 10-40.
Driving on steep hills or through
mountains is different than driving
on flat or rolling terrain. Tips for
driving in these conditions include:
Other Rainy Weather Tips
.
Turn off cruise control.
.
Keep the vehicle serviced and in
good shape.
.
Check all fluid levels and brakes,
tyres, cooling system, and
transmission.
.
Shift to a lower gear when going
down steep or long hills.
Highway Hypnosis
Always be alert and pay attention to
your surroundings while driving.
If you become tired or sleepy, find a
safe place to park the vehicle
and rest.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-6
Black plate (6,1)
Driving and Operating
{ Warning
Using the brakes to slow the
vehicle on a long downhill slope
can cause brake overheating, can
reduce brake performance, and
could result in a loss of braking.
Shift the transmission to a lower
gear to let the engine assist the
brakes on a steep downhill slope.
{ Warning
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral)
or with the ignition off is
dangerous. This can cause
overheating of the brakes and
loss of steering. Always have the
engine running and the vehicle
in gear.
.
Stay in your own lane. Do not
swing wide or cut across the
centre of the road. Drive at
speeds that let you stay in your
own lane.
.
Be alert on top of hills;
something could be in your lane
(stalled car, accident).
.
Pay attention to special road
signs (falling rocks area, winding
roads, long grades, overtaking or
no-overtaking zones) and take
appropriate action.
Winter Driving
Driving on Snow or Ice
Drive carefully when there is snow
or ice between the tyres and the
road, creating less traction or grip.
Wet ice can occur at about 0°C
(32°F) when freezing rain begins to
fall, resulting in even less traction.
Avoid driving on wet ice or in
freezing rain until roads can be
treated with salt or sand.
Drive with caution, whatever the
condition. Accelerate gently so
traction is not lost. Accelerating too
quickly causes the wheels to spin
and makes the surface under the
tyres slick, so there is even less
traction.
Try not to break the fragile traction.
If you accelerate too fast, the drive
wheels will spin and polish the
surface under the tyres even more.
If equipped, Traction Control should
be turned on. See Traction Control/
Electronic Stability Control on
page 9-29.
The Antilock Brake System (ABS)
on page 9-26 improves vehicle
stability during hard stops on
slippery roads, but apply the brakes
sooner than when on dry pavement.
Allow greater following distance on
any slippery road and watch for
slippery spots. Icy patches can
occur on otherwise clear roads in
shaded areas. The surface of a
curve or an overpass can remain icy
when the surrounding roads are
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Driving and Operating
clear. Avoid sudden steering
manoeuvres and braking while
on ice.
Warning (Continued)
Turn off cruise control on slippery
surfaces.
cannot be seen or smelled. It can
cause unconsciousness and even
death.
Blizzard Conditions
If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:
Being stuck in snow can be a
serious situation. Stay with the
vehicle unless there is help nearby.
To get help and keep everyone in
the vehicle safe:
.
Turn on the hazard warning
lights.
.
Tie a red cloth to an outside
mirror.
.
Clear away snow from around
the base of your vehicle,
especially any that is blocking
the exhaust pipe.
.
Check again from time to
time to be sure snow does
not collect there.
.
Open a window about 5 cm
(2 in) on the side of the
vehicle that is away from the
wind to bring in fresh air.
.
Fully open the air outlets on
or under the instrument
panel.
.
Adjust the climate control
system to a setting that
circulates the air inside the
(Continued)
{ Warning
Snow can trap engine exhaust
under the vehicle. This may
cause exhaust gases to get
inside. Engine exhaust contains
carbon monoxide (CO) which
(Continued)
9-7
Warning (Continued)
vehicle and set the fan speed
to the highest setting. See
“Climate Control Systems”.
For more information about
carbon monoxide, see Engine
Exhaust on page 9-20.
To save fuel, run the engine for only
short periods as needed to warm
the vehicle and then shut the engine
off and close the window most of
the way to save heat. Repeat this
until help arrives but only when you
feel really uncomfortable from the
cold. Moving about to keep warm
also helps.
If it takes some time for help to
arrive, now and then when you run
the engine, push the accelerator
pedal slightly so the engine runs
faster than the idle speed. This
keeps the battery charged to restart
the vehicle and to signal for help
with the headlamps. Do this as little
as possible to save fuel.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-8
Black plate (8,1)
Driving and Operating
If the Vehicle Is Stuck
Slowly and cautiously spin the
wheels to free the vehicle when
stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow.
If stuck too severely for the traction
system to free the vehicle, turn the
traction system off and use the
rocking method. See Traction
Control/Electronic Stability Control
on page 9-29.
{ Warning
If the vehicle's tyres spin at high
speed, they can explode, and you
or others could be injured. The
vehicle can overheat, causing an
engine compartment fire or other
damage. Spin the wheels as little
as possible and avoid going
above 56 km/h (35 mph).
Rocking the Vehicle to Get
it Out
Turn the steering wheel left and
right to clear the area around the
front wheels. Turn off any traction
system. Shift back and forth
between R (Reverse) and a low
forward gear, spinning the wheels
as little as possible. To prevent
transmission wear, wait until the
wheels stop spinning before shifting
gears. Release the accelerator
pedal while shifting, and press
lightly on the accelerator pedal
when the transmission is in gear.
Slowly spinning the wheels in the
forward and reverse directions
causes a rocking motion that could
free the vehicle. If that does not get
the vehicle out after a few tries, it
might need to be towed out. If the
vehicle does need to be towed out,
see Towing the Vehicle on
page 10-74.
Vehicle Load Limits
It is very important to know how
much weight the vehicle can
carry. This weight is called the
vehicle capacity weight and
includes the weight of all
occupants, cargo and all
non-factory-installed options.
Two labels on the vehicle show
how much weight it may
properly carry, the Tyre and
Loading Information label and
the Certification label.
{ Warning
Do not load the vehicle any
heavier than the Gross
Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR), or either the
maximum front or rear Gross
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).
This can cause systems to
break and change the way the
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
Driving and Operating
Warning (Continued)
vehicle handles. This could
cause loss of control and a
crash. Overloading can also
shorten the life of the vehicle.
Tyre and Loading Information
Label
Label Example
A vehicle-specific Tyre and
Loading Information label is
attached to the vehicle's centre
pillar (B-pillar). With the driver
door open, you will find the label
attached near the door lock
post. The Tyre and Loading
Information label shows the
number of occupant seating
positions (1), and the maximum
vehicle capacity weight (2) in
kilogrammes and pounds.
The Tyre and Loading
Information label also shows the
tyre size of the original
equipment tyres (3) and the
recommended cold tyre inflation
pressures (4). For more
information on tyres and inflation
see Tyres on page 10-40 and
Tyre Pressure on page 10-42.
There is also important loading
information on the Certification
label. It tells you the Gross
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
and the Gross Axle Weight
9-9
Rating (GAWR) for the front and
rear axle. See “Certification
Label” later in this section.
“Steps for Determining Correct
Load Limit–
1. Locate the statement "The
combined weight of
occupants and cargo should
never exceed XXX kg or
XXX lbs." on your vehicle's
placard.
2. Determine the combined
weight of the driver and
passengers that will be riding
in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined
weight of the driver and
passengers from XXX kg or
XXX lbs.
4. The resulting figure equals
the available amount of cargo
and luggage load capacity.
For example, if the "XXX"
amount equals 1400 lbs. and
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-10
Black plate (10,1)
Driving and Operating
there will be five 150 lb
passengers in your vehicle,
the amount of available cargo
and luggage load capacity is
650 lbs. (1400-750 (5 x 150)
= 650 lbs.)
5. Determine the combined
weight of luggage and cargo
being loaded on the vehicle.
That weight may not safely
exceed the available cargo
and luggage load capacity
calculated in Step 4.
6. If your vehicle will be towing
a trailer, load from your trailer
will be transferred to your
vehicle. Consult this manual
to determine how this
reduces the available cargo
and luggage load capacity of
your vehicle.”
See Trailer Towing on page 9-60
for important information on
towing a trailer, towing safety
rules and trailering tips.
Example 1
1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for
Example 1 = 453 kg
(1,000 lbs).
2. Subtract Occupant Weight @
68 kg (150 lbs) × 2 = 136 kg
(300 lbs).
3. Available Occupant and
Cargo Weight = 317 kg
(700 lbs).
Example 2
1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for
Example 2 = 453 kg
(1,000 lbs).
2. Subtract Occupant Weight @
68 kg (150 lbs) × 5 = 340 kg
(750 lbs).
3. Available Cargo Weight =
113 kg (250 lbs).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
Driving and Operating
seating positions. The combined
weight of the driver, passengers,
and cargo should never exceed
the vehicle's capacity weight.
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR). The GVWR includes
the weight of the vehicle, all
occupants, fuel, and cargo.
Certification Label
The Certification/Tyre label also
tells you the maximum weights
for the front and rear axles,
called Gross Axle Weight Rating
(GAWR). To find out the actual
loads on the front and rear
axles, you need to go to a weigh
station and weigh the vehicle.
Your dealer can help you with
this. Be sure to spread out the
load equally on both sides of the
centre line.
Example 3
1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for
Example 3 = 453 kg
(1,000 lbs).
2. Subtract Occupant Weight @
91 kg (200 lbs) × 5 = 453 kg
(1,000 lbs).
3. Available Cargo Weight =
0 kg (0 lbs).
Refer to the vehicle's Tyre and
Loading Information label for
specific information about the
vehicle's capacity weight and
9-11
Label Example
A vehicle-specific Certification/
Tyre label is attached to the
driver side centre pillar (B-pillar).
The label shows the size of the
vehicle's original tyres and the
inflation pressures needed to
obtain the gross weight capacity
of the vehicle. This is called
Never exceed the GVWR for the
vehicle, or the GAWR for either
the front or rear axle.
Note that your vehicle may have
two certification labels. One U.S.
certification label and one
European certification label. Be
sure to reference your European
label for information.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-12
Black plate (12,1)
Driving and Operating
If the vehicle is carrying a heavy
load, it should be spread out.
See “Steps for Determining
Correct Load Limit” earlier in this
section.
{ Warning
Do not load the vehicle any
heavier than the Gross
Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR), or either the
maximum front or rear Gross
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).
This can cause systems to
break and change the way the
vehicle handles. This could
cause loss of control and a
crash. Overloading can also
shorten the life of the vehicle.
Your warranty does not cover
parts or components that fail
because of overloading.
The label will help you decide
how much cargo and installed
equipment your vehicle can
carry.
Using heavier suspension
components to get added
durability might not change your
weight ratings. Ask your dealer
to help you load your vehicle the
right way.
If you put things inside your
vehicle - like suitcases, tools,
packages, or anything else they will go as fast as the
vehicle goes. If you have to stop
or turn quickly, or if there is a
crash, they will keep going.
Warning (Continued)
.
Put things in the cargo
area of the vehicle. In the
cargo area, put them as
far forward as possible.
Try to spread the weight
evenly.
.
Never stack heavier
things, like suitcases,
inside the vehicle so that
some of them are above
the tops of the seats.
.
Do not leave an
unsecured child restraint
in the vehicle.
.
Secure loose items in the
vehicle.
.
Do not leave a seat folded
down unless needed.
{ Warning
Things inside the vehicle can
strike and injure people in a
sudden stop or turn, or in a
crash.
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (13,1)
Driving and Operating
Starting and
Operating
New Vehicle Run-In
{ Caution
The vehicle does not need an
elaborate run-in. But it will
perform better in the long run if
you follow these guidelines:
.
.
Do not drive at any one
constant speed, fast or slow,
for the first 805 km (500 mi).
Do not make full-throttle
starts. Avoid downshifting to
brake or slow the vehicle.
Avoid making hard stops for
the first 322 km (200 mi) or
so. During this time the new
brake linings are not yet
broken in. Hard stops with
new linings can mean
premature wear and earlier
replacement. Follow this
(Continued)
9-13
Caution (Continued)
breaking-in guideline every
time you get new brake
linings.
Following run-in, engine speed
and load can be gradually
increased.
Adjustable Throttle and
Brake Pedal
If the vehicle has this feature, the
position of the throttle and brake
pedals can be adjusted.
The switch used to adjust the
pedals is located on the right side of
the steering column, below the
wiper stalk. Pull the switch toward
you to move the pedals further from
the floor, or push the switch away
from you to move the pedals closer
to the floor.
Adjust the throttle and brake pedals
while the vehicle is in P (Park)
without pressing on the pedals. The
pedals cannot be adjusted while the
vehicle is in R (Reverse) or when
cruise control is engaged. The
throttle and brake pedals can also
be adjusted while driving.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-14
Black plate (14,1)
Driving and Operating
Ignition Positions
To shift out of P (Park), the vehicle
must be in ON/RUN mode and the
brake pedal must be applied.
STOPPING THE ENGINE/LOCK/
OFF (No Indicator Light): When
the vehicle is stopped, press the
ENGINE START/STOP button once
to turn the engine off.
If the vehicle is in P (Park), the
ignition will turn off, and Retained
Accessory Power (RAP) will remain
active. See Retained Accessory
Power (RAP) on page 9-18.
The vehicle has an electronic
keyless ignition with pushbutton
start.
Pressing the button cycles it through
three modes, ACC/ACCESSORY,
ON/RUN/START and STOPPING
THE ENGINE/LOCK/OFF.
If the pushbutton start is not
working, the vehicle may be near a
strong radio aerial signal causing
interference to the keyless entry
system. See Key and Lock
Messages on page 5-32.
If the vehicle is not in P (Park), the
ignition will return to ACC/
ACCESSORY and display the
message SHIFT TO PARK in the
Driver Information Centre (DIC).
See Driver Information Centre (DIC)
on page 5-25. When the vehicle is
shifted into P (Park), the ignition
system will switch to OFF.
The vehicle may have an electric
steering column lock. The lock is
activated when the ignition is
switched to off and either front door
is opened. An audible sound may
be heard as the lock actuates or
releases. The steering column lock
can bind with the wheels turned off
centre. If this happens, the vehicle
may not start, and a DIC message
will be displayed. Move the steering
wheel from left to right while
attempting to start the vehicle. See
Starting the Vehicle Messages on
page 5-36. If this does not work, the
vehicle needs service.
Do not turn the engine off when the
vehicle is moving. This will cause a
loss of power assist in the brake
and steering systems and disable
the airbags.
If the vehicle must be shut off in an
emergency:
1. Brake using a firm and steady
pressure. Do not pump the
brakes repeatedly. This may
deplete power assist, requiring
increased brake pedal force.
2. Shift the vehicle to N (Neutral).
This can be done while the
vehicle is moving. After shifting
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (15,1)
Driving and Operating
to N (Neutral), firmly apply the
brakes and steer the vehicle to a
safe location.
3. Come to a complete stop, shift
to P (Park), and turn the ignition
to LOCK/OFF. On vehicles with
an automatic transmission, the
shift lever must be in P (Park) to
turn the ignition switch to the
LOCK/OFF position.
4. Apply the parking brake. See
Parking Brake on page 9-27.
{ Warning
Turning off the vehicle while
moving may cause loss of power
assistance in the brake and
steering systems and disable the
airbags. While driving, only shut
the vehicle off in an emergency.
If the vehicle cannot be pulled over,
and must be shut off while driving,
press and hold the ENGINE START/
STOP button for longer than
two seconds, or press twice in
five seconds.
ACC/ACCESSORY (Amber
Indicator Light): This mode allows
you to use some electrical
accessories when the engine is off.
With the ignition off, pressing the
button one time without the brake
pedal applied, will place the ignition
system in ACC/ACCESSORY.
The ignition will switch from ACC/
ACCESSORY to OFF after
10 minutes to prevent battery
run down.
ON/RUN/START (Green Indicator
Light): This mode is for driving and
starting. With the ignition off, and
the brake pedal applied, pressing
the button once will place the
ignition system in ON/RUN/START.
Once engine cranking begins,
release the button. Engine cranking
will continue until the engine starts.
See Starting the Petrol Engine on
page 9-15. The ignition will then
remain in ON/RUN.
9-15
Service Only Mode
This power mode is available for
service and diagnostics, and to
verify the proper operation of the
malfunction indicator lamp as may
be required for emission inspection
purposes. With the vehicle off, and
the brake pedal not applied,
pressing and holding the button for
more than five seconds will place
the vehicle in Service Only Mode.
The instruments and audio systems
will operate as they do in ON/RUN,
but the vehicle will not be able to be
driven. The engine will not start in
Service Only Mode. Push the button
again to turn the vehicle off.
Starting the Petrol Engine
Place the transmission in the proper
gear by moving the gear lever to
P (Park) or N (Neutral). To restart
the engine when the vehicle is
already moving, use N (Neutral).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-16
Black plate (16,1)
Driving and Operating
{ Caution
Do not try to shift to P (Park) if
the vehicle is moving. If you do,
you could damage the
transmission. Shift to P (Park)
only when the vehicle is stopped.
{ Caution
If the steering wheel is turned
until it reaches the end of its
travel, and is held in that position
while starting the vehicle, damage
may occur to the hydraulic power
steering system and there may be
loss of power steering assist.
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
transmitter must be inside the
vehicle for the ignition to work.
Mobile phone chargers can interfere
with the operation of the Keyless
Access System. Battery chargers
should not be plugged in when
starting or turning off the engine.
To start the vehicle:
Starting Procedure
1. With the brake pedal applied,
press the ENGINE START/
STOP button on the instrument
panel. See Ignition Positions on
page 9-14.
2. When the engine begins
cranking, let go of the button and
the engine cranks automatically
until it starts.
If the transmitter is not in the
vehicle or something is
interfering with the transmitter,
the Driver Information Centre
(DIC) will display NO REMOTE
DETECTED. See Driver
Information Centre (DIC) on
page 5-25.
If the battery in the RKE
transmitter needs replacing, the
DIC displays REPLACE
BATTERY IN REMOTE KEY.
The vehicle can still be driven.
See Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) System Operation on
page 2-3.
3. Do not race the engine
immediately after starting it.
Operate the engine and
transmission gently until the oil
warms up and lubricates all
moving parts.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (17,1)
Driving and Operating
4. If the engine does not start and
no DIC message is displayed,
wait 15 seconds before trying
again to let the cranking motor
cool down.
If the engine does not start after
five to 10 seconds, especially in
very cold weather (below -18°C
or 0°F), it could be flooded with
too much petrol. Try pushing the
accelerator pedal all the way to
the floor while cranking for up to
15 seconds.
{ Caution
Cranking the engine for long
periods of time, by pressing the
ENGINE START/STOP button
immediately after cranking has
ended, can overheat and damage
the cranking motor, and drain the
battery. Wait at least 15 seconds
between each try, to let the
cranking motor cool down.
When the engine starts, let go of the
accelerator. If the vehicle starts
briefly but then stops again, do the
same thing. This clears the extra
petrol from the engine.
The vehicle has a
Computer-Controlled Cranking
System. This feature assists in
starting the engine and protects
components. Once cranking has
been initiated, the engine continues
cranking for a few seconds or until
the vehicle starts. If the engine does
not start, cranking automatically
stops after 15 seconds to prevent
cranking motor damage. To prevent
gear damage, this system also
prevents cranking if the engine is
already running.
{ Caution
If you add electrical parts or
accessories, you could change
the way the engine operates. Any
resulting damage would not be
(Continued)
9-17
Caution (Continued)
covered by the vehicle warranty.
See Add-On Electrical Equipment
on page 9-64.
Engine Heater
The engine heater, if available, can
help in cold weather conditions at or
below -18°C (0°F) for easier starting
and better fuel economy during
engine warm-up. Plug in the heater
at least four hours before starting
the vehicle. An internal thermostat
in the plug end of the cord will
prevent engine coolant heater
operation at temperatures above
-18°C (0°F).
To Use the Engine Heater
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Open the bonnet and unwrap the
heater's electrical cord. The cord
is located near the air cleaner.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-18
Black plate (18,1)
Driving and Operating
3. The heater cord requires an
adaptor/extension cord, which is
available from your dealer. Plug
this adaptor/extension cord into
the heater's electrical cord.
Retained Accessory
Power (RAP)
4. Plug the adaptor/extension cord
into a normal, grounded 220-volt
AC outlet.
.
Infotainment system (up to
10 minutes or until the driver
door is opened).
It can be dangerous to leave the
vehicle with the engine running.
It could overheat and catch fire.
5. Before starting the engine, be
sure to unplug and store the
adaptor/extension cord, and
place the heater's electrical cord
as it was before to keep it away
from moving engine parts. If you
do not it could be damaged.
.
Power windows, sunroof (if
equipped), and power outlets (up
to 10 minutes or until any door is
opened).
It is dangerous to get out of the
vehicle if the shift lever is not fully
in P (Park) with the parking brake
firmly applied. The vehicle
can roll.
The length of time the heater should
remain plugged in depends on
several factors. Ask a dealer in the
area where you will be parking the
vehicle for the best advice on this.
These accessories can be used
after the engine is turned off:
Shifting Into Park
1. Hold the brake pedal down and
set the parking brake. See
Parking Brake on page 9-27.
2. Move the gear lever into
P (Park) by pushing the lever all
the way toward the front of the
vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition off.
Leaving the Vehicle with the
Engine Running
{ Warning
Do not leave the vehicle when the
engine is running. If you have left
the engine running, the vehicle
can move suddenly. You or others
could be injured. To be sure the
vehicle will not move, even when
you are on fairly level ground,
always set the parking brake and
move the shift lever to P (Park).
See Shifting Into Park on
page 9-18. If you are towing a
trailer, see Driving Characteristics
and Towing Tips on page 9-57.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (19,1)
Driving and Operating
If you have to leave the vehicle with
the engine running, be sure the
vehicle is in P (Park) and the
parking brake is firmly applied
before you leave it. After you have
moved the gear lever into P (Park),
hold down the regular brake pedal.
See if you can move the gear lever
away from P (Park) without first
pulling it toward you. If you can, it
means that the shift lever was not
fully locked into P (Park).
Torque Lock
Torque lock is when the weight of
the vehicle puts too much force on
the parking pawl in the
transmission. This happens when
parking on a hill and shifting the
transmission into P (Park) is not
done properly and then it is difficult
to shift out of P (Park). To prevent
torque lock, set the parking brake
and then shift into P (Park). To find
out how, see "Shifting Into P (Park)"
listed previously.
9-19
If torque lock does occur, your
vehicle may need to be pushed
uphill by another vehicle to relieve
the parking pawl pressure, so you
can shift out of P (Park).
If the vehicle has an uncharged
battery or a battery with low voltage,
try charging or jump starting the
battery. See Jump Starting on
page 10-70.
If you are towing a trailer and
parking on a hill, see Driving
Characteristics and Towing Tips on
page 9-57.
To shift out of P (Park):
Shifting out of Park
3. Press the shift lever button.
This vehicle is equipped with an
automatic transmission shift lock
control system. The shift lock
control is designed to prevent
movement of the gear lever out of
P (Park), unless the ignition is in
ON/RUN and the brake pedal is
applied.
4. Move the shift lever to the
desired position.
The shift lock control is always
functional except in the case of an
uncharged or low voltage (less than
9-volt) battery.
1. Apply the brake pedal.
2. Press the ENGINE START/
STOP button.
If you still are unable to shift out of
P (Park):
1. Fully release the shift lever
button.
2. Hold the brake pedal down and
press the gear lever button
again.
3. Move the shift lever to the
desired position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-20
Black plate (20,1)
Driving and Operating
If you still cannot move the gear
lever from P (Park), consult your
dealer or a professional towing
service.
Parking over Things
That Burn
{ Warning
Things that can burn could touch
hot exhaust parts under the
vehicle and ignite. Do not park
over papers, leaves, dry grass,
or other things that can burn.
Engine Exhaust
{ Warning
Engine exhaust contains carbon
monoxide (CO) which cannot be
seen or smelled. Exposure to CO
can cause unconsciousness and
even death.
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:
.
The vehicle idles in areas
with poor ventilation (parking
garages, tunnels, deep snow
that may block underbody
airflow or exhaust pipes).
.
The exhaust smells or
sounds strange or different.
.
The exhaust system leaks
due to corrosion or damage.
.
The vehicle exhaust system
has been modified, damaged,
or improperly repaired.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
.
There are holes or openings
in the vehicle body from
damage or aftermarket
modifications that are not
completely sealed.
If unusual fumes are detected or
if it is suspected that exhaust is
coming into the vehicle:
.
Drive it only with the windows
completely down.
.
Have the vehicle repaired
immediately.
Never park the vehicle with the
engine running in an enclosed
area such as a garage or a
building that has no fresh air
ventilation.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (21,1)
Driving and Operating
Running the Vehicle
While Parked
Automatic
Transmission
It is better not to park with the
engine running.
If the vehicle is left with the engine
running, follow the proper steps to
be sure the vehicle will not move.
See Shifting Into Park on page 9-18
and Engine Exhaust on page 9-20.
If parking on a hill and pulling a
trailer, see Driving Characteristics
and Towing Tips on page 9-57.
There are several different positions
for the shift lever.
P (Park): This position locks the
front wheels. It is the best position
to use when you start the engine
because the vehicle cannot move
easily.
9-21
{ Warning
It is dangerous to get out of the
vehicle if the shift lever is not fully
in P (Park) with the parking brake
firmly applied. The vehicle
can roll.
Do not leave the vehicle when the
engine is running. If you have left
the engine running, the vehicle
can move suddenly. You or others
could be injured. To be sure the
vehicle will not move, even when
you are on fairly level ground,
always set the parking brake and
move the shift lever to P (Park).
See Shifting Into Park on
page 9-18 and Driving
Characteristics and Towing Tips
on page 9-57.
Make sure the shift lever is fully in
P (Park) before starting the engine.
The vehicle has an automatic
transmission shift lock control
system. You must fully apply the
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-22
Black plate (22,1)
Driving and Operating
regular brakes first and then press
the gear lever button before you can
shift from P (Park) when the ignition
is in ON/RUN. If you cannot shift out
of P (Park), ease pressure on the
gear lever and push the gear lever
all the way into P (Park) as you
maintain brake application. Then
press the shift lever button and
move the shift lever into another
gear. See Shifting out of Park on
page 9-19.
At low vehicle speeds, R (Reverse)
can be used to rock the vehicle
back and forth to get out of snow,
ice or sand without damaging your
transmission. See If the Vehicle Is
Stuck on page 9-8.
Shifting out of P (Park) or
N (Neutral) with the engine
running at high speed may
damage the transmission. The
repairs would not be covered by
the vehicle warranty. Be sure the
engine is not running at high
speed when shifting the vehicle.
N (Neutral): In this position, the
engine does not connect with the
wheels. To restart when the vehicle
is already moving, use N (Neutral)
only. You can also use N (Neutral)
when the vehicle is being towed.
{ Caution
{ Warning
Shifting to R (Reverse) while the
vehicle is moving forward could
damage the transmission. The
repairs would not be covered by
the vehicle warranty. Shift to
R (Reverse) only after the vehicle
is stopped.
Shifting into a drive gear while the
engine is running at high speed is
dangerous. Unless your foot is
firmly on the brake pedal, the
vehicle could move very rapidly.
You could lose control and hit
people or objects. Do not shift
into a drive gear while the engine
is running at high speed.
R (Reverse): Use this gear to
reverse.
{ Caution
D (Drive): This position is for
normal driving. It provides the best
fuel economy. If you need more
power for overtaking, and you are:
.
Going less than 35 mph
(55 km/h), push the accelerator
pedal about halfway down.
.
Going about 35 mph (55 km/h)
or more, push the accelerator all
the way down.
The transmission will shift down
to a lower gear and have more
power.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (23,1)
Driving and Operating
Downshifting the transmission in
slippery road conditions could result
in skidding. See “Skidding” under
Loss of Control on page 9-4
{ Caution
Spinning the tyres or holding the
vehicle in one place on a hill
using only the accelerator pedal
may damage the transmission.
The repair will not be covered by
the vehicle warranty. If you are
stuck, do not spin the tyres. When
stopping on a hill, use the brakes
to hold the vehicle in place.
Manual Mode
Driver Shift Control (DSC)
{ Caution
Driving with the engine at a high
rpm without upshifting while using
Driver Shift Control (DSC), could
damage the vehicle. Always
upshift when necessary while
using DSC.
9-23
DSC allows you to shift an
automatic transmission similar to a
manual gearbox. To use the DSC
feature:
1. Move the gear lever to the left
from D (Drive) to M
(Manual Mode).
If you do not move the gear
lever forward or rearward, the
vehicle will be in Sport Mode.
When you are in Sport Mode the
vehicle will still shift
automatically. The transmission
may remain in a gear longer
than it would in the normal
driving mode based on braking,
throttle input and vehicle lateral
acceleration.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-24
Black plate (24,1)
Driving and Operating
SPORT MODE ON will be
displayed in the DIC. See Ride
Control System Messages on
page 5-35. The word “sport” will
display below the odometer. The
gear position will also be
indicated in the tachometer.
Within Sport Mode there is a
further performance feature
called Performance Mode Lift
Foot (PMLF) Mode. The feature
is activated automatically when
sports oriented driving is
detected, based on cornering
and on/off throttle application.
PMLF allows the transmission to
hold the current gear instead of
upshifting when the throttle is
lifted.
2. To enter M (Manual Mode),
press the gear lever forward to
upshift or rearward to downshift.
An M will be displayed in
the DIC.
3. To return to Sport Mode from M
(Manual Mode), press and briefly
hold the gear lever forward.
Gear position is indicated in the
bottom right corner of the display
area in the instrument cluster. The
number indicates the requested
gear range when moving the shift
lever forward or rearward.
While using the DSC feature, the
vehicle will have firmer, quicker
shifting. You can use this for sport
driving or when climbing or
descending hills, to stay in gear
longer or to downshift for more
power or engine braking.
The transmission will only allow you
to shift into gears appropriate for the
vehicle speed and engine
revolutions per minute (rpm). The
transmission will not automatically
shift to the next lower gear if the
engine rpm is too high or to the next
higher gear when the maximum
engine rpm is reached.
If shifting is prevented for any
reason, the currently selected gear
will flash multiple times, indicating
that the transmission has not shifted
gears.
While in the DSC mode, the
transmission will automatically
downshift when the vehicle comes
to a stop. This will allow for more
power during take-off.
When accelerating the vehicle from
a stop in snowy and icy conditions,
you may want to shift into second
gear. A higher gear ratio allows you
to gain more traction on slippery
surfaces.
Fuel Economy Mode
Driving habits can affect fuel
mileage. For driving tips to get the
best fuel economy possible, see
Driving for Better Fuel Economy on
page 1-18.
The vehicle may have a fuel
economy mode. When engaged,
fuel economy mode can improve the
vehicle's fuel economy.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (25,1)
Driving and Operating
Pressing the eco button by the shift
lever will engage fuel economy
mode. When activated, the eco light
in the instrument cluster will come
on. See Fuel Economy Light on
page 5-22. Pressing the button a
second time will turn fuel economy
mode off.
When fuel economy mode is on:
.
The transmission will upshift
sooner, and downshift later.
.
The torque converter will lock up
sooner, and stay on longer.
.
The accelerator pedal will be
less sensitive.
Drive Systems
.
The vehicle's computers will
more aggressively shut off fuel
to the engine under deceleration.
All-Wheel Drive
.
The engine operates at lower
rpms in fuel economy mode,
which can increase noise and
vibration. This is normal.
9-25
Vehicles with this feature transfer
torque as required to the rear
wheels. It is fully automatic, and
adjusts itself as needed for road
conditions.
AWD system performance will be
automatically reduced when you use
the compact spare. To restore full
AWD operation and prevent
excessive wear on the system,
replace the compact spare with a
full-size tyre as soon as possible.
See Compact Spare Tyre on
page 10-69.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-26
Black plate (26,1)
Driving and Operating
Brakes
Antilock Brake
System (ABS)
This vehicle has ABS, an advanced
electronic braking system that helps
prevent a braking skid.
When the vehicle begins to drive
away, ABS checks itself.
A momentary motor or clicking noise
might be heard while this test is
going on, and it might even be
noticed that the brake pedal moves
a little. This is normal.
If there is a problem with ABS, this
warning light stays on. See Antilock
Brake System (ABS) Warning Light
on page 5-19.
If driving safely on a wet road and it
becomes necessary to slam on the
brakes and continue braking to
avoid a sudden obstacle, a
computer senses that the wheels
are slowing down. If one of the
wheels is about to stop rolling, the
computer will separately work the
brakes at each wheel.
ABS can change the brake pressure
to each wheel, as required, faster
than any driver could. This can help
you steer around the obstacle while
braking hard.
As the brakes are applied, the
computer keeps receiving updates
on wheel speed and controls
braking pressure accordingly.
Remember: ABS does not change
the time needed to get a foot up to
the brake pedal or always decrease
stopping distance. If you get too
close to the vehicle in front of you,
there will not be enough time to
apply the brakes if that vehicle
suddenly slows or stops. Always
leave enough room up ahead to
stop, even with ABS.
Using ABS
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold
the brake pedal down firmly and let
ABS work. You might hear the ABS
pump or motor operating and feel
the brake pedal pulsate, but this is
normal.
Braking in Emergencies
ABS allows you to steer and brake
at the same time. In many
emergencies, steering can help
more than even the very best
braking.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (27,1)
Driving and Operating
Parking Brake
There are also handbrake-related
Driver Information Centre (DIC)
messages. See Brake System
Messages on page 5-28. In case of
insufficient electrical power, the EPB
cannot be applied or released.
Before leaving the vehicle, check
the red handbrake status light to
ensure that the handbrake is
applied.
EPB Apply
To apply the EPB:
The Electric Parking Brake (EPB)
switch is on the centre console. The
EPB can always be activated, even
if the ignition is off. To prevent
draining the battery, avoid repeated
cycles of the EPB when the engine
is not running.
The system has a red handbrake
status light and an amber
handbrake warning light. See
Electric Parking Brake Light on
page 5-18 and Service Electric
Parking Brake Light on page 5-19.
1. Be sure the vehicle is at a
complete stop.
2. Lift up the EPB switch
momentarily.
The red handbrake status light will
flash and then stay on once the
EPB is fully applied. If the red
handbrake status light flashes
continuously, then the EPB is only
partially applied or there is a
problem with the EPB. A DIC
message will display. Release the
EPB and try to apply it again. If the
light does not come on, or keeps
9-27
flashing, have the vehicle serviced.
Do not drive the vehicle if the red
handbrake status light is flashing.
See your dealer. See Electric
Parking Brake Light on page 5-18.
If the amber handbrake warning
light is on, lift up on the EPB switch
and hold it up. Continue to hold the
switch until the red handbrake
status light remains on. If the amber
handbrake warning light remains on,
see your dealer.
If the EPB is applied while the
vehicle is moving, the vehicle will
decelerate as long as the switch is
held up. If the switch is held up until
the vehicle comes to a stop, the
EPB will remain applied.
The vehicle may automatically apply
the EPB in some situations when
the vehicle is not moving. This is
normal, and is done to periodically
check the correct operation of the
EPB system.
If the EPB fails to apply, the rear
wheels should be blocked to
prevent vehicle movement.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-28
Black plate (28,1)
Driving and Operating
EPB Release
To release the EPB:
1. Place the ignition in the ACC/
ACCESSORY or ON/RUN
position.
2. Apply and hold the brake pedal.
If parking on a hill, or if the vehicle
is pulling a trailer, see Driving
Characteristics and Towing Tips on
page 9-57.
system hydraulic brake control
module to supplement the power
brake system under conditions
where the driver has quickly and
forcefully applied the brake pedal in
an attempt to quickly stop or slow
down the vehicle. The stability
system hydraulic brake control
module increases brake pressure at
each corner of the vehicle until the
ABS activates. Minor brake pedal
pulsation or pedal movement during
this time is normal and the driver
should continue to apply the brake
pedal as the driving situation
dictates. The brake assist feature
will automatically disengage when
the brake pedal is released or brake
pedal pressure is quickly
decreased.
Brake Assist
Hill Start Assist (HSA)
This vehicle has a brake assist
feature designed to assist the driver
in stopping or decreasing vehicle
speed in emergency driving
conditions. This feature
automatically uses the stability
This vehicle has an HSA feature,
which may be useful when the
vehicle is stopped on a gradient.
This feature is designed to prevent
the vehicle from rolling, either
forward or rearward, during vehicle
Caution (Continued)
damage to brake system parts.
Make sure that the parking brake
is fully released and the brake
warning light is off before driving.
3. Push down momentarily on the
EPB switch.
Automatic EPB Release
The EPB is released when the red
handbrake status light is off.
The EPB will automatically release if
the vehicle is running, placed into
gear and an attempt is made to
drive away. Avoid rapid acceleration
when the EPB is applied, to
preserve parking brake lining life.
If the amber handbrake warning
light is on, release the EPB by
pushing down on the EPB switch
and holding it down. Continue to
hold the switch until the red
handbrake status light is off. If either
light stays on after release is
attempted, see your dealer.
{ Caution
Driving with the parking brake on
can overheat the brake system
and cause premature wear or
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (29,1)
Driving and Operating
drive off. After the driver completely
stops and holds the vehicle in a
complete standstill on a grade, HSA
will be automatically activated.
During the transition period between
when the driver releases the brake
pedal and starts to accelerate to
drive off on a gradient, HSA holds
the braking pressure for a maximum
of two seconds to ensure that there
is no rolling. The brakes will
automatically release when the
accelerator pedal is applied within
the two-second window. It will not
activate if the vehicle is in a drive
gear and facing downhill, or if the
vehicle is facing uphill and in
R (Reverse).
Ride Control Systems
Traction Control/
Electronic Stability
Control
System Operation
The vehicle has a Traction Control
System (TCS) and StabiliTrak®, an
electronic stability control system.
These systems help limit wheel slip
and assist the driver in maintaining
control, especially on slippery road
conditions.
TCS activates if it senses that any
of the drive wheels are spinning or
beginning to lose traction. When this
happens, TCS applies the brakes to
the spinning wheels and reduces
engine power to limit wheel spin.
StabiliTrak activates when the
vehicle senses a difference between
the intended path and the direction
the vehicle is actually travelling.
StabiliTrak selectively applies
braking pressure to any one of the
9-29
vehicle wheel brakes to assist the
driver in keeping the vehicle on the
intended path. Trailer Sway Control
(TSC) is also on automatically when
the vehicle is started. See Trailer
Sway Control (TSC) on page 9-64.
If cruise control is being used and
traction control or StabiliTrak begins
to limit wheel spin, cruise control will
disengage. Cruise control may be
turned back on when road
conditions allow.
Both systems come on
automatically when the vehicle is
started and begins to move. The
systems may be heard or felt while
they are operating or while
performing diagnostic checks. This
is normal and does not mean there
is a problem with the vehicle.
It is recommended to leave both
systems on for normal driving
conditions, but it may be necessary
to turn TCS off if the vehicle gets
stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-30
Black plate (30,1)
Driving and Operating
See If the Vehicle Is Stuck on
page 9-8 and “Turning the Systems
Off and On” later in this section.
maintaining control. The vehicle is
safe to drive, but driving should be
adjusted accordingly.
If
d comes on and stays on:
1. Stop the vehicle.
2. Turn the engine off and wait
15 seconds.
3. Start the engine.
The indicator light for both systems
is in the instrument cluster. This
light will:
.
Flash when TCS is limiting
wheel spin.
Drive the vehicle. If d comes on
and stays on, the vehicle may need
more time to diagnose the problem.
If the condition persists, see your
dealer.
.
Flash when StabiliTrak is
activated.
Turning the Systems Off
and On
.
Turn on and stay on when either
system is not working.
If either system fails to turn on or to
activate, a message displays in the
Driver Information Centre (DIC), and
d comes on and stays on to
indicate that the system is inactive
and is not assisting the driver in
The button for TCS and StabiliTrak
is on the centre stack.
{ Caution
Do not repeatedly brake or
accelerate heavily when TCS is
off. The vehicle driveline could be
damaged.
To turn off only TCS, press and
release the g button. The traction
off light i displays in the instrument
cluster. The appropriate message is
displayed in the DIC. See Ride
Control System Messages on
page 5-35.
To turn TCS on again, press and
release the g button. The traction
off light i displayed in the
instrument cluster will turn off. The
appropriate message is displayed in
the DIC. See Ride Control System
Messages on page 5-35.
If TCS is limiting wheel spin when
the g button is pressed, the system
will not turn off until the wheels stop
spinning.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (31,1)
Driving and Operating
To turn off both TCS and StabiliTrak,
press and hold the g button until
the traction off light i and the
StabiliTrak OFF light g come on
and stay on in the instrument
cluster. The appropriate message is
displayed in the DIC. See Ride
Control System Messages on
page 5-35.
To turn TCS and StabiliTrak on
again, press and release the g
button. The traction off light i and
the StabiliTrak OFF light g in the
instrument cluster turn off. The
appropriate message is displayed in
the DIC. See Ride Control System
Messages on page 5-35.
Adding accessories can affect the
vehicle performance. See
Accessories and Modifications on
page 10-2.
Limited-Slip Rear Axle
Vehicles with a limited-slip rear axle
can give more traction on snow,
mud, ice, sand or gravel. When
traction is low, this feature allows
the drive wheel with the most
traction to move the vehicle. The
limited-slip rear axle also gives the
driver enhanced control when
cornering hard or completing a
manoeuvre, such as a lane change.
Selective Ride Control
The vehicle may have a ride control
system called Selective Ride
Control. The setting can be changed
at any time. Based on road
conditions, steering wheel angle
and the vehicle speed, the system
automatically adjusts to provide the
best handling while providing a
smooth ride. The Tour and Sport
modes will feel similar on a
smooth road.
9-31
Tour: Use for normal city and
highway driving. This setting
provides a smooth, soft ride.
Sport: Use where road conditions
or personal preference demand
more control. This setting provides
more “feel,” or response to road
conditions through increased
steering effort and suspension
control. Transmission shift points
and shift firmness are also
enhanced.
The vehicle is normally in the Tour
Mode. To switch from Tour Mode to
Sport Mode, move the shift lever to
the left while the transmission is in
D (Drive). Sport Mode is
automatically engaged when the
shift lever is moved to the left.
Moving the shift lever forward or
rearward will put the transmission in
the Manual (M) Mode.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-32
Black plate (32,1)
Driving and Operating
The Driver Information Centre (DIC)
will display SPORT MODE ON
when the Sport Mode has been
activated. When the shift lever is
moved to the right in D (Drive), the
system will revert back to Tour
Mode. See Manual Mode on
page 9-23 under Automatic
Transmission.
If there is a problem detected with
Selective Ride Control, SERVICE
SUSPENSION SYSTEM displays
on the DIC. See Ride Control
System Messages on page 5-35.
Driving should be adjusted
accordingly.
Cruise Control
{ Warning
Cruise control can be dangerous
where you cannot drive safely at
a steady speed. Do not use the
cruise control on winding roads or
in heavy traffic.
Cruise control can be dangerous
on slippery roads. On such roads,
fast changes in tyre traction can
cause excessive wheel slip, and
you could lose control. Do not use
cruise control on slippery roads.
With cruise control, a speed of
about 40 km/h (25 mph) or more
can be maintained without keeping
your foot on the accelerator. Cruise
control does not work at speeds
below about 40 km/h (25 mph).
If the brakes are applied, the cruise
control disengages.
If the StabiliTrak® system begins to
limit wheel spin while using cruise
control, the cruise control
automatically disengages. See
Traction Control/Electronic Stability
Control on page 9-29. If a collision
alert occurs when cruise control is
activated, cruise control is
disengaged. See Forward Collision
Alert (FCA) System on page 9-45.
When road conditions allow the
cruise control to be safely used, you
can apply the cruise control again.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (33,1)
Driving and Operating
J (On/Off):
Press to turn the
system on and off. A white cruise
control indicator appears in the
instrument cluster when cruise is
turned on.
+RES (Resume/Accelerate):
Press the control up briefly to make
the vehicle resume a previously set
speed, or press and hold to
accelerate. If cruise control is
already active, use to increase
vehicle speed.
SET− (Set/Coast): Press the
control down briefly to set the speed
and activate cruise control. If cruise
control is already active, use to
decrease vehicle speed.
* (Cancel):
Press to disengage
cruise control without erasing the
set speed from memory.
Setting Cruise Control
If the cruise button is on when not in
use, it could get pressed and go into
cruise when not desired. Keep the
cruise control button off when cruise
is not being used.
9-33
1. Press J to turn the cruise
system on.
Increasing Speed While Cruise
Control is at a Set Speed
2. Get up to the desired speed.
If the cruise control system is
already activated:
3. Move the control down to SET−
and release it.
.
Move the control up toward
+RES and hold until the desired
speed is reached, then
release it.
.
To increase vehicle speed in
small increments, move the
control up toward +RES briefly
and then release it. Each time
this is done, the vehicle goes
about 1.6 km/h (1 mph) faster.
4. Remove foot from the
accelerator.
When the cruise control has been
set to the desired speed, the green
cruise control indicator appears on
the instrument cluster.
Resuming a Set Speed
If the cruise control is set at a
desired speed and then the brakes
are applied, the cruise control is
disengaged without erasing the set
speed from memory.
Once the vehicle speed reaches
about 40 km/h (25 mph) or more,
move the control up toward +RES
briefly. The vehicle returns to the
previous set speed.
Reducing Speed While Cruise
Control is at a Set Speed
If the cruise control system is
already activated:
.
Move the control toward SET−
and hold until the desired lower
speed is reached, then
release it.
.
To decrease the vehicle speed in
small increments, move the
control toward SET− briefly.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-34
Black plate (34,1)
Driving and Operating
Each time this is done, the
vehicle goes about 1.6 km/h
(1 mph) slower.
Overtaking Another Vehicle While
Using Cruise Control
Use the accelerator pedal to
increase the vehicle speed. When
you take your foot off the pedal, the
vehicle will slow down to the
previously set cruise speed. While
pressing the accelerator pedal or
shortly following the release to
override cruise control, briefly
pressing the SET– button will result
in cruise control set to the current
vehicle speed.
Using Cruise Control on Hills
How well the cruise control will work
on hills depends upon the vehicle
speed, load, and the steepness of
the hills. When going up steep hills,
you might have to step on the
accelerator pedal to maintain the
vehicle speed. When going
downhill, you might have to brake or
shift to a lower gear to keep the
vehicle speed down. If the brake is
applied, the cruise control
disengages.
Ending Cruise Control
There are three ways to end cruise
control:
.
Step lightly on the brake pedal.
.
Press
.
To turn off the cruise control,
press J on the steering wheel.
* on the steering wheel.
Erasing Speed Memory
The cruise control set speed is
erased from memory if J is
pressed or if the ignition is
turned off.
Adaptive Cruise Control
If equipped with Adaptive Cruise
Control (ACC), it allows the driver to
select the cruise control set speed
and following gap. Read this entire
section before using this system.
The following gap is the following
time between your vehicle and a
vehicle detected directly ahead in
your path. If no vehicle is detected
in your path, ACC works like regular
cruise control. ACC uses camera
and radar sensors. See Declaration
of Conformity on page 13-1.
If a vehicle is detected in your path,
ACC can apply acceleration or
limited, moderate braking to
maintain the selected following gap.
To disengage ACC, apply the brake.
If ACC is controlling your vehicle
speed when the traction control
system (TCS) or electronic stability
control system activates, the ACC
may automatically disengage. See
Traction Control/Electronic Stability
Control on page 9-29. When road
conditions allow ACC to be safely
used, the ACC can be turned
back on.
ACC will not engage if the TCS or
StabiliTrak electronic stability control
system is disabled.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (35,1)
Driving and Operating
{ Warning
ACC has limited braking ability
and may not have time to slow
the vehicle down enough to avoid
a collision with another vehicle
you are following. This can occur
when vehicles suddenly slow or
stop ahead, or enter your lane.
Also see “Alerting the Driver” in
this section. Complete attention is
always required while driving and
you should be ready to take
action and apply the brakes. See
Defensive Driving on page 9-2.
{ Warning
Adaptive Cruise Control will not
detect or brake for children,
pedestrians, animals, or other
objects.
(Continued)
9-35
Warning (Continued)
Do not use Adaptive Cruise
Control when:
.
On winding and hilly roads or
when the sensors are
blocked by snow, ice, or dirt.
The system may not detect a
vehicle ahead. Keep the
entire front of the vehicle
clean.
.
Visibility is low, such as in
fog, rain, or snow conditions.
Adaptive Cruise Control
performance is limited under
these conditions.
.
On slippery roads where fast
changes in tyre traction can
cause excessive wheel slip.
] (On/Off): Press to turn the
system on or off. A white cruise
control indicator comes on.
+RES (Resume/Accelerate):
Press the control up briefly to
resume to the previous set speed or
hold upwards to accelerate. If cruise
control is already active, use to
increase vehicle speed.
SET− (Set/Coast): Press the
control down briefly to set the speed
and activate ACC. If cruise control is
already active, use to decrease
vehicle speed.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-36
Black plate (36,1)
Driving and Operating
* (Cancel):
Press to disengage
ACC without erasing the set speed
from memory.
2. Get up to the desired speed.
Resuming a Set Speed
3. Press and release the SET−
control on the steering wheel.
3 (Follow Distance Gap): Press
to select a following gap time (or
distance) setting for ACC of Far,
Medium, or Near.
4. Remove foot from the
accelerator.
If the ACC is set at a desired speed
and then the brakes are applied,
ACC is disengaged without erasing
the set speed from memory.
After ACC is set, it may immediately
apply the brakes if a vehicle ahead
is detected closer than the selected
following gap.
To begin using ACC again, press
+RES up briefly on the steering
wheel. The vehicle returns to the
previous set speed.
Setting Adaptive Cruise Control
If cruise control is on when not in
use, the cruise control on/off control
could get pressed and cruise control
could become active when not
desired. Keep the cruise control off
when cruise is not being used.
Select the set speed desired for
cruise. This is the vehicle speed
when no vehicle is detected in
its path.
ACC will not set at a speed less
than 25 km/h (16 mph), although it
can be resumed when driving at
lower speeds.
To set ACC:
1. Press
].
Increasing Speed While ACC is at
a Set Speed
If ACC is already activated, do one
of the following:
.
The ACC indicator displays on the
instrument cluster. When the ACC is
active, the indicator turns green.
Be mindful of speed limits,
surrounding traffic speeds, and
weather conditions when selecting
the set speed.
Use the accelerator to get to the
higher speed. Press SET– down.
Release the control and the
accelerator pedal. The vehicle
will now cruise at the higher
speed.
When the accelerator pedal is
pressed, ACC will not brake
because it is overridden.
A warning message will appear
on the Driver Information Centre
(DIC). See Cruise Control
Messages on page 5-29.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (37,1)
Driving and Operating
.
Press and hold +RES up until
the desired set speed appears
on the display, then release it.
.
To increase vehicle speed in
small increments, press +RES
up briefly. For each press, the
vehicle goes 5 km/h (1 mph)
faster.
When it is determined that there is
no vehicle ahead or the vehicle
ahead is beyond the selected
following gap, then the vehicle
speed will increase to the set speed.
Reducing Speed While ACC is at a
Set Speed
If ACC is already activated, do one
of the following:
.
.
Use the brake to get to the
desired lower speed. Press
SET– down and release the
accelerator pedal. The vehicle
will now cruise at the lower
speed.
Press and hold SET− down until
the desired lower speed is
reached, then release it.
.
To decrease the vehicle speed in
smaller increments, press SET−
down briefly. For each press, the
vehicle goes about 5 km/h
(1 mph) slower.
Selecting the Follow Distance
When a slower moving vehicle is
detected ahead within the selected
following gap, ACC will adjust the
vehicle's speed and attempt to
maintain the follow distance gap
selected.
Press 3 on the steering wheel to
adjust the following gap. When
pressed, the current gap setting
displays briefly on the instrument
cluster. Subsequent presses cycle
the gap button through three
settings: Far, Medium, or Near.
When pressed, the current gap
setting displays briefly on the
instrument cluster. The gap setting
will be maintained until it is
changed.
9-37
Since each gap setting corresponds
to a following time (Far, Medium,
or Near), the following distance will
vary based on vehicle speed. The
faster the vehicle speed, the further
back your vehicle will follow a
vehicle detected ahead. Consider
traffic and weather conditions when
selecting the following gap. The
range of selectable gaps may not be
appropriate for all drivers and
driving conditions.
Changing the gap setting
automatically changes the alert
timing sensitivity (Far, Medium,
or Near) for the Forward Collision
Alert (FCA) feature. See Forward
Collision Alert (FCA) System on
page 9-45.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-38
Black plate (38,1)
Driving and Operating
Alerting the Driver
Approaching and Following a
Vehicle
lights will come on. The automatic
braking may feel or sound different
than if the brakes were applied
manually. This is normal.
Stationary or Very Slow-Moving
Objects
{ Warning
The vehicle ahead symbol is in the
instrument cluster.
If ACC is engaged driver action may
be required when ACC cannot apply
sufficient braking because of
approaching a vehicle too rapidly.
When this condition occurs, six red
lights will flash on the windscreen
and either eight beeps will sound
from the front, or both sides of the
Safety Alert Seat will pulse five
times. See “Collision/Detection
Systems” under Vehicle
Personalisation on page 5-38.
See Defensive Driving on page 9-2.
The vehicle ahead symbol only
displays when a vehicle is detected
in your vehicle's path moving in the
same direction.
If this symbol is not displaying, ACC
will not respond to or brake to
vehicles ahead.
ACC automatically slows the vehicle
down and adjusts vehicle speed to
follow the vehicle in front at the
selected follow gap. The vehicle
speed increases or decreases to
follow the vehicle in front of you, but
will not exceed the set speed. It may
apply limited braking, if necessary.
When braking is active, the brake
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
may not detect and react to
stopped or slow-moving vehicles
ahead of you. For example, the
system may not brake for a
vehicle that it has never detected
moving. This can occur in
stop-and-go traffic or when a
vehicle suddenly appears due to
a vehicle ahead changing lanes.
Your vehicle may not stop and
could cause a crash. Use caution
when using ACC. Your complete
attention is always required while
driving and you should be ready
to take action and apply the
brakes.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (39,1)
Driving and Operating
ACC Automatically Disengages
ACC may automatically disengage
and the driver will need to manually
apply the brakes to slow the
vehicle when:
.
The sensors are blocked.
.
The Traction Control System
(TCS) or electronic stability
control system has activated or
been disabled.
.
There is no traffic and nothing to
detect on the side of the road.
.
There is a fault in the system.
.
The brakes get heated.
A message indicating that cruise is
disengaging will appear on the DIC
and the ACC active symbol will not
be displayed when ACC is no longer
active.
Notification to Resume ACC
ACC will maintain a follow time/
distance gap behind a detected
vehicle and slow your vehicle to a
stop behind that vehicle.
If the stopped vehicle ahead has
driven away and ACC has not
resumed, the vehicle ahead symbol
will flash as a reminder. In addition,
the left and right sides of the Safety
Alert Seat will pulse three times,
or three beeps will sound. See ”Alert
Type” and “Go Notifier” in “Collision/
Detection Systems” under Vehicle
Personalisation on page 5-38.
When the vehicle ahead drives
away, press +RES or the
accelerator pedal to resume ACC.
If stopped for more than
two minutes or if the driver door is
opened and the driver safety belt is
unbuckled, the ACC automatically
applies the electric parking brake to
hold the vehicle. The electric
parking brake status light will turn
on. See Parking Brake on
page 9-27. To release the electric
handbrake, press the accelerator
pedal.
A DIC warning message may
display indicating to shift to P (Park)
before exiting the vehicle. See
Vehicle Messages on page 5-28.
9-39
{ Warning
If ACC has stopped the vehicle,
and if ACC is disengaged, turned
off, or cancelled, the vehicle will
no longer be held at a stop. The
vehicle can move. When ACC is
holding the vehicle at a stop,
always be prepared to manually
apply the brakes.
{ Warning
Leaving the vehicle without
placing it in P (Park) can be
dangerous. Do not leave the
vehicle while it is being held at a
stop by ACC. Always place the
vehicle in P (Park) and turn off
the ignition before leaving the
vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-40
Black plate (40,1)
Driving and Operating
ACC Override
If using the accelerator pedal while
ACC is active, a DIC warning
message will indicate that automatic
braking will not occur. See Vehicle
Messages on page 5-28. ACC will
resume operation when the
accelerator pedal is not being
pressed.
{ Warning
The ACC will not automatically
apply the brakes if your foot is
resting on the accelerator pedal.
You could crash into a vehicle
ahead of you.
Bends in the Road
{ Warning
On bends, ACC may not detect a
vehicle ahead in your lane. You
could be startled if the vehicle
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
accelerates up to the set speed,
especially when following a
vehicle exiting or entering exit
ramps. You could lose control of
the vehicle or crash. Do not use
ACC while driving on an entrance
or exit ramp. Always be ready to
use the brakes if necessary.
{ Warning
On bends, ACC may respond to a
vehicle in another lane, or may
not have time to react to a vehicle
in your lane. You could crash into
a vehicle ahead of you, or lose
control of your vehicle. Give extra
attention in bends and be ready
to use the brakes if necessary.
Select an appropriate speed while
driving in bends.
ACC may operate differently in a
sharp bend. It may reduce the
vehicle speed if the bend is too
sharp.
When following a vehicle and
entering a bend, ACC may not
detect the vehicle ahead and
accelerate to the set speed. When
this happens the vehicle ahead
symbol will not appear.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (41,1)
Driving and Operating
Other Vehicle Lane Changes
ACC may detect a vehicle that is
not in your lane and apply the
brakes.
ACC may occasionally provide an
alert and/or braking that is
considered unnecessary. It could
respond to vehicles in different
lanes, signs, guardrails, and other
stationary objects when entering or
exiting a bend. This is normal
operation. The vehicle does not
need service.
9-41
Do not use ACC when driving on
steep hills or when towing a trailer.
ACC will not detect a vehicle in the
lane while driving on steep hills. The
driver will often need to take over
acceleration and braking on steep
hills, especially when towing a
trailer. If the brakes are applied, the
ACC disengages.
Ending ACC
ACC will not detect a vehicle ahead
until it is completely in the lane. The
brake may need to be manually
applied.
There are three ways to end ACC:
Do Not Use ACC on Hills and
When Towing a Trailer
.
.
Step lightly on the brake pedal.
.
Press
*.
Press ].
Erasing Speed Memory
The cruise control set speed is
erased from memory if ] is
pressed or if the ignition is
turned off.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-42
Black plate (42,1)
Driving and Operating
Cleaning the Sensing System
The camera sensor on the back of
the rearview mirror and the radar
sensors on the front of the vehicle
can become blocked by snow, ice,
dirt, or mud. These areas need to
be cleaned for ACC to operate
properly.
For cleaning instructions, see
“Washing the Vehicle” under
Exterior Care on page 10-78.
System operation may also be
limited under snow, heavy rain or
road spray conditions.
Driver Assistance
Systems
This vehicle may have features that
work together to help avoid crashes
or reduce crash damage while
driving, reversing, and parking.
Read this entire section before
using these systems.
{ Warning
Do not rely on the Driver
Assistance Systems. These
systems do not replace the need
for paying attention and driving
safely. You may not hear or feel
alerts or warnings provided by
these systems. Failure to use
proper care when driving may
result in injury, death, or vehicle
damage. See Defensive Driving
on page 9-2.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
Under many conditions, these
systems will not:
.
Detect children, pedestrians,
bicyclists, or animals.
.
Detect vehicles or objects
outside the area monitored by
the system.
.
Work at all driving speeds.
.
Warn you or provide you with
enough time to avoid a crash.
.
Work under poor visibility or
bad weather conditions.
.
Work if the detection sensor
is not cleaned or is covered
by ice, snow, mud, or dirt.
Complete attention is always
required while driving, and you
should be ready to take action
and apply the brakes and/or steer
the vehicle to avoid crashes.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (43,1)
Driving and Operating
Audible or Safety Alert Seat
Some driver assistance features
alert the driver of obstacles by
beeping. To change the volume of
the warning chime, see “Comfort
and Convenience” under Vehicle
Personalisation on page 5-38.
If equipped with the Safety Alert
Seat, the driver seat cushion may
provide a vibrating pulse alert
instead of beeping. To change this,
see “Collision/Detection Systems”
under Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Assistance Systems for
Parking or Reversing
When the vehicle is in R (Reverse),
the Rear Vision Camera (RVC) and
Rear Parking Assist may help the
driver to avoid a crash or to reduce
crash damage. Some models may
also have Rear Cross Traffic Alert
(RCTA), and/or Front Parking
Assist.
9-43
When the vehicle is shifted into
R (Reverse), the RVC displays an
image of the area behind the vehicle
in the centre stack display.
{ Warning
The RVC system does not display
children, pedestrians, bicyclists,
animals, or any other object
located outside the camera's field
of view, below the bumper,
or under the vehicle. Perceived
distances may be different from
actual distances. Do not reverse
the vehicle using only the RVC
screen, during longer, higher
speed reversing manoeuvres,
or where there could be cross
traffic. Failure to use proper care
before reversing may result in
injury, death, or vehicle damage.
Always check behind and around
the vehicle before reversing.
1. View Displayed by the Camera
1. View Displayed by the Camera
2. Corners of the Rear Bumper
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-44
Black plate (44,1)
Driving and Operating
Displayed images may be farther or
closer than they appear. The area
displayed is limited and objects that
are close to either corner of the
bumper or under the bumper do not
display.
Use caution while changing lanes
when towing a trailer, as the RCTA
detection zones that extend out
from the back of the vehicle do not
move further back when a trailer is
towed.
A warning triangle may display on
the RVC screen to show where the
Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist
(URPA) has detected an object. This
triangle changes from amber to red
and increases in size the closer the
object.
URPA and Front Park Assist (if
equipped), operate at speeds of
less than 8 km/h (5 mph) and detect
objects 25 cm (10 in) high off the
ground and below bumper level,
using the sensors on the bumpers.
URPA detects objects up to 2.5 m
(8 ft) behind the vehicle, and Front
Park Assist detects objects up to
1.2 m (4 ft) in front of the
vehicle. These detection distances
may be less during warmer or humid
weather.
On vehicles with the Rear Cross
Traffic Alert (RCTA), a triangle with
an arrow may also display on the
RVC screen to warn of traffic
coming from either direction. This
system detects objects coming from
up to 20 m (65 ft) from the left or
right side behind the vehicle. When
an object is detected, either three
beeps sound or three Safety Alert
Seat pulses occur on the left or right
side, depending on the direction of
the detected vehicle.
Warning (Continued)
are too close or too far from the
vehicle. It is not available at
speeds greater than 8 km/h
(5 mph). To prevent injury, death,
or vehicle damage, even with
parking assist, always check the
area around the vehicle and
check all mirrors before moving
forward or reversing.
{ Warning
The parking assist system does
not detect children, pedestrians,
bicyclists, animals, or objects
located below the bumper or that
(Continued)
The instrument cluster may have a
parking assist display with bars that
show “distance to object” and object
location information for URPA, and
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (45,1)
Driving and Operating
on some vehicles, for the Front
Parking Assist system. As the object
gets closer, more bars light up.
When an object is first detected in
the rear, one beep will be heard
from the rear, or both sides of the
Safety Alert Seat will pulse two
times. When an object is very close
(<0.6 m (2 ft) in the vehicle rear,
or <0.3 m (1 ft) in the vehicle front),
five beeps will sound from the front
or rear, or both sides of the Safety
Alert Seat will pulse five times.
Beeps for Front Parking Assist are
higher pitched than for Rear Parking
Assist.
Turning the Features On or Off
indicator light next to the button
comes on when the features are on
and turns off when the features
have been disabled.
The Rear Vision Camera (RVC) can
be turned on or off through the
Settings menu on the infotainment
system. The parking assist symbols,
guidance lines, and Rear Cross
Traffic Alert (RCTA) can also be
turned off. To turn the RVC system,
symbols, guidance lines, or RCTA
on or off:
1. On the infotainment system,
press the Settings screen
button, or turn the MENU knob
to highlight Settings and
press MENU.
2. Select Rear Camera.
3. Press Rear Camera Display,
Park Assist Symbols, Guidance
Lines, or Rear Cross Traffic Alert
and then select OFF or ON.
The X button near the shift lever
is used to turn on or off the Front
and Rear Parking Assist. The
9-45
Assistance Systems for
Driving
If equipped, when driving the
vehicle forward, Forward Collision
Alert (FCA), Lane Departure
Warning (LDW), Side Blind Zone
Alert (SBZA), and/or the Active
Emergency Braking System can
help to avoid a crash or reduce
crash damage.
Forward Collision Alert
(FCA) System
The FCA system may help to avoid
or reduce the harm caused by
front-end crashes. FCA provides a
red flashing alert on the windscreen,
and beeps or pulses the Safety Alert
Seat when approaching a vehicle
directly ahead too quickly. FCA also
provides a visual alert if following
another vehicle much too closely.
FCA detects vehicles within a
distance of approximately 60 m
(197 ft) and operates at speeds
above 40 km/h (25 mph). If the
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-46
Black plate (46,1)
Driving and Operating
vehicle has Adaptive Cruise Control
(ACC), it can detect vehicles to
distances of approximately 110 m
(360 ft) and operates at all speeds.
See Adaptive Cruise Control on
page 9-34.
of “Collision/Detection Systems”
under Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
Detecting the Vehicle Ahead
{ Warning
FCA is a warning system and
does not apply the brakes. When
approaching a slower-moving or
stopped vehicle ahead too rapidly,
or when following a vehicle too
closely, FCA may not provide a
warning with enough time to help
avoid a crash. FCA does not warn
of pedestrians, animals, signs,
guardrails, bridges, construction
barrels, or other objects. Be ready
to take action and apply the
brakes. For more information, see
Defensive Driving on page 9-2.
FCA can be disabled through
vehicle personalisation. See the
“Auto Collision Preparation” portion
FCA warnings will not occur unless
the FCA system detects a vehicle
ahead. The vehicle-ahead indicator
will display green when a vehicle is
detected in front. Vehicles may not
be detected on bends, highway exit
ramps, or hills; or due to poor
visibility. FCA will not detect another
vehicle ahead until it is completely
in the driving lane.
{ Warning
FCA does not provide a warning
to help avoid a crash, unless it
detects a vehicle. FCA may not
detect a vehicle ahead if the FCA
sensor is blocked by dirt, snow,
or ice, or if the windscreen is
damaged. It may also not detect a
vehicle on winding or hilly roads,
or in conditions that can limit
visibility such as fog, rain,
or snow, or if the headlamps or
windscreen are not cleaned or in
proper condition. Keep the
windscreen, headlamps, and FCA
sensors clean and in good repair.
Collision Alert
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (47,1)
Driving and Operating
When the vehicle is started, this
series of red lights will come on to
indicate the system is operating.
When your vehicle approaches
another vehicle too rapidly, the red
lights will flash on the windscreen.
Either eight beeps will sound from
the front, or both sides of the Safety
Alert Seat will pulse five times. If a
collision alert occurs when cruise
control is activated, cruise control is
disengaged.
Selecting the Alert Timing
Tailgating Alert
With Adaptive Cruise Control
9-47
Press the collision alert/following
gap button on the steering wheel to
set the FCA timing to far, medium,
near, or on some vehicles, off. The
first button press shows the current
setting on the DIC. Additional button
presses will change this setting. The
chosen setting will remain until it is
changed and will affect the timing of
both the Collision Alert and the
Tailgating Alert features. The timing
of both alerts will vary based on
vehicle speed. The faster the
vehicle speed, the farther away the
alert will occur. Consider traffic and
weather conditions when selecting
the alert timing. The range of
selectable alert timing may not be
appropriate for all drivers and
driving conditions.
Changing the FCA timing setting
automatically changes the following
gap setting (Far, Medium, or Near)
for the Adaptive Cruise Control
(ACC) feature.
The vehicle-ahead indicator will
display amber when you are
following a vehicle ahead much too
closely.
Without Adaptive Cruise Control
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-48
Black plate (48,1)
Driving and Operating
Unnecessary Alerts
Intelligent Brake Assist (IBA)
FCA may provide unnecessary
alerts for turning vehicles, vehicles
in other lanes, objects that are not
vehicles, or shadows. These alerts
are normal operation and the
vehicle does not need service.
IBA may activate when the brake
pedal is applied quickly by providing
a boost to braking based on the
speed of approach and distance to
a vehicle ahead.
Cleaning the System
If the FCA system does not seem to
operate properly, cleaning the
outside of the windscreen in front of
the camera sensor and the front of
the vehicle may correct the issue.
Active Emergency
Braking System
If the vehicle has Adaptive Cruise
Control (ACC) it also has the Active
Emergency Braking System, which
includes Intelligent Brake Assist
(IBA) and the Automatic Collision
Preparation (ACP) System. These
systems can provide a boost to
braking or automatically brake the
vehicle to help avoid or lessen the
severity of crashes.
Minor brake pedal pulsations or
pedal movement during this time is
normal and the brake pedal should
continue to be applied as needed.
IBA will automatically disengage
only when the brake pedal is
released.
{ Warning
IBA may increase vehicle braking
in situations when it may not be
necessary. You could block the
flow of traffic. If this occurs, take
your foot off the brake pedal and
then apply the brakes as needed.
Automatic Collision
Preparation (ACP) System
ACP may help reduce crash
damage by applying the vehicle's
brake system and has a detection
range of approximately 60 m
(197 ft). Braking can only occur if a
vehicle is detected ahead in your
path. This is shown by the FCA
vehicle-ahead indicator being lit.
See Forward Collision Alert (FCA)
System on page 9-45.
{ Warning
ACP is an emergency crash
preparation feature and is not
designed to avoid crashes. Do
not rely on ACP to brake the
vehicle.
ACP may not:
.
Respond to stopped vehicles,
pedestrians, or animals.
.
Detect a vehicle ahead on
winding or hilly roads.
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (49,1)
Driving and Operating
Warning (Continued)
.
Detect a stopped or
slow-moving vehicle or other
object ahead.
.
Detect a vehicle when
weather limits visibility, such
as in fog, rain, or snow. In
these situations, ACP sensor
performance is limited.
Complete attention is always
required while driving, and you
should be ready to take action
and apply the brakes and/or steer
the vehicle to avoid crashes.
Brake Preparation
When quickly approaching a vehicle
ahead, Brake Preparation reduces
brake response time by having the
brake system prepared for driver
braking to occur more rapidly.
Automatic Braking
In some imminent front-end crash
situations, if the driver has not
applied the brakes, Automatic
Braking applies the brakes to help
reduce crash damage. It may even
help avoid some very low speed
crashes.
Automatic Braking may slow the
vehicle to a complete stop to try to
avoid a potential crash. If this
happens, Automatic Braking will
engage the electric handbrake,
Electric Parking Brake (EPB), to
hold the vehicle at a stop. To
release the EPB, press the EPB
button. A firm press of the
accelerator pedal will also release
Automatic Braking and the EPB.
{ Warning
Automatic Braking may
automatically brake the vehicle in
situations where it may be
unnecessary. It could respond to
(Continued)
9-49
Warning (Continued)
a turning vehicle ahead,
guardrails, signs, and other
non-moving objects. This could
be uncomfortable and startling. To
override Automatic Braking, firmly
press the accelerator pedal, if it is
safe to do so.
Automatic Braking can be disabled
or reduced through vehicle
personalisation. See the “Auto
Collision Preparation” portion of
“Collision/Detection Systems” under
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38.
{ Warning
Using the Automatic Collision
Preparation System while towing
a trailer could cause you to lose
control of the vehicle and crash.
Turn the system off when towing
a trailer.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-50
Black plate (50,1)
Driving and Operating
Side Blind Zone
Alert (SBZA)
If equipped, the Side Blind Zone
Alert system is a lane-changing aid
that assists drivers with avoiding
crashes that occur with vehicles in
the side blind zone (or spot) areas.
The SBZA warning display will light
up in the corresponding outside side
mirror and will flash if the indicator
is on.
Warning (Continued)
making a lane change, always
check mirrors, glance over your
shoulder, and use the indicators.
SBZA Detection Zones
{ Warning
SBZA does not alert the driver to
vehicles rapidly approaching
outside of the side blind zones,
pedestrians, bicyclists,
or animals. It may not provide
alerts when changing lanes under
all driving conditions. Failure to
use proper care when changing
lanes may result in injury, death,
or vehicle damage. Before
(Continued)
The SBZA sensor covers a zone of
approximately one lane over from
both sides of the vehicle, or 3.5 m
(11 ft). The height of the zone is
approximately between
0.5 m (1.5 ft) and 2 m (6 ft) off the
ground. This zone starts at
approximately the middle of the
vehicle and goes back 5 m (16 ft).
How the System Works
The SBZA symbol lights up in the
side mirrors when the system
detects a vehicle in the next lane
over that is in the side blind zone.
This indicates it may be unsafe to
change lanes. Before making a lane
change, check the SBZA display,
check mirrors, glance over your
shoulder, and use the indicators.
Left Side Mirror Right Side Mirror
Display
Display
When the vehicle is started, both
outside mirror SBZA displays will
briefly come on to indicate the
system is operating. When the
vehicle is moving forward, the left-
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (51,1)
Driving and Operating
or right-side mirror display will light
up if a vehicle is detected in that
blind zone. If the indicator is
activated in the same direction as a
detected vehicle, this display will
flash as an extra warning not to
change lanes.
SBZA can be disabled through
vehicle personalisation. See
“Collision/Detection Systems” under
Vehicle Personalisation on
page 5-38. If SBZA is disabled by
the driver, the SBZA mirror displays
will not light up.
When the System Does Not
Seem to Work Properly
SBZA displays may not come on
when passing a vehicle quickly or
when towing a trailer. The SBZA
detection zones that extend back
from the side of the vehicle do not
move further back when a trailer is
towed. Use caution while changing
lanes when towing a trailer. SBZA
may alert to objects attached to the
vehicle, such as a trailer, bicycle,
or object extending out to either side
of the vehicle. This is normal system
operation; the vehicle does not need
service.
SBZA may not always alert the
driver to vehicles in the side blind
zone, especially in wet conditions.
The system does not need to be
serviced. The system may light up
due to guardrails, signs, trees,
shrubs, and other non-moving
objects. This is normal system
operation; the vehicle does not need
service.
SBZA may not operate when the
SBZA sensors in the left or right
corners of the rear bumper are
covered with mud, dirt, snow, ice,
or slush, or in heavy rainstorms. For
cleaning instructions, see "Washing
the Vehicle" under Exterior Care on
page 10-78. If the DIC still displays
the system unavailable message
after cleaning both sides of the
vehicle toward the rear corners of
the vehicle, see your dealer.
9-51
If the SBZA displays do not light up
when vehicles are in the blind zone
and the system is clean, the system
may need service. Take the vehicle
to your dealer.
When SBZA is disabled for any
reason other than the driver turning
it off, the Side Blind Zone Alert On
option will not be available on the
personalisation menu.
Declaration of Conformity
See Declaration of Conformity on
page 13-1.
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW)
If equipped, LDW may help avoid
crashes due to unintentional lane
departures. It may provide a
warning if the vehicle is crossing a
detected lane marker without using
an indicator in the lane departure
direction. LDW uses a camera
sensor to detect the lane markings.
It only operates at speeds of 56
km/h (35 mph) or greater.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-52
Black plate (52,1)
Driving and Operating
When the vehicle crosses a
detected lane marking, the LDW
indicator will flash and either three
beeps will be sounded from the left
or right side, or three Safety Alert
Seat pulses will occur on the left or
right side of the seat, depending on
the lane departure direction. LDW
will not warn if the indicator is on in
the departure direction, or if a sharp
manoeuvre is made.
{ Warning
The LDW system is an aid to help
the vehicle stay in the driving
lane. It does not steer the vehicle.
The LDW system may not:
.
Provide enough time to avoid
a crash.
.
Detect lane markings under
bad weather conditions or if
the windscreen is dirty.
.
Detect lane markings and will
not detect road edges.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
.
Warn that the vehicle is
crossing a lane marking if the
system does not detect the
lane marking.
If LDW only detects lane
markings on one side of the road,
it will only warn you when
departing the lane on the side
where it has detected a lane
marker. Even with LDW, always
keep your attention on the road
and maintain proper vehicle
position within the lane, or vehicle
damage, injury, or death could
occur. Always keep the
windscreen clean and do not use
LDW in bad weather conditions.
How the System Works
The LDW camera sensor is on the
windscreen ahead of the rearview
mirror.
To turn LDW on and off, press @
near the shift lever. The control
indicator will light when LDW is on.
When the vehicle is started, the
LDW indicator on the instrument
cluster will come on briefly.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (53,1)
Driving and Operating
If LDW is on, the LDW indicator will
appear green if the system detects
a left or right lane marking while the
vehicle is travelling at 56 km/h (35
mph) or greater. If the vehicle
crosses a detected lane marking
without using the indicator in the
lane departure direction, this
indicator will change to amber and
flash. In addition, three beeps will
be sounded from the left or right
side, or the Safety Alert Seat will
pulse three times on either the left
or right side of the seat, depending
on the lane departure direction.
When the System Does Not
Seem to Work Properly
If the LDW symbol does not appear
when the system is on and the
vehicle is travelling at least 56 km/h
(35 mph):
.
The lane markings on the road
may not be seen.
.
The camera sensor may be
blocked by dirt, snow, or ice.
.
.
The windscreen may be
damaged.
The weather may be limiting
visibility.
This is normal operation; the vehicle
does not need service.
Lane markings may not be detected
on bends, motorway exit ramps,
or hills; or due to poor visibility.
If the LDW camera system does not
seem to operate properly, cleaning
the outside of the windscreen in
front of the camera sensor may
correct the issue.
{ Warning
LDW does not provide a warning
to help avoid a crash, unless it
detects the lane markings. LDW
may not detect the lane markings
if the camera sensor is blocked
by dirt, snow, or ice, or if the
windscreen is damaged. It may
also not detect a lane on winding
(Continued)
9-53
Warning (Continued)
or hilly roads, or in conditions that
can limit visibility such as fog,
rain, or snow, or if the headlamps
or windscreen are not cleaned or
in proper condition. Keep the
windscreen, headlamps, and
camera sensors clean and in
good repair.
LDW warnings may occur due to tar
marks, shadows, cracks in the road,
or other road imperfections. This is
normal system operation; the
vehicle does not need service.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-54
Black plate (54,1)
Driving and Operating
Fuel
Use the recommended fuel for
proper vehicle maintenance.
Recommended Fuel
Use regular unleaded petrol with a
posted octane rating of 95 RON or
higher. If the octane rating is less
than 95 RON, an audible knocking
noise may be heard. If this occurs,
use a petrol rated at 95 RON or
higher as soon as possible. If heavy
knocking is heard when using petrol
rated at 95 RON or higher, the
engine needs service.
Use of Seasonal Fuels
Use summer and winter fuels in the
appropriate season. Driving or
starting could be affected if the
incorrect fuel is used. Drive the
vehicle with the engine running until
the fuel is a half tank or less, then
refuel with the current seasonal fuel.
Prohibited Fuels
Petrols containing oxygenates, such
as ethers and ethanol, as well as
reformulated petrols are available in
some cities. If these petrols comply
with the previously described
specification, then they are
acceptable to use. However, E85
(85% ethanol) and other fuels
containing more than 15% ethanol
must be used only in flex fuel
vehicles.
{ Caution
Do not use fuel containing
methanol. It can corrode metal
parts in the fuel system and also
damage plastic and rubber parts.
That damage would not be
covered under the vehicle
warranty.
Some petrols that are not
reformulated for low emissions can
contain an octane-enhancing
additive called
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese
tricarbonyl (MMT). Do not use
petrols with MMT as they can
reduce spark plug life and affect
emission control system
performance. The malfunction
indicator lamp may turn on. If this
occurs, see your dealer for service.
Fuel Additives
Petrol should contain detergent
additives that help prevent engine
and fuel system deposits from
forming. Clean fuel injectors and
intake valves will allow the emission
control system to work properly.
Some petrol does not contain
sufficient quantities of additive to
keep fuel injectors and intake valves
clean. To make up for this lack of
detergency, add Fuel System
Treatment PLUS, part number
88861013 to the fuel tank at every
engine oil change or every
15 000 km, whichever occurs first.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (55,1)
Driving and Operating
Filling the Tank
{ Warning
Fuel vapours and fuel fires burn
violently and can cause injury or
death.
.
To help avoid injuries to you
and others, read and follow
all the instructions on the fuel
pump island.
.
Turn off the engine when
refuelling.
.
Keep sparks, flames, and
smoking materials away
from fuel.
.
Do not leave the fuel pump
unattended.
.
Do not reenter the vehicle
while pumping fuel.
.
Keep children away from the
fuel pump and never let
children pump fuel.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
.
Fuel can spray out if the fuel
cap is opened too quickly.
This spray can happen if the
tank is nearly full, and is
more likely in hot weather.
Open the fuel cap slowly and
wait for any hiss noise to stop
then unscrew the cap all
the way
9-55
The fuel cap is behind a hinged fuel
door on the passenger side of the
vehicle. To open the fuel filler flap,
push and release the rearward
centre edge of the flap. If equipped,
the fuel door is locked when the
vehicle doors are locked. Press K
on the RKE transmitter to unlock.
To remove the fuel cap, turn it
slowly anticlockwise.
While refuelling, hang the tethered
fuel cap from the hook on the
fuel door.
When reinstalling the cap, turn it
clockwise until it clicks once,
otherwise the malfunction indicator
lamp could turn on. See Malfunction
Indicator Lamp on page 5-15.
Be careful not to spill fuel. Do not
top off or overfill the tank and wait a
few seconds after you have finished
pumping before removing the
nozzle. Clean fuel from painted
surfaces as soon as possible. See
Exterior Care on page 10-78.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-56
Black plate (56,1)
Driving and Operating
When replacing the fuel cap, turn it
clockwise until it clicks once. Make
sure the cap is fully installed. The
diagnostic system can determine if
the fuel cap has been left off or
improperly installed. This would
allow fuel to evaporate into the
atmosphere. See Malfunction
Indicator Lamp on page 5-15.
{ Warning
If a fire starts while you are
refuelling, do not remove the
nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by
shutting off the pump or by
notifying the station attendant.
Leave the area immediately.
{ Caution
If a new fuel cap is needed, be
sure to get the right type of cap
from your dealer. The wrong type
of fuel cap might not fit properly,
(Continued)
Caution (Continued)
might cause the malfunction
indicator lamp to light, and could
damage the fuel tank and
emissions system. See
Malfunction Indicator Lamp on
page 5-15.
Warning (Continued)
.
Remove the container from
the vehicle, boot, or pickup
bed before filling.
.
Place the container on the
ground.
.
Place the nozzle inside the fill
opening of the container
before dispensing fuel, and
keep it in contact with the fill
opening until filling is
complete.
.
Fill the container no more
than 95% full to allow for
expansion.
.
Do not smoke, light matches,
or use lighters while
pumping fuel.
.
Avoid using mobile phones or
other electronic devices.
Filling a Portable Fuel
Container
{ Warning
Filling a portable fuel container
while it is in the vehicle can cause
fuel vapours that can ignite either
by static electricity or other
means. You or others could be
badly burned and the vehicle
could be damaged. Always:
.
Use approved fuel
containers.
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (57,1)
Driving and Operating
Trailer Towing
General Towing
Information
Only use towing equipment that has
been designed for the vehicle.
Contact your dealer or trailering
dealer for assistance with preparing
the vehicle for towing a trailer. Read
the entire section before towing a
trailer.
For towing a disabled vehicle, see
Towing the Vehicle on page 10-74.
For towing the vehicle behind
another vehicle such as a motor
home, see Recreational Vehicle
Towing on page 10-76.
Driving Characteristics
and Towing Tips
Driving with a Trailer
When towing a trailer:
.
Become familiar with the state
and local laws that apply
specifically to trailer towing.
.
Do not tow a trailer during the
first 800 km (500 mi), to prevent
damage to the engine, axle or
other parts.
.
Then, during the first 800 km
(500 mi) trailer towing, do not
drive over 80 km/h (50 mph) and
do not make starts at full throttle.
.
The vehicle can tow in D (Drive).
Use a lower gear if the
transmission shifts too often.
.
Do not use Adaptive Cruise
Control when towing.
.
The Automatic Collision
Preparation System should be
set to “Off” when towing. See
Active Emergency Braking
System on page 9-48.
.
Turn off Park Assist when
towing.
9-57
{ Warning
When towing a trailer, exhaust
gases may collect at the rear of
the vehicle and enter if the
tailgate, boot/hatch, or rear-most
window is open.
When towing a trailer:
.
Do not drive with the tailgate,
boot/hatch, or rear-most
window open.
.
Fully open the air outlets on
or under the instrument
panel.
.
Also adjust the Climate
Control system to a setting
that brings in only outside air.
See “Climate Control
Systems” in the Index.
For more information about
Carbon Monoxide, see Engine
Exhaust on page 9-20.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-58
Black plate (58,1)
Driving and Operating
Towing a trailer requires a certain
amount of experience. The
combination you are driving is
longer and not as responsive as the
vehicle itself. Get acquainted with
the handling and braking of the rig
before setting out for the open road.
Before starting, check all trailer hitch
parts and attachments, safety
chains, electrical connectors, lamps,
tyres, and mirrors. If the trailer has
electric brakes, start the
combination moving and then apply
the trailer brake controller by hand
to be sure the brakes work.
During the trip, check occasionally
to be sure that the load is secure
and the lamps and any trailer
brakes still work.
Towing with a Stability Control
System
When towing, the sound of the
stability control system might be
heard. The system is reacting to the
vehicle movement caused by the
trailer, which mainly occurs during
cornering. This is normal when
towing heavier trailers.
Following Distance
Stay at least twice as far behind the
vehicle ahead as you would when
driving the vehicle without a trailer.
This can help to avoid situations
that require heavy braking and
sudden turns.
Overtaking
More overtaking distance is needed
when towing a trailer. Because the
rig is longer, it is necessary to go
farther beyond the passed vehicle
before returning to the lane.
Reversing
Hold the bottom of the steering
wheel with one hand. To move the
trailer to the left, move your hand to
the left. To move the trailer to the
right, move your hand to the right.
Always reverse slowly and,
if possible, have someone
guide you.
Making Turns
{ Caution
Making very sharp turns while
trailering could cause the trailer to
come in contact with the vehicle.
The vehicle could be damaged.
Avoid making very sharp turns
while trailering.
When turning with a trailer, make
wider turns than normal so the
trailer will not strike soft shoulders,
curbs, road signs, trees or other
objects. Use the indicators well in
advance and avoid jerky or sudden
manoeuvres.
Turn Signals When Towing a
Trailer
The indicator indicators on the
instrument cluster flash whenever
signalling a turn or lane change.
Properly hooked up, the trailer lights
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (59,1)
Driving and Operating
9-59
If parking the rig on a hill:
When towing a trailer, the arrows on
the instrument cluster flash for turns
even if the bulbs on the trailer are
burned out. Check occasionally to
be sure the trailer bulbs are still
working.
grades, the vehicle could show
signs similar to engine overheating.
To avoid this, let the engine run
while parked, preferably on level
ground, with the transmission in
P (Park) for a few minutes before
turning the engine off. If the
overheat warning comes on, see
Engine Overheating on page 10-16.
Driving on Grades
Parking on Hills
3. When the wheel chocks are in
place, release the brake pedal
until the chocks absorb the load.
also flash, telling other drivers the
vehicle is turning, changing lanes or
stopping.
Reduce speed and shift to a lower
gear before starting down a long or
steep downhill gradient. If the
transmission is not shifted down, the
brakes might have to be used so
much that they would get hot and no
longer work well.
The vehicle can tow in D (Drive).
Use a lower gear if the transmission
shifts too often.
When towing at high altitude on
steep uphill grades, engine coolant
boils at a lower temperature than at
normal altitudes. If the engine is
turned off immediately after towing
at high altitude on steep uphill
{ Warning
Parking the vehicle on a hill with
the trailer attached can be
dangerous. If something goes
wrong, the rig could start to move.
People can be injured, and both
the vehicle and the trailer can be
damaged. When possible, always
park the rig on a flat surface.
1. Press the brake pedal, but do
not shift into P (Park) yet. Turn
the wheels into the curb if facing
downhill or into traffic if facing
uphill.
2. Have someone place chocks
under the trailer wheels.
4. Reapply the brake pedal. Then
apply the parking brake and shift
into P (Park).
5. Release the brake pedal.
Leaving After Parking on a Hill
1. Apply and hold the brake pedal
while you:
.
Start the engine.
.
Shift into a gear.
.
Release the parking brake.
2. Release the brake pedal.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-60
Black plate (60,1)
Driving and Operating
3. Drive slowly until the trailer is
clear of the chocks.
4. Stop and have someone pick up
and store the chocks.
Maintenance When Trailer
Towing
The vehicle needs service more
often when pulling a trailer. See the
Scheduled Maintenance on
page 11-1. Things that are
especially important in trailer
operation are automatic
transmission fluid, engine oil, axle
lubricant, belts, cooling system and
brake system. Inspect these before
and during the trip.
Check periodically to see that all
hitch nuts and bolts are tight.
Engine Cooling When Trailer
Towing
The cooling system may temporarily
overheat during severe operating
conditions. See Engine Overheating
on page 10-16.
Trailer Towing
Before pulling a trailer, there are
three important considerations that
have to do with weight:
.
The weight of the trailer
.
The weight of the trailer tongue
.
The total weight on the vehicle's
tyres
Weight of the Trailer
How heavy can a trailer safely be?
It depends on how the rig is used.
For example, speed, altitude, road
grades, outside temperature and
how much the vehicle is used to pull
a trailer are all important. It can
depend on any special equipment
on the vehicle, and the amount of
tongue weight the vehicle can carry.
See “Weight of the Trailer Tongue”
later in this section.
Maximum trailer weight is calculated
assuming only the driver is in the
tow vehicle and it has all the
required trailering equipment. The
weight of additional optional
equipment, passengers and cargo in
the tow vehicle must be subtracted
from the maximum trailer weight.
Ask your dealer for trailering
information or advice.
Weight of the Trailer Tongue
The tongue load (1) of any trailer is
an important weight to measure
because it affects the total gross
weight of the vehicle. The Gross
Vehicle Weight (GVW) includes the
curb weight of the vehicle, any
cargo carried in it and the people
who will be riding in the vehicle.
If there are a lot of options,
equipment, passengers or cargo in
the vehicle, it will reduce the nose
weight the vehicle can carry, which
will also reduce the trailer weight the
vehicle can tow. If towing a trailer,
the nose weight must be added to
the GVW because the vehicle will
be carrying that weight, too. See
Vehicle Load Limits on page 9-8 for
more information about the vehicle's
maximum load capacity.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (61,1)
Driving and Operating
(Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) or
the RGAWR (Rear Gross Axle
Weight Rating). The effect of
additional weight may reduce the
trailering capacity more than the
total of the additional weight.
If a weight-carrying hitch or a
weight-distributing hitch is being
used, the trailer tongue (1) should
weigh 10-15 percent of the total
loaded trailer weight (2).
After loading the trailer, weigh the
trailer and then the tongue,
separately, to see if the weights are
proper. If they are not, adjustments
might be made by moving some
items around in the trailer.
Trailering may be limited by the
vehicle's ability to carry tongue
weight. Tongue weight cannot cause
the vehicle to exceed the GVWR
It is important that the vehicle does
not exceed any of its ratings GCWR, GVWR, RGAWR, Maximum
Trailer Rating or Tongue Weight.
The only way to be sure it is not
exceeding any of these ratings is to
weigh the vehicle and trailer.
Total Weight on the Vehicle's
Tyres
Be sure the vehicle's tyres are
inflated to the upper limit for cold
tyres. These numbers can be found
on the Certification label or see
Vehicle Load Limits on page 9-8.
Make sure not to go over the GVW
limit for the vehicle, or the GAWR,
including the weight of the trailer
tongue. If using a weight distributing
hitch, make sure not to go over the
rear axle limit before applying the
weight distribution spring bars.
9-61
Towing Equipment
Hitches
It is important to have the correct
hitch equipment. Crosswinds, large
trucks going by and rough roads are
a few reasons why the right hitch is
needed.
.
The rear bumper on the vehicle
is not intended for hitches. Do
not attach rental hitches or other
bumper-type hitches to it. Use
only a frame-mounted hitch that
does not attach to the bumper.
.
Will any holes be made in the
body of the vehicle when the
trailer hitch is installed? If there
are, then be sure to seal the
holes later when the hitch is
removed. If the holes are not
sealed, dirt, water and deadly
carbon monoxide (CO) from the
exhaust can get into the vehicle.
See Engine Exhaust on
page 9-20 Engine Exhaust .
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-62
Black plate (62,1)
Driving and Operating
Installing the Hitch
1. Remove the hitch cover and
store in a safe place.
2. Make sure the hitch is ready to
be installed.
.
The red marking on knob
points towards the green
mark on the hitch.
.
There is a gap of 6 mm
(0.24 in) between the knob
and the hitch.
.
The key is in the lock.
3. If the hitch is not ready to be
installed, the tension must be set
by pulling the knob out and
turning it clockwise as far as it
will go.
4. Insert the hitch into the housing
and push up firmly until you hear
the knob snap into place against
the hitch.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (63,1)
Driving and Operating
Removing the Hitch
9-63
becomes separated from the hitch.
Always leave just enough slack so
the rig can turn. Never allow safety
chains to drag on the ground.
Trailer Brakes
5. Remove the key and install the
protective cover.
Check that the hitch is correctly
installed:
A loaded trailer that weighs more
than 450 kg (1,000 lbs) needs to
have its own brake system that is
adequate for the weight of the
trailer. Be sure to read and follow
the instructions for the trailer brakes
so they are installed, adjusted and
maintained properly.
1. Pull the knob out and turn it
clockwise as far as it will go.
.
Red marking on knob points
towards white marking on hitch.
2. Pull the hitch downwards out of
the coupling housing and store it
in a safe place.
.
There is no gap between the
knob and the hitch.
3. Insert the plug in the housing.
.
.
The hitch is seated firmly in the
housing.
The hitch must be locked and
the key removed.
Safety Chains
Always attach chains between the
vehicle and the trailer. Cross the
safety chains under the tongue of
the trailer to help prevent the tongue
from contacting the road if it
Because the vehicle has anti-lock
brakes, do not tap into the vehicle's
brake system. If you do, both brake
systems will not work well, or at all.
Trailer Wiring Harness
See your dealer/retailer or towing
professional for information on
preparing the vehicle for trailer
towing.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
9-64
Black plate (64,1)
Driving and Operating
Trailer Sway
Control (TSC)
Conversions and
Add-Ons
The vehicle has a TSC feature as
part of the StabiliTrak system.
If TSC detects that the trailer is
swaying, the vehicle's brakes are
automatically applied.
Add-On Electrical
Equipment
When TSC is applying the brakes,
the TCS/StabiliTrak indicator light
flashes to notify the driver to reduce
speed. If the trailer continues to
sway, StabiliTrak will reduce engine
torque to help slow the vehicle.
TSC will not function if StabiliTrak is
turned off. See Traction Control/
Electronic Stability Control on
page 9-29.
{ Caution
Some electrical equipment can
damage the vehicle or cause
components to not work and
would not be covered by the
warranty. Always check with your
dealer before adding electrical
equipment.
Add-on equipment can drain the
vehicle's 12-volt battery, even if the
vehicle is not operating.
The vehicle has an airbag system.
Before attempting to add anything
electrical to the vehicle, see
Servicing the Airbag-Equipped
Vehicle on page 3-27 and Adding
Equipment to the Airbag-Equipped
Vehicle on page 3-27.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Vehicle Care
Vehicle Care
General Information
General Information . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
Accessories and
Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
Vehicle Checks
Doing Your Own
Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
Engine Compartment
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5
Engine Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . 10-9
Automatic Transmission
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . 10-9
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . 10-16
Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . 10-17
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
All-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22
Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . 10-22
Automatic Transmission Shift
Lock Control Function
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Park Brake and P (Park)
Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . 10-23
Wiper Blade
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Headlamp Aiming
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Bulb Replacement
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . .
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High Intensity Discharge
(HID) Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Indicator Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . .
Back-Up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . .
Number Plate Lamp . . . . . . . .
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . .
10-25
10-25
10-26
10-26
10-29
10-30
10-30
10-31
Electrical System
Electrical System
Overload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32
Fuses and Circuit
Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32
10-1
Engine Compartment Fuse
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33
Instrument Panel Fuse
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35
Rear Compartment Fuse
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37
Wheels and Tyres
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40
All-Season Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41
Winter Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41
Summer Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41
Tyre Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42
Tyre Pressure for
High-Speed Operation . . . . 10-43
Tyre Pressure Monitor
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-43
Tyre Pressure Monitor
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-45
Tyre Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-48
Tyre Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-48
When It Is Time for New
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-49
Buying New Tyres . . . . . . . . . . 10-50
Different Size Tyres and
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-52
Wheel Alignment and Tyre
Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-52
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . 10-53
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-2
Black plate (2,1)
Vehicle Care
Tyre Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
If a Tyre Goes Flat . . . . . . . . .
Tyre Sealant and
Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . .
Storing the Tyre Sealant and
Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . .
Tyre Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Compact Spare Tyre . . . . . . .
10-53
10-54
10-56
10-63
10-63
10-69
Jump Starting
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70
Towing the Vehicle
Towing the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . 10-74
Recreational Vehicle
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-76
Appearance Care
Exterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-78
Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-83
Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-86
General Information
For service and parts needs, visit
your dealer. You will receive
genuine parts and trained and
supported service people.
Accessories and
Modifications
Adding non-dealer accessories or
making modifications to the vehicle
can affect vehicle performance and
safety, including such things as
airbags, braking, stability, ride and
handling, emissions systems,
aerodynamics, durability, and
electronic systems like anti-lock
brakes, traction control, and stability
control. These accessories or
modifications could even cause
malfunction or damage not covered
by the vehicle warranty.
Damage to vehicle components
resulting from modifications or the
installation or use of non-GM
certified parts, including control
module or software modifications, is
not covered under the terms of the
vehicle warranty and may affect
remaining warranty coverage for
affected parts.
GM Accessories are designed to
complement and function with other
systems on the vehicle. See your
dealer to accessorise the vehicle
using genuine GM Accessories
installed by a dealer technician.
Also, see Adding Equipment to the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on
page 3-27.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Vehicle Care
Vehicle Checks
Doing Your Own
Service Work
{ Warning
It can be dangerous to work on
your vehicle if you do not have
the proper knowledge, service
manual, tools, or parts. Always
follow owner manual procedures
and consult the service manual
for your vehicle before doing any
service work.
If doing some of your own service
work, use the proper service
manual. It tells you much more
about how to service the vehicle
than this manual can.
This vehicle has an airbag system.
Before attempting to do your own
service work, see Servicing the
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on
page 3-27.
Keep a record with all parts receipts
and list the mileage and the date of
any service work performed.
10-3
{ Caution
Even small amounts of
contamination can cause damage
to vehicle systems. Do not allow
contaminants to contact the fluids,
reservoir caps, or dipsticks.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-4
Vehicle Care
Bonnet
To open the bonnet:
1. Pull the release handle with the
above symbol on it. It is located
below the instrument panel to
the left of the steering wheel.
2. Move the secondary bonnet
release lever up to release the
striker. The lever is located near
the middle of the bonnet.
3. Lift the hood.
Before closing the bonnet, be sure
all the filler caps are on properly.
Black plate (4,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Vehicle Care
Engine Compartment Overview
10-5
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-6
Black plate (6,1)
Vehicle Care
1. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on
page 10-9.
2. Power Steering Reservoir and
Cap (Under Engine Cover). See
Power Steering Fluid on
page 10-17.
10. Remote Positive (+) Terminal.
See Jump Starting on
page 10-70.
11. Remote Negative (-) Terminal
(Out of View). See Jump
Starting on page 10-70.
3. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See Engine
Oil on page 10-6.
12. Engine Compartment Fuse
Block on page 10-33.
4. Engine Oil Dipstick (Out of
View). See Engine Oil on
page 10-6.
13. Windscreen Washer Fluid
Reservoir. See Washer Fluid
on page 10-18.
5. Engine Cover on page 10-6.
6. Transmission Fluid Cap and
Dipstick (Out of View). See
Automatic Transmission Fluid on
page 10-9.
Engine Cover
2. Engine Cover Bolt
3. Engine Cover
To remove:
1. Remove the oil fill cap (1).
2. Remove the engine cover
bolt (2).
3. Raise the engine cover (3) to
release from the retainers.
4. Lift and remove the engine
cover.
5. Reverse Steps 1–4 to reinstall
engine cover.
Engine Oil
To ensure proper engine
performance and long life, careful
attention must be paid to engine oil.
Following these simple, but
important steps will help protect
your investment:
7. Brake Fluid Reservoir. See
Brakes on page 10-19.
8. Engine Coolant Surge Tank and
Pressure Cap. See Engine
Coolant on page 10-12.
.
9. Battery (Out of View). See
Battery on page 10-21.
1. Oil Fill Cap
Always use engine oil approved
to the proper specification and of
the proper viscosity grade. See
“Selecting the Right Engine Oil”
in this section.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Vehicle Care
.
.
.
Check the engine oil level
regularly and maintain the
proper oil level. See “Checking
Engine Oil” and “When to Add
Engine Oil” in this section.
Change the engine oil at the
appropriate time. See Engine Oil
Life System on page 10-9.
Always dispose of engine oil
properly. See “What to Do with
Used Oil” in this section.
Checking Engine Oil
It is a good idea to check the engine
oil level at each fuel fill. In order to
get an accurate reading, the vehicle
must be on level ground. The
engine oil dipstick handle is a loop.
See Engine Compartment Overview
on page 10-5 for the location of the
engine oil dipstick.
1. If the engine has been running
recently, turn off the engine and
allow several minutes for the oil
to drain back into the oil sump.
Checking the oil level too soon
after engine shutoff will not
provide an accurate oil level
reading.
{ Warning
The engine oil dipstick handle
may be hot; it could burn you.
Use a towel or glove to touch the
dipstick handle.
2. Pull out the dipstick and clean it
with a paper towel or cloth, then
push it back in all the way.
Remove it again, keeping the tip
down, and check the level.
When to Add Engine Oil
If the oil is below the cross-hatched
area at the tip of the dipstick, add
1 L (1 qt) of the recommended oil
and then recheck the level. See
“Selecting the Right Engine Oil” in
this section for an explanation of
what kind of oil to use. For engine
oil crankcase capacity, see
Capacities and Specifications on
page 12-2.
10-7
{ Caution
Do not add too much oil. Oil
levels above or below the
acceptable operating range
shown on the dipstick are harmful
to the engine. If you find that you
have an oil level above the
operating range, i.e., the engine
has so much oil that the oil level
gets above the cross-hatched
area that shows the proper
operating range, the engine could
be damaged. You should drain
out the excess oil or limit driving
of the vehicle and seek a service
professional to remove the
excess amount of oil.
See Engine Compartment Overview
on page 10-5 for the location of the
engine oil fill cap.
Add enough oil to put the level
somewhere in the proper operating
range. Push the dipstick all the way
back in when done.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-8
Black plate (8,1)
Vehicle Care
Selecting the Right Engine Oil
Selecting the right engine oil
depends on both the proper oil
specification and viscosity grade.
See Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants on page 11-5.
Specification
Use and ask for licensed engine oils
with the dexos2™ approved
certification mark. Engine oils
meeting the requirements for the
vehicle should have the dexos2
approved certification mark. This
certification mark indicates that the
oil has been approved to the dexos2
specification.
{ Caution
Failure to use the recommended
engine oil can result in engine
damage not covered by the
vehicle warranty. Check with your
dealer or service provider on
whether the oil is approved to the
dexos2 specification.
specification. See “Specification”
earlier in this section for more
information.
Engine Oil Additives/Engine
Oil Flushes
Viscosity Grade
Do not add anything to the oil. The
recommended oils with the dexos
specification and displaying the
dexos certification mark are all that
is needed for good performance and
engine protection.
SAE 5W-30 is the best viscosity
grade for the vehicle. Do not use
other viscosity grade oils such as
SAE 10W-30, 10W-40, or 20W-50.
Engine oil system flushes are not
recommended and could cause
engine damage not covered by the
vehicle warranty.
Cold Temperature Operation: If in an
area of extreme cold, where the
temperature falls below −29°C (−20°
F), an SAE 0W-30 oil may be used.
An oil of this viscosity grade will
provide easier cold starting for the
engine at extremely low
temperatures. When selecting an oil
of the appropriate viscosity grade,
always select an oil of the correct
What to Do with Used Oil
Used engine oil contains certain
elements that can be unhealthy for
your skin and could even cause
cancer. Do not let used oil stay on
your skin for very long. Clean your
skin and nails with soap and water,
or a good hand cleaner. Wash or
properly dispose of clothing or rags
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
Vehicle Care
containing used engine oil. See the
manufacturer's warnings about the
use and disposal of oil products.
Used oil can be a threat to the
environment. If you change your
own oil, be sure to drain all the oil
from the filter before disposal. Never
dispose of oil by putting it in the
trash or pouring it on the ground,
into sewers, or into streams or
bodies of water. Recycle it by taking
it to a place that collects used oil.
Engine Oil Life System
When to Change Engine Oil
This vehicle has a computer system
that indicates when to change the
engine oil and filter. This is based
on a combination of factors which
include engine revolutions, engine
temperature, and miles driven.
Based on driving conditions, the
mileage at which an oil change is
indicated can vary considerably. For
the oil life system to work properly,
the system must be reset every time
the oil is changed.
When the system has calculated
that oil life has been diminished, it
indicates that an oil change is
necessary. A CHANGE ENGINE
OIL SOON message comes on. See
Engine Oil Messages on page 5-31.
Change the oil as soon as possible
within the next 1 000 km (600 mi).
It is possible that, if driving under
the best conditions, the oil life
system might indicate that an oil
change is not necessary for up to a
year. The engine oil and filter must
be changed at least once a year
and, at this time, the system must
be reset. Your dealer has trained
service people who will perform this
work and reset the system. It is also
important to check the oil regularly
over the course of an oil drain
interval and keep it at the proper
level.
If the system is ever reset
accidentally, the oil must be
changed at 5 000 km (3,000 mi)
since the last oil change.
Remember to reset the oil life
system whenever the oil is changed.
10-9
After you change the oil, the oil life
monitor will need to be reset. See
your dealer for service.
See “Oil Life” under Driver
Information Centre (DIC) on
page 5-25 for information on the
engine oil life monitor.
Automatic Transmission
Fluid
A transmission fluid leak is the only
reason for fluid loss. If a leak
occurs, take the vehicle to your
dealer and have it repaired as soon
as possible.
Change the fluid and filter at the
intervals listed in Scheduled
Maintenance on page 11-1, and be
sure to use the fluid listed in
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants on page 11-5.
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter
See Engine Compartment Overview
on page 10-5 for the location of the
engine air cleaner/filter.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-10
Black plate (10,1)
Vehicle Care
When to Inspect the Engine Air
Cleaner/Filter
Inspect or replace the air cleaner/
filter at the scheduled maintenance
intervals. See Scheduled
Maintenance on page 11-1. If driving
in dusty/dirty conditions, inspect the
filter at each engine oil change.
How to Inspect the Engine Air
Cleaner/Filter
To inspect the air cleaner/filter,
remove the filter from the vehicle
and lightly shake the filter to release
loose dust and dirt. If the filter
remains covered with dirt, a new
filter is required. Never use
compressed air to clean the filter.
1. Air Duct Clamp
1. Cover Cut Outs
2. Electrical Connector
2. Air Filter Tabs
3. Retaining Clips
To inspect or replace the engine air
cleaner/filter:
1. Open the bonnet. See Bonnet
on page 10-4.
2. Locate the air filter housing on
the front of the passenger side
of the engine compartment. See
Engine Compartment Overview
on page 10-5.
3. Disconnect the outlet duct by
loosening the air duct clamp (1).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
Vehicle Care
4. Disconnect the electrical
connector (2). First, remove the
connector lock clip located at the
bottom of the connector, then
press on the top and bottom of
the connector to remove.
5. Lift the 3 retaining clips (3) on
the air filter housing.
6. Tilt and lift the cover slightly
upwards and slide the cover
away from outside edge of the
vehicle. Remove the air filter.
7. To install the air filter, place filter
inside box where the pleats fit in
between the tabs located inside
the lower box. Ensure that the
cover cut outs (1) on both sides
match the air filter tabs (2) on
both sides.
8. Replace air cleaner cover by
inserting the 4 tabs into the 4
slots. Lower cover to meet
bottom of box. Place the 3
retaining clips (3) on retention
features and clip closed.
9. Reconnect outlet duct to cover
and tighten the air duct
clamp (1).
10. Reconnect the electrical
connector (2). Install connector
lock clip to bottom of
connector.
{ Warning
10-11
{ Caution
If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt
can easily get into the engine,
which could damage it. Always
have the air cleaner/filter in place
when you are driving.
Cooling System
Operating the engine with the air
cleaner/filter off can cause you or
others to be burned. The air
cleaner not only cleans the air; it
helps to stop flames if the engine
backfires. Use caution when
working on the engine and do not
drive with the air cleaner/filter off.
1. Engine Cooling Fan (Out
of View)
2. Engine Coolant Surge Tank and
Pressure Cap
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-12
Black plate (12,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Warning
An electric engine cooling fan
under the bonnet can start up
even when the engine is not
running and can cause injury.
Keep hands, clothing, and tools
away from any underbonnet
electric fan.
If the coolant inside the coolant
surge tank is boiling, do not do
anything else until it cools down.
The vehicle should be parked on a
level surface.
The coolant level should be
between the MIN and MAX lines.
If it is not, the vehicle may have a
leak at the radiator hoses, heater
hoses, radiator, water pump,
or somewhere else in the cooling
system.
{ Warning
{ Caution
Heater and radiator hoses, and
other engine parts, can be very
hot. Do not touch them. If you do,
you can be burned.
Using coolant other than
DEX-COOL® can cause
premature engine, heater core,
or radiator corrosion. In addition,
the engine coolant could require
changing sooner. Any repairs
would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty. Always use
DEX-COOL (silicate-free) coolant
in the vehicle.
Do not run the engine if there is a
leak. If you run the engine, it
could lose all coolant. That could
cause an engine fire, and you
could be burned. Get any leak
fixed before you drive the vehicle.
If there seems to be no leak, with
the engine on, check to see if the
engine cooling fan is running. If the
engine is overheating, the fan
should be running. If it is not, the
vehicle needs service. Turn off the
engine.
Engine Coolant
The cooling system in the vehicle is
filled with DEX-COOL® engine
coolant. This coolant needs to be
checked and replaced at
appropriate intervals. See
Scheduled Maintenance on
page 11-1.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (13,1)
Vehicle Care
The following explains the cooling
system and how to check and add
coolant when it is low. If there is a
problem with engine overheating,
see Engine Overheating on
page 10-16.
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean,
drinkable water and DEX-COOL
coolant. If using this mixture,
nothing else needs to be added.
This mixture:
.
Gives freezing protection down
to -37°C (-34°F), outside
temperature.
.
Gives boiling protection up to
129°C (265°F), engine
temperature.
.
Protects against rust and
corrosion.
.
Will not damage aluminium
parts.
.
Helps keep the proper engine
temperature.
What to Use
{ Warning
Adding only plain water or some
other liquid to the cooling system
can be dangerous. Plain water
and other liquids, can boil before
the proper coolant mixture will.
The coolant warning system is set
for the proper coolant mixture.
With plain water or the wrong
mixture, the engine could get too
hot but you would not get the
overheat warning. The engine
could catch fire and you or others
could be burned. Use a 50/
50 mixture of clean, drinkable
water and DEX-COOL coolant.
{ Caution
If improper coolant mixture,
inhibitors, or additives are used in
the vehicle cooling system, the
engine could overheat and be
(Continued)
10-13
Caution (Continued)
damaged. Too much water in the
mixture can freeze and crack
engine cooling parts. The repairs
would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty. Use only the
proper mixture of engine coolant
for the cooling system. See
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants on page 11-5.
Never dispose of engine coolant by
putting it in the refuse, pouring it on
the ground, or into sewers, streams,
or bodies of water. Have the coolant
changed by an authorised service
centre, familiar with legal
requirements regarding used
coolant disposal. This will help
protect the environment and your
health.
Checking Coolant
The vehicle must be on a level
surface when checking the coolant
level.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-14
Black plate (14,1)
Vehicle Care
Check to see if coolant is visible in
the coolant surge tank. If the coolant
inside the coolant surge tank is
boiling, do not do anything else until
it cools down. If coolant is visible
but the coolant level is not at the
indicated mark, add a 50/50 mixture
of clean, drinkable water and
DEX-COOL coolant at the coolant
surge tank, but be sure the cooling
system is cool before this is done.
See Engine Overheating on
page 10-16.
The coolant surge tank is located in
the engine compartment on the
driver side of the vehicle. See
Engine Compartment Overview on
page 10-5.
How to Add Coolant to the
Coolant Surge Tank
{ Caution
This vehicle has a specific
coolant fill procedure. Failure to
follow this procedure could cause
the engine to overheat and be
severely damaged.
If no problem is found, check to see
if coolant is visible in the coolant
surge tank. If coolant is visible but
the coolant level is not at the
indicated level mark, add a 50/
50 mixture of clean, drinkable water
and DEX-COOL coolant at the
coolant surge tank, but be sure the
cooling system, including the
coolant surge tank pressure cap, is
cool before you do it.
{ Warning
Steam and scalding liquids from a
hot cooling system can blow out
and burn you badly. Never turn
the cap when the cooling system,
including the surge tank pressure
cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling
system and surge tank pressure
cap to cool.
{ Warning
Adding only plain water or some
other liquid to the cooling system
can be dangerous. Plain water
and other liquids, can boil before
the proper coolant mixture will.
The coolant warning system is set
for the proper coolant mixture.
With plain water or the wrong
mixture, the engine could get too
hot but you would not get the
overheat warning. The engine
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (15,1)
Vehicle Care
3. Fill the coolant surge tank with
the proper mixture to the
indicated level mark.
Warning (Continued)
could catch fire and you or others
could be burned. Use a 50/
50 mixture of clean, drinkable
water and DEX-COOL coolant.
4. With the coolant surge tank
pressure cap off, start the
engine and let it run until you
can feel the upper radiator hose
getting hot. Watch out for the
engine cooling fan.
{ Caution
In cold weather, water can freeze
and crack the engine, radiator,
heater core, and other parts. Use
the recommended coolant and
the proper coolant mixture.
{ Warning
You can be burned if you spill
coolant on hot engine parts.
Coolant contains ethylene glycol
and it will burn if the engine parts
are hot enough. Do not spill
coolant on a hot engine.
10-15
1. Remove the coolant surge tank
pressure cap when the cooling
system, including the coolant
surge tank pressure cap and
upper radiator hose, is no
longer hot.
Turn the pressure cap slowly
anticlockwise about one-quarter
of a turn. If you hear a hiss, wait
for that to stop. This will allow
any pressure still left to be
vented out the discharge hose.
2. Then keep turning the pressure
cap slowly and remove it.
By this time, the coolant level
inside the coolant surge tank
may be lower. If the level is
lower, add more of the proper
mixture to the coolant surge tank
until the level reaches the
indicated level mark.
5. Replace the pressure cap tightly.
6. Verify coolant level after the
engine is shut off and the
coolant is cold. If necessary,
repeat coolant fill procedure
Steps 1–6.
If the coolant still is not at the
proper level when the system
cools down again, see your
dealer.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-16
Black plate (16,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Caution
If the pressure cap is not tightly
installed, coolant loss and
possible engine damage may
occur. Be sure the cap is properly
and tightly secured.
Engine Overheating
The vehicle has an indicator to warn
of engine overheating.
There is an engine coolant
temperature warning light on the
vehicle instrument cluster. See
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
on page 5-12.
If the decision is made not to lift the
bonnet when this warning appears,
get help right away.
If the decision is made to lift the
bonnet, make sure the vehicle is
parked on a level surface.
Then check to see if the engine
cooling fans are running. If the
engine is overheating, both fans
should be running. If they are not,
do not continue to run the engine
and have the vehicle serviced.
Warning (Continued)
Wait until there is no sign of
steam or coolant before you open
the bonnet.
{ Caution
Running the engine without
coolant may cause damage or a
fire. Vehicle damage would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty.
If you keep driving when the
engine is overheated, the liquids
in it can catch fire. You or others
could be badly burned. Stop the
engine if it overheats, and get out
of the vehicle until the engine
is cool.
If Steam Is Coming from the
Engine Compartment
{ Warning
Steam from an overheated engine
can burn you badly, even if you
just open the bonnet. Stay away
from the engine if you see or hear
steam coming from it. Just turn it
off and get everyone away from
the vehicle until it cools down.
(Continued)
If No Steam Is Coming from
the Engine Compartment
If an engine overheat warning is
displayed but no steam can be seen
or heard, the problem may not be
too serious. Sometimes the engine
can get a little too hot when the
vehicle:
.
Climbs a long hill on a hot day.
.
Stops after high-speed driving.
.
Idles for long periods in traffic.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (17,1)
Vehicle Care
.
Tows a trailer.
If the overheat warning displays with
no sign of steam:
1. Turn the air conditioning off.
2. Turn the heater on to the highest
temperature and to the highest
fan speed. Open the windows as
necessary.
If there is no sign of steam, idle the
engine for three minutes while
parked. If the warning is still
displayed, turn off the engine until it
cools down.
Power Steering Fluid
3. When it is safe to do so, pull off
the road, shift to P (Park) or
N (Neutral), and let the
engine idle.
If the temperature overheat gauge is
no longer in the overheat zone or an
overheat warning no longer
displays, the vehicle can be driven.
Continue to drive the vehicle slowly
for about 10 minutes. Keep a safe
vehicle distance from the vehicle in
front. If the warning does not come
back on, continue to drive normally
and have the cooling system
checked for proper fill and function.
If the warning continues, pull over,
stop, and park the vehicle
right away.
10-17
How to Check Power Steering
Fluid
To check the power steering fluid:
1. Turn the engine off and let the
engine compartment cool down.
2. Remove the engine cover,
if required. See Engine Cover on
page 10-6.
3. Wipe the cap and the top of the
reservoir clean.
4. Unscrew the cap and wipe the
dipstick with a clean rag.
See Engine Compartment Overview
on page 10-5 for reservoir location.
5. Replace the cap and completely
tighten it.
When to Check Power Steering
Fluid
6. Remove the cap again and look
at the fluid level on the dipstick.
It is not necessary to regularly
check power steering fluid unless a
leak is suspected in the system or
unusual noise is heard. A fluid loss
in this system could indicate a
problem. Have the system inspected
and repaired.
The level should be within the HOT
mark. If necessary, add only enough
fluid to bring the level within
the mark.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-18
Black plate (18,1)
Vehicle Care
What to Use
{ Caution
Use of the incorrect fluid may
damage the vehicle and the
damage may not be covered by
the vehicle warranty. Always use
the correct fluid listed in
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants on page 11-5.
below freezing, use a fluid that has
sufficient protection against
freezing.
What to Use
When windscreen washer fluid is
needed, be sure to read the
manufacturer's instructions before
use. If operating the vehicle in an
area where the temperature may fall
.
Do not use engine coolant
(antifreeze) in the windscreen
washer. It can damage the
windscreen washer system
and paint.
.
Do not mix water with
ready-to-use washer fluid.
Water can cause the solution
to freeze and damage the
washer fluid tank and other
parts of the washer system.
.
When using concentrated
washer fluid, follow the
manufacturer instructions for
adding water.
.
Fill the washer fluid tank only
three-quarters full when it is
very cold. This allows for fluid
expansion if freezing occurs,
which could damage the tank
if it is completely full.
Adding Washer Fluid
The WASHER FLUID LOW ADD
FLUID message appears on the
Driver Information Centre (DIC)
when the fluid level is low. See
Washer Fluid Messages on
page 5-38.
To determine what kind of fluid to
use, see Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants on page 11-5. Always
use the proper fluid.
Washer Fluid
{ Caution
Open the cap with the washer
symbol on it. Add washer fluid up to
the fill mark. See Engine
Compartment Overview on
page 10-5 for reservoir location.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (19,1)
Vehicle Care
Brakes
This vehicle has disc brakes. Disc
brake pads have built-in wear
indicators that make a high-pitched
warning sound when the brake pads
are worn and new pads are needed.
The sound can come and go or be
heard all the time when the vehicle
is moving, except when applying the
brake pedal firmly.
{ Warning
The brake wear warning sound
means that soon the brakes will
not work well. That could lead to
a crash. When the brake wear
warning sound is heard, have the
vehicle serviced.
{ Caution
Continuing to drive with worn-out
brake pads could result in costly
brake repair.
Some driving conditions or climates
can cause a brake squeal when the
brakes are first applied or lightly
applied. This does not mean
something is wrong with the brakes.
Properly torqued wheel nuts are
necessary to help prevent brake
pulsation. When tyres are rotated,
inspect brake pads for wear and
evenly tighten wheel nuts in the
proper sequence to torque
specifications. See Capacities and
Specifications on page 12-2.
Brake linings should always be
replaced as complete axle sets.
Brake Pedal Travel
See your dealer if the brake pedal
does not return to normal height,
or if there is a rapid increase in
pedal travel. This could be a sign
that brake service might be
required.
Brake Adjustment
Every time the brakes are applied,
with or without the vehicle moving,
the brakes adjust for wear.
10-19
Replacing Brake System Parts
The braking system on a vehicle is
complex. Its many parts have to be
of top quality and work well together
if the vehicle is to have really good
braking. The vehicle was designed
and tested with top-quality brake
parts. When parts of the braking
system are replaced, be sure to get
new, approved replacement parts.
If this is not done, the brakes might
not work properly. For example,
installing disc brake pads that are
wrong for the vehicle, can change
the balance between the front and
rear brakes - for the worse. The
braking performance expected can
change in many other ways if the
wrong replacement brake parts are
installed.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-20
Vehicle Care
Brake Fluid
The brake/clutch master cylinder
reservoir is filled with DOT 3 brake
fluid as indicated on the reservoir
cap. See Engine Compartment
Overview on page 10-5 for the
location of the reservoir.
There are only two reasons why the
brake fluid level in the reservoir
might go down:
.
.
Black plate (20,1)
The brake fluid level goes down
because of normal brake lining
wear. When new linings are
installed, the fluid level goes
back up.
A fluid leak in the brake/clutch
hydraulic system can also cause
a low fluid level. Have the brake/
clutch hydraulic system fixed,
since a leak means that sooner
or later the brakes will not
work well.
Do not top up the brake/clutch fluid.
Adding fluid does not correct a leak.
If fluid is added when the linings are
worn, there will be too much fluid
when new brake linings are
installed. Add or remove fluid, as
necessary, only when work is done
on the brake/clutch hydraulic
system.
{ Warning
If too much brake fluid is added, it
can spill on the engine and burn,
if the engine is hot enough. You
or others could be burned, and
the vehicle could be damaged.
Add brake fluid only when work is
done on the brake/clutch
hydraulic system.
Checking Brake Fluid
The brake/clutch fluid can be
checked without taking off the cap
by looking at the brake/clutch fluid
reservoir.
The fluid level should be above
MIN. If it is not, have the brake/
clutch hydraulic system checked to
see if there is a leak.
After work is done on the brake/
clutch hydraulic system, make sure
the level is above MIN but not over
the MAX mark.
When the brake/clutch fluid falls to a
low level, the brake warning light
comes on. See Brake System
Warning Light on page 5-18.
What to Add
Use only new GM approved DOT 3
brake fluid from a sealed container.
See Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants on page 11-5.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (21,1)
Vehicle Care
Always clean the brake/clutch fluid
reservoir cap and the area around
the cap before removing it. This
helps keep dirt from entering the
reservoir.
{ Warning
With the wrong kind of fluid in the
brake/clutch hydraulic system, the
brakes might not work well. This
could cause a crash. Always use
the proper brake/clutch fluid.
{
.
.
Caution (Continued)
{ Warning
be replaced. Do not let
someone put in the wrong
kind of fluid.
Batteries should not be disposed
of with regular refuse. Make sure
that you dispose of old batteries
in accordance with environmental
protection regulations to help
protect the environment and your
health.
If brake fluid is spilled on the
vehicle's painted surfaces,
the paint finish can be
damaged. Be careful not to
spill brake fluid on the
vehicle. If you do, wash it off
immediately.
Battery
Caution
Using the wrong fluid can
badly damage brake/clutch
hydraulic system parts. For
example, just a few drops of
mineral-based oil, such as
engine oil, in the brake
hydraulic system can damage
brake hydraulic system parts
so badly that they will have to
(Continued)
10-21
Refer to the replacement number
shown on the original battery label
when a new battery is needed. See
Engine Compartment Overview on
page 10-5 for battery location.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-22
Black plate (22,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Warning
Warning (Continued)
Do not use a match or flame near
a vehicle's battery. If you need
more light, use a torch.
Battery posts, terminals and
related accessories contain lead
and lead compounds which can
cause cancer and reproductive
harm. Wash hands after handling.
Do not smoke near a vehicle's
battery.
When working around a vehicle's
battery, shield your eyes with
protective glasses.
Keep children away from vehicle
batteries.
{ Warning
Batteries have acid that can burn
you and gas that can explode.
You can be hurt badly if you are
not careful.
Follow instructions carefully when
working around a battery.
(Continued)
Vehicle Storage
Infrequent Usage: Remove the
black, negative (-) cable from the
battery to keep the battery from
running down.
Extended Storage: Remove the
black, negative (-) cable from the
battery or use a battery trickle
charger.
All-Wheel Drive
Transfer Case
Under normal driving conditions,
transfer case fluid does not require
changing or checking unless there
is a fluid leak or unusual noise.
If required, have the transfer case
serviced by your dealer.
Starter Switch Check
{ Warning
When you are doing this
inspection, the vehicle could
move suddenly. If the vehicle
moves, you or others could be
injured.
1. Before starting this check, be
sure there is enough room
around the vehicle.
2. Apply both the parking brake
and the regular brake.
Do not use the accelerator
pedal, and be ready to turn off
the engine immediately if it
starts.
3. Try to start the engine in each
gear. The vehicle should start
only in P (Park) or N (Neutral).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (23,1)
Vehicle Care
If the vehicle starts in any other
position, contact your dealer for
service.
Automatic Transmission
Shift Lock Control
Function Check
{ Warning
When you are doing this
inspection, the vehicle could
move suddenly. If the vehicle
moves, you or others could be
injured.
1. Before starting this check, be
sure there is enough room
around the vehicle. It should be
parked on a level surface.
2. Apply the parking brake. Be
ready to apply the regular brake
immediately if the vehicle begins
to move.
3. With the engine off, turn the
ignition on, but do not start the
engine. Without applying the
regular brake, try to move the
gear lever out of P (Park) with
normal effort. If the shift lever
moves out of P (Park), contact
your dealer for service.
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the
vehicle facing downhill. Keeping
your foot on the regular brake, apply
the parking brake.
.
To check the parking brake's
holding ability: With the engine
running and the transmission in
N (Neutral), slowly remove foot
pressure from the regular brake
pedal. Do this until the vehicle is
held by the parking brake only.
.
To check the P (Park)
mechanism's holding ability:
With the engine running, shift to
P (Park). Then release the
parking brake followed by the
regular brake.
Park Brake and P (Park)
Mechanism Check
{ Warning
When you are doing this check,
the vehicle could begin to move.
You or others could be injured
and property could be damaged.
Make sure there is room in front
of the vehicle in case it begins to
roll. Be ready to apply the regular
brake at once should the vehicle
begin to move.
10-23
Contact your dealer if service is
required.
Wiper Blade Replacement
Windscreen wiper blades should be
inspected for wear or cracking.
It is a good idea to clean or replace
the wiper blade assembly on a
regular basis or when worn. For
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-24
Black plate (24,1)
Vehicle Care
proper windscreen wiper blade
length and type, see Maintenance
Replacement Parts on page 11-6.
To remove the cover:
{ Caution
Allowing the wiper arm to touch
the windscreen when no wiper
blade is installed could damage
the windscreen. Any damage that
occurs would not be covered by
your warranty. Do not allow the
wiper arm to touch the
windscreen.
Front Wiper Blade
Replacement
1. Slide a plastic tool under the
cover and push upward to
unsnap.
2. Press the button in the middle of
the wiper arm connector, and
pull the wiper blade away from
the arm connector.
3. Remove the wiper blade.
To replace the wiper blade
assembly:
4. Reverse steps 1–3 for wiper
blade replacement.
1. Pull the windscreen wiper
assembly away from the
windscreen.
Rear Wiper Blade Replacement
The rear wiper blade and wiper arm
have a cover for protection. The
cover must be removed before the
wiper blade can be replaced.
2. Slide the cover toward the wiper
blade tip to unhook it from the
blade assembly.
3. Remove the cover.
4. After wiper blade replacement,
ensure that the cover hook
slides into the slot in the blade
assembly.
5. Snap the cover down to secure.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (25,1)
Vehicle Care
To remove the wiper blade:
1. Lift the wiper arm away from the
window.
2. Push the release lever (2) to
disengage the hook and push
the wiper arm (1) out of the
blade assembly (3).
3. Push the new blade assembly
securely on the wiper arm until
the release lever clicks into
place.
4. Replace the wiper cover.
10-25
Headlamp Aiming
Bulb Replacement
Headlamp alignment has been
preset and should need no further
adjustment.
For the proper type of replacement
bulbs, see Replacement Bulbs on
page 10-31.
If the vehicle is damaged in a crash,
the headlamp alignment may be
affected. If adjustment to the
headlamps is necessary, see your
dealer.
For any bulb changing procedure
not listed in this section, contact
your dealer.
Halogen Bulbs
{ Warning
Halogen bulbs have pressurised
gas inside and can burst if you
drop or scratch the bulb. You or
others could be injured. Be sure
to read and follow the instructions
on the bulb package.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-26
Black plate (26,1)
Vehicle Care
High Intensity Discharge
(HID) Lighting
Headlamps
{ Warning
The high intensity discharge
lighting system operates at a very
high voltage. If you try to service
any of the system components,
you could be seriously injured.
Have your dealer or a qualified
technician service them.
After an HID headlamp bulb has
been replaced, the beam might be a
slightly different shade than it was
originally. This is normal.
Uplevel Headlamp Assembly (Rear
View Driver Side)
Base Headlamp Assembly (Rear
View Passenger Side)
1. Main/Dipped Beam Headlamp
(To be replaced at dealer only)
1. Dipped Beam Headlamp/
Daytime Running Lamp (DRL)
2. Daytime Running Lamp (DRL)
2. Main Beam Headlamp
3. Indicator Lamp
3. Indicator Lamp
Driver Side
The removal of the under bonnet
electrical centre cover is required for
the replacement of one of these
bulbs:
1. Open the bonnet. See Bonnet
on page 10-4.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (27,1)
Vehicle Care
3. Lift the air cleaner/filter base to
disengage from the three pins.
{ Warning
Liquids from environment or
spillage and/or tools placed on
top of or used in the underbonnet
electrical centre while the cover is
removed can pose a risk of
electrical shock/burn to anyone in
the vicinity. These conditions can
also cause damage to electrical
components on the vehicle. Keep
liquids and tools away from the
underbonnet electrical centre
when the cover is removed.
10-27
Dipped-Beam Headlamps/
Daytime Running Lamps
(DRL), Main-Beam
Headlamps (Base)
2. Unlatch three clips and lift up the
underbonnet electrical centre
cover to remove.
Passenger Side
The removal of the air filter/cleaner
assembly and base is required for
the replacement of one of these
bulbs:
1. Open the bonnet. See Bonnet
on page 10-4.
2. Remove the air cleaner/filter
cover. See Engine Air Cleaner/
Filter on page 10-9.
1. From the back side of the
headlamp assembly, remove the
top cap to replace the dipped
beam headlamp/DRL bulb.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-28
Black plate (28,1)
Vehicle Care
8. Install the cap with the down
arrow pointing down in the back
of the headlamp assembly.
Daytime Running Lamp (DRL)
(Uplevel)
9. For the driver side, reinstall the
under bonnet electrical centre
cover by latching three clips.
2. From the back side of the
headlamp assembly, remove the
bottom cap to replace the main
beam headlamp bulb.
3. Disconnect the electrical
connector.
4. Remove the bulb socket from
the headlamp assembly.
10. For the passenger side,
reinstall the air filter/cleaner
assembly base by pushing to
seat. Verify the base is seated
securely, then install the engine
air filter/cleaner assembly.
Main/Dipped Beam Headlamps
(Uplevel)
The main/dipped beam headlamps
on the uplevel are High Intensity
Discharge (HID) and should be
replaced at the dealer.
1. From the back side of the
headlamp assembly, remove the
bottom cap to replace the
DRL bulb.
2. Disconnect electrical connector.
5. Replace the bulb in the bulb
socket.
3. Remove the DRL bulb socket
from the headlamp assembly.
6. Install the bulb socket in the
headlamp assembly.
4. Replace the bulb in the bulb
socket.
7. Connect the electrical connector.
5. Install the bulb socket in the
headlamp assembly.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (29,1)
Vehicle Care
6. Connect the electrical connector.
7. Install the cap with the down
arrow pointing down in the back
of the headlamp assembly.
8. For driver side, reinstall the
underbonnet electrical centre
cover by latching three clips.
9. For passenger side, reinstall the
air filter/cleaner assembly base
by pushing to seat. Verify the
base is seated securely, then
install the engine air filter/
cleaner assembly.
Front Indicator Lamp (Base
and Uplevel)
To replace the front indicator lamp:
1. Remove the indicator lamp bulb
socket from the headlamp
assembly.
2. Remove the indicator lamp bulb
from the socket.
3. Replace the bulb in the bulb
socket.
10-29
4. Install the bulb socket in the
headlamp assembly.
5. For the driver side, reinstall the
under bonnet electrical centre
cover by latching three clips.
6. For the passenger side, reinstall
the air filter/cleaner assembly
base by pushing to seat. Verify
the base is seated securely, then
install the engine air filter/
cleaner assembly.
Indicator Lamps
To replace one of these bulbs:
1. Open the tailgate. See Tailgate
on page 2-11.
2. Remove the push pin (1) on the
tail lamp cover (2).
3. Remove the tail lamp cover from
the lamp assembly by pulling
rearward from the top to
unfasten the snap tabs.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-30
Black plate (30,1)
Vehicle Care
9. Reinstall the taillamp assembly
and tighten the screws.
10. Reinstall the taillamp cover by
snapping it into place.
11. Push the push pin to secure
the taillamp cover.
Back-Up Lamps
This vehicle has LED reversing and
rear fog lamps. For replacement of
these lamps, contact your dealer.
4. Remove the two screws from the
taillamp assembly.
5. Pull the taillamp assembly
straight back to remove.
6. Turn the indicator lamp bulb
socket anticlockwise to remove it
from the tail lamp assembly.
7. Pull the bulb straight out from
the socket.
8. Press a new bulb into the
socket, insert it into the tail lamp
assembly, and turn the bulb
socket clockwise until it clicks.
Number Plate Lamp
To replace one of these bulbs:
1. Open the tailgate. See Tailgate
on page 2-11.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (31,1)
Vehicle Care
10-31
8. Push on the lamp side opposite
the clip until the lamp assembly
snaps into place.
Replacement Bulbs
Exterior Lamp
Daytime Running
Lamp (If Equipped)
Passenger Side Shown, Driver
Side Similar
2. Push the left end of the lamp
assembly toward the right.
3. Turn the lamp assembly down to
remove it from the tailgate.
Headlamp Main
Beam (Base)
4. Turn the bulb socket (1)
anticlockwise to remove it from
the lamp assembly (3).
5. Pull the bulb (2) straight out of
the bulb socket.
6. Push the replacement bulb
straight into the bulb socket and
turn the bulb socket clockwise to
install into the lamp assembly.
7. Turn the lamp assembly into the
tailgate, engaging the clip side
first.
Bulb
Number
W21/
5W ULL
9005
Headlamp Dipped
Beam (Base)
H11 LL
Number Plate Lamp
W5WLL
Indicator Front
WY21W
Tail/Indicator Rear
WY21W
For replacement bulbs not listed
here, contact your dealer.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-32
Black plate (32,1)
Vehicle Care
Electrical System
Electrical System
Overload
The vehicle has fuses and circuit
breakers to protect against an
electrical system overload.
When the current electrical load is
too heavy, the circuit breaker opens
and closes, protecting the circuit
until the current load returns to
normal or the problem is fixed. This
greatly reduces the chance of circuit
overload and fire caused by
electrical problems.
Fuses and circuit breakers protect
power devices in the vehicle.
Replace a bad fuse with a new one
of the identical size and rating.
If there is a problem on the road and
a fuse needs to be replaced, the
same amperage fuse can be
borrowed. Choose some feature of
the vehicle that is not needed to use
and replace it as soon as possible.
Headlamp Wiring
An electrical overload may cause
the lamps to go on and off, or in
some cases to remain off. Have the
headlamp wiring checked right away
if the lamps go on and off or
remain off.
Windscreen Wipers
If the wiper motor overheats due to
heavy snow or ice, the windscreen
wipers will stop until the motor cools
and will then restart.
Although the circuit is protected
from electrical overload, overload
due to heavy snow or ice may
cause wiper linkage damage.
Always clear ice and heavy snow
from the windscreen before using
the windscreen wipers.
If the overload is caused by an
electrical problem and not snow or
ice, be sure to get it fixed.
Fuses and Circuit
Breakers
The wiring circuits in the vehicle are
protected from short circuits by a
combination of fuses and circuit
breakers. This greatly reduces the
chance of damage caused by
electrical problems.
To check a fuse, look at the
silver-coloured band inside the fuse.
If the band is broken or melted,
replace the fuse. Be sure to replace
a bad fuse with a new one of the
identical size and rating.
Fuses of the same amperage can
be temporarily borrowed from
another fuse location, if a fuse goes
out. Replace the fuse as soon as
possible.
To identify and check fuses, circuit
breakers, and relays, see Engine
Compartment Fuse Block on
page 10-33, Instrument Panel Fuse
Block on page 10-35, and Rear
Compartment Fuse Block on
page 10-37.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (33,1)
Vehicle Care
Engine Compartment
Fuse Block
To remove the fuse block cover,
press the clips on the cover and lift
it straight up.
{ Caution
Spilling liquid on any electrical
component on the vehicle may
damage it. Always keep the
covers on any electrical
component.
Engine Compartment Fuse Block
The vehicle may not be equipped
with all of the fuses, relays, and
features shown.
J-Case
Usage
Fuses
6
Wiper
12
Vacuum Pump
J-Case
Fuses
Usage
24
Antilock Brake
System Pump
25
Rear Electrical
Centre 1
10-33
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-34
Vehicle Care
J-Case
Fuses
Usage
26
Rear Electrical
Centre 2
41
Cooling Fan 2
42
Starter
45
Cooling Fan 1
MiniFuses
Usage
1
Engine Control
Module Battery
2
Transmission
Control Module
Battery
5
7
8
Black plate (34,1)
Engine Control
Module Run Crank
Post-Catalytic
Converter O2
Sensor
Pre-Catalytic
Converter O2
Sensor
MiniFuses
Usage
9
Engine Control
Module Powertrain
10
Fuel Injectors - Even
11
Fuel Injectors - Odd
13
Washer
14
Heated Steering
Wheel
15
Heads Up Display
16
Instrument Cluster/
Malfunction Indicator
Lamp/Ignition
17
Air Quality Sensor
18
Headlamp Washer
19
Transmission
Control Module Run
Crank
MiniFuses
Usage
32
Battery Sense
(Regulated Voltage
Control)
33
Adaptive Forward
Lighting/Adaptive
Headlamp Levelling
Module
35
Electronic Brake
Control Module
36
Air Conditioning
Compressor Clutch
46
Dipped Beam
Headlamp – Right
47
Dipped Beam
Headlamp – Left
50
Front Fog Lamps
51
Horn
20
Rear Electrical
Centre Run Crank
52
Fuel System Control
Module
30
Switch Back Light
53
Headlamp Level
54
Sensing Diagnostic
Module Ignition
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (35,1)
Vehicle Care
MiniFuses
Usage
Mini Relays
Usage
13
Cooling Fan 1
15
Run/Crank
55
Main Beam
Headlamp – Right
56
Main Beam
Headlamp – Left
57
Ignition Steering
Column Lock
2
Vacuum Pump
65
Trailer Right
Brake lamp
4
Wiper Control
66
Trailer Left
Brake lamp
5
Wiper Speed
10
Starter
67
Spare
12
Cool Fan 3
68
Spare
14
Dipped Beam/HID
69
Spare
70
Spare
U Micro
Relays
71
Spare
3
72
Spare
Air Conditioning
Compressor Clutch
8
Headlamp Washer
Mini Relays
Usage
7
Powertrain
9
Cooling Fan 2
Micro
Relays
10-35
Instrument Panel Fuse
Block
Usage
Usage
The instrument panel fuse block is
located in the centre console
between the driver and passenger
seats. To access the fuses, open
the fuse panel door from the
passenger side by pulling it out.
To reinstall the door, push the door
back into its original location.
The vehicle may not be equipped
with all of the fuses, relays and
features shown.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-36
Black plate (36,1)
Vehicle Care
MiniFuses
Usage
DISPLY
Display
S/ROOF
Sunroof
UHP
Universal
Handsfree Phone
(If Equipped)
RDO
Radio
APO –
IP/CNSL
Auxiliary Power
Outlet – Instrument
Panel/Console
APO - CNSL Auxiliary Power
Outlet - Floor
Console
Instrument Panel Fuse Block
BCM 1
Body Control
Module 3
BCM 4
Body Control
Module 4
BCM 7
Body Control
Module 7
ONSTAR
RAIN SNSR
OnStar® System (If
Equipped)
Rain Sensor
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (37,1)
Vehicle Care
MiniFuses
Usage
BCM 6
Body Control
Module 6
ESCL
Electronic Steering
Column Lock
AIRBAG
Sensing and
Diagnostic Module
DLC
Data Link
Connector
IPC
Instrument Cluster
STR
WHL SW
BCM 3
BCM 2
AMP/RDO
HVAC
Steering Wheel
Switch
J-Case
Fuses
Usage
BCM 8
Body Control
Module 8
FRT BLWR
Front Blower
Relays
Usage
RAP/
ACCY RLY
Retained
Accessory Power/
Accessory Relay
Breakers
Usage
Body Control
Module 2
HTR DR
Heated Driver Seat
HTR PAS
Heated
Passenger Seat
Heating Ventilation
& Air Conditioning
Rear Compartment Fuse
Block
LOGIC RLY/ Logistics Relay/
SHUNT
Shunt
Body Control
Module 1
Amplifier/Radio
10-37
The rear compartment fuse block is
in the cargo area, on the driver side
of the vehicle behind the lower trim
panel. To open, turn the latch with a
flat bladed tool and pull the trim
panel from the edges to fold it down.
The vehicle may not be equipped
with all of the fuses, relays, and
features shown.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-38
Black plate (38,1)
Vehicle Care
Fuses
Usage
AOS MDL
Automatic Occupant
Sensing Module
AUX PWR
Auxiliary Power
Outlet
* BCM
THEFT
CAMERA
CNSTR
VENT
Body Control
Module Theft
Rear Vision Camera
Canister Vent
DRV
Driver Power Seat
PWR SEAT
EOCM/
SBZA
External Object
Calculating Module/
Side Blind Zone
Alert
FRT
HTD SEAT
Front Heated Seats
FRT
Front Ventilated
VENT SEAT Seats
Rear Compartment Fuse Block
FUEL
PUMP
HTD MIR
Fuel Pump
Heated Mirror
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (39,1)
Vehicle Care
Fuses
Usage
Fuses
IGN/
THEFT 1
Ignition/Theft 1
REAR
DEFOG
IGN/
THEFT 2
Ignition/Theft 2
REAR
HTD SEAT
INFOTMNT Infotainment
Usage
Rear Defog
Rear Heated Seats
RT WDO
Right Window
LGM
Tailgate Module
RPA MDL
LGM
LOGIC
Tailgate Module
Logic
Rear Parking Assist
Module
MDL TRLR Trailer Module
MIR
WDO MDL
Mirror Window
Module
PRK
BRK MDL
Park Brake Module
PASS DR
WDO SW
Passenger Door
Window Switch
PASS DR Passenger/Driver
PWR SEAT Power Seats
PRK
LPS TRLR
Trailer Park Lamps
RDM
Rear Drive Module
UGDO
VICS
REAR/WPR Rear Wiper
Tailgate
* T/GATE
Fuses
SADS MDL Semi Active
Damping System
Module
WNDO
Power Window
Rear Window
Demister
Security
LOGIC
SPARE
Not Used
SPARE
FUSES
Spare Fuses
*
TRLR EXP
Trailer Export
TRLR
Trailer Module
Fuel Pump
Logistic Relay
(Export)
* RUN RLY Run Relay
SPARE
Trailer 2
Vehicle Information
Communications
System (Export)
DEMIST
REAR
Shunt
* TRLR 2
Universal Garage
Door Opener
Usage
SHUNT
* SEC
Usage
Relays
*
FUEL
PUMP
WPR
CONTRL
10-39
Not Used
Wiper Control
*Denotes uplevel content.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-40
Vehicle Care
Wheels and Tyres
Warning (Continued)
Tyres
Every new GM vehicle has
high-quality tyres made by a
leading tyre manufacturer. See
the warranty manual for
information regarding the tyre
warranty and where to get
service. For additional
information refer to the tyre
manufacturer.
and a serious crash. See
Vehicle Load Limits on
page 9-8.
.
{ Warning
.
.
Black plate (40,1)
Poorly maintained and
improperly used tyres are
dangerous.
Overloading the tyres can
cause overheating as a
result of too much flexing.
There could be a blowout
(Continued)
.
Underinflated tyres pose
the same danger as
overloaded tyres. The
resulting crash could
cause serious injury.
Check all tyres frequently
to maintain the
recommended pressure.
Tyre pressure should be
checked when the tyres
are cold.
Overinflated tyres are
more likely to be cut,
punctured, or broken by a
sudden impact - such as
when hitting a pothole.
Keep tyres at the
recommended pressure.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
.
Worn or old tyres can
cause a crash. If the tread
is badly worn,
replace them.
.
Replace any tyres that
have been damaged by
impacts with potholes,
curbs, etc.
.
Improperly repaired tyres
can cause a crash. Only
the dealer or an
authorised tyre service
centre should repair,
replace, dismount, and
mount the tyres.
.
Do not spin the tyres in
excess of 56 km/h
(35 mph) on slippery
surfaces such as snow,
mud, ice, etc. Excessive
spinning may cause the
tyres to explode.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (41,1)
Vehicle Care
See Tyre Pressure for
High-Speed Operation on
page 10-43 for inflation pressure
adjustment for high-speed
driving.
All-Season Tyres
This vehicle may come with
all-season tyres. These tyres are
designed to provide good overall
performance on most road surfaces
and weather conditions. Original
equipment tyres designed to GM's
specific tyre performance criteria
have a TPC specification code
moulded onto the sidewall. Original
equipment all-season tyres can be
identified by the last two characters
of this TPC code, which will
be “MS.”
Consider installing winter tyres on
the vehicle if frequent driving on
snow or ice-covered roads is
expected. All-season tyres provide
adequate performance for most
winter driving conditions, but they
may not offer the same level of
10-41
Use only radial ply tyres of the
same size, load range and
speed rating as the original
equipment tyres.
traction or performance as winter
tyres on snow or ice-covered roads.
See Winter Tyres on page 10-41.
.
Winter Tyres
Winter tyres with the same speed
rating as the original equipment
tyres may not be available for H, V,
W, Y and ZR speed rated tyres.
If winter tyres with a lower speed
rating are chosen, never exceed the
tyre's maximum speed capability.
This vehicle was not originally
equipped with winter tyres. Winter
tyres are designed for increased
traction on snow and ice-covered
roads. Consider installing winter
tyres on the vehicle if frequent
driving on ice or snow covered
roads is expected. See your dealer
for details regarding winter tyre
availability and proper tyre
selection. Also, see Buying New
Tyres on page 10-50.
With winter tyres, there may be
decreased dry road traction,
increased road noise and shorter
tread life. After changing to winter
tyres, be alert for changes in the
vehicle handling and braking.
If using winter tyres:
.
Use tyres of the same brand and
tread type on all four wheel
positions.
Summer Tyres
This vehicle may come with high
performance summer tyres. These
tyres have a special tread and
compound that are optimised for
maximum dry and wet road
performance. This special tread and
compound will decrease
performance in cold climates, and
on ice and snow. We recommend
installing winter tyres on the vehicle
if frequent driving in cold
temperatures or on snow or ice
covered roads is expected. See
Winter Tyres on page 10-41.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-42
Black plate (42,1)
Vehicle Care
Tyre Pressure
Caution (Continued)
Tyres need the correct amount
of air pressure to operate
effectively.
{ Caution
Neither tyre underinflation nor
overinflation is good.
Underinflated tyres, or tyres
that do not have enough air,
can result in:
.
Tyre overloading and
overheating which could
lead to a blowout.
.
Premature or
irregular wear.
.
Poor handling.
.
Reduced fuel economy.
Overinflated tyres, or tyres
that have too much air, can
result in:
(Continued)
.
Unusual wear.
.
Poor handling.
.
Rough ride.
.
Needless damage from
road hazards.
When to Check
Check the tyres once a month or
more. Do not forget the compact
spare, if the vehicle has one.
The cold compact spare tyre
pressure should be at 420 kPa
(60 psi). See Compact Spare
Tyre on page 10-69.
How to Check
The Tyre and Loading
Information label on the vehicle
indicates the original equipment
tyres and the correct cold tyre
inflation pressures. The
recommended pressure is the
minimum air pressure needed to
support the vehicle's maximum
load carrying capacity. See
Vehicle Load Limits on
page 9-8.
How the vehicle is loaded
affects vehicle handling and ride
comfort. Never load the vehicle
with more weight than it was
designed to carry.
Use a good quality pocket-type
gauge to check tyre pressure.
Proper tyre inflation cannot be
determined by looking at the
tyre. Check the tyre inflation
pressure when the tyres are
cold, meaning the vehicle has
not been driven for at least three
hours or no more than
1.6 km (1 mi).
Remove the valve cap from the
tyre valve stem. Press the tyre
gauge firmly onto the valve to
get a pressure measurement.
If the cold tyre inflation pressure
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (43,1)
Vehicle Care
matches the recommended
pressure on the Tyre and
Loading Information label, no
further adjustment is necessary.
If the inflation pressure is low,
add air until the recommended
pressure is reached. If the
inflation pressure is high, press
on the metal stem in the centre
of the tyre valve to release air.
Recheck the tyre pressure with
the tyre gauge.
Return the valve caps on the
valve stems to prevent leaks
and keep out dirt and moisture.
Tyre Pressure for
High-Speed Operation
{ Warning
Driving at high speeds, 160 km/h
(100 mph) or higher, puts an
additional strain on tyres.
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
Sustained high-speed driving
causes excessive heat build-up
and can cause sudden tyre
failure. You could have a crash
and you or others could be killed.
Some high-speed rated tyres
require inflation pressure
adjustment for high-speed
operation. When speed limits and
road conditions are such that a
vehicle can be driven at high
speeds, make sure the tyres are
rated for high-speed operation, in
excellent condition, and set to the
correct cold tyre inflation pressure
for the vehicle load.
Vehicles with P235/65R18, P235/
55R20, or 235/55R20 size tyres
require inflation pressure adjustment
when driving the vehicle at speeds
of 160 km/h (100 mph) or higher.
Set the cold inflation pressure to the
maximum inflation pressure shown
on the tyre sidewall, or 260 kPa
10-43
(38 psi), whichever is lower. Return
the tyres to the recommended cold
tyre inflation pressure when
high-speed driving has ended. See
Vehicle Load Limits on page 9-8
and Tyre Pressure on page 10-42.
The maximum load and inflation
pressure is molded on the tyre
sidewall, in small letters, near the
rim flange. It will read something like
this: Maximum load 690 kg
(1521 lbs) 300 kPa (44 psi) Max.
Press.
Tyre Pressure Monitor
System
{ Caution
Modifications made to the Tyre
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)
by anyone other than an
authorised service facility may
void authorisation to use the
system.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-44
Black plate (44,1)
Vehicle Care
The Tyre Pressure Monitor System
(TPMS) uses radio and sensor
technology to check tyre pressure
levels. The TPMS sensors monitor
the air pressure in your vehicle's
tyres and transmit tyre pressure
readings to a receiver located in the
vehicle.
Each tyre, including the spare (if
provided), should be checked
monthly when cold and inflated to
the inflation pressure recommended
by the vehicle manufacturer on the
vehicle placard or tyre inflation
pressure label. (If your vehicle has
tyres of a different size than the size
indicated on the vehicle placard or
tyre inflation pressure label, you
should determine the proper tyre
inflation pressure for those tyres.)
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a
tyre pressure monitoring system
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tyre
pressure telltale when one or more
of your tyres is significantly
under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tyre
pressure telltale illuminates, you
should stop and check your tyres as
soon as possible, and inflate them
to the proper pressure. Driving on a
significantly under-inflated tyre
causes the tyre to overheat and can
lead to tyre failure. Under-inflation
also reduces fuel efficiency and tyre
tread life, and may affect the
vehicle's handling and stopping
ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tyre
maintenance, and it is the driver's
responsibility to maintain correct
tyre pressure, even if under-inflation
has not reached the level to trigger
illumination of the TPMS low tyre
pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been
equipped with a TPMS malfunction
indicator to indicate when the
system is not operating properly.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is
combined with the low tyre pressure
telltale. When the system detects a
malfunction, the telltale will flash for
approximately one minute and then
remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as
long as the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be
able to detect or signal low tyre
pressure as intended. TPMS
malfunctions may occur for a variety
of reasons, including the installation
of replacement or alternate tyres or
wheels on the vehicle that prevent
the TPMS from functioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more
tyres or wheels on your vehicle to
ensure that the replacement or
alternate tyres and wheels allow the
TPMS to continue to function
properly.
See Tyre Pressure Monitor
Operation on page 10-45 for
additional information.
See Declaration of Conformity on
page 13-1.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (45,1)
Vehicle Care
Tyre Pressure Monitor
Operation
This vehicle may have a Tyre
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS).
The TPMS is designed to warn the
driver when a low tyre pressure
condition exists. TPMS sensors are
mounted onto each tyre and wheel
assembly, excluding the spare tyre
and wheel assembly. The TPMS
sensors monitor the air pressure in
the tyres and transmits the tyre
pressure readings to a receiver
located in the vehicle.
When a low tyre pressure condition
is detected, the TPMS illuminates
the low tyre pressure warning light
on the instrument cluster. If the
warning light comes on, stop as
soon as possible and inflate the
tires to the recommended pressure
shown on the Tire and Loading
Information label. See Vehicle Load
Limits on page 9-8.
A message to check the pressure in
a specific tyre displays in the Driver
Information Centre (DIC). The low
tyre pressure warning light and the
DIC warning message come on at
each ignition cycle until the tyres
are inflated to the correct inflation
pressure. Using the DIC, tyre
pressure levels can be viewed. For
additional information and details
about the DIC operation and
displays see Driver Information
Centre (DIC) on page 5-25.
The low tyre pressure warning light
may come on in cool weather when
the vehicle is first started, and then
turn off as the vehicle is driven. This
could be an early indicator that the
air pressure is getting low and
needs to be inflated to the proper
pressure.
10-45
A Tyre and Loading Information
label, attached to your vehicle,
shows the size of the original
equipment tyres and the correct
inflation pressure for the tyres when
they are cold. See Vehicle Load
Limits on page 9-8, for an example
of the Tyre and Loading Information
label and its location. Also see Tyre
Pressure on page 10-42.
The TPMS can warn about a low
tyre pressure condition but it does
not replace normal tyre
maintenance. See Tyre Inspection
on page 10-48, Tyre Rotation on
page 10-48 and Tyres on
page 10-40.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-46
Black plate (46,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Caution
Tyre sealant materials are not all
the same. A non-approved tyre
sealant could damage the TPMS
sensors. TPMS sensor damage
caused by using an incorrect tyre
sealant is not covered by the
vehicle warranty. Always use only
the GM approved tyre sealant
available through your dealer or
included in the vehicle.
Factory-installed Tyre Inflator Kits
use a GM approved liquid tyre
sealant. Using non-approved tyre
sealants could damage the TPMS
sensors. See Tyre Sealant and
Compressor Kit on page 10-56 for
information regarding the inflator kit
materials and instructions.
TPMS Malfunction Light and
Message
The TPMS will not function properly
if one or more of the TPMS sensors
are missing or inoperable. When the
system detects a malfunction, the
low tyre warning light flashes for
about one minute and then stays on
for the remainder of the ignition
cycle. A DIC warning message also
displays. The malfunction light and
DIC warning message come on at
each ignition cycle until the problem
is corrected. Some of the conditions
that can cause these to come
on are:
.
One of the road tyres has been
replaced with the spare tyre. The
spare tyre does not have a
TPMS sensor. The malfunction
light and DIC message should
go off after the road tyre is
replaced and the sensor
matching process is performed
successfully. See “TPMS Sensor
Matching Process” later in this
section.
.
The TPMS sensor matching
process was not done or not
completed successfully after
rotating the tyres. The
malfunction light and the DIC
message should go off after
successfully completing the
sensor matching process. See
"TPMS Sensor Matching
Process" later in this section.
.
One or more TPMS sensors are
missing or damaged. The
malfunction light and the DIC
message should go off when the
TPMS sensors are installed and
the sensor matching process is
performed successfully. See
your dealer for service.
.
Replacement tyres or wheels do
not match the original equipment
tyres or wheels. Tyres and
wheels other than those
recommended could prevent the
TPMS from functioning properly.
See Buying New Tyres on
page 10-50.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (47,1)
Vehicle Care
.
Operating electronic devices or
being near facilities using radio
wave frequencies similar to the
TPMS could cause the TPMS
sensors to malfunction.
If the TPMS is not functioning
properly it cannot detect or signal a
low tyre condition. See your dealer
for service if the TPMS malfunction
light and DIC message comes on
and stays on.
TPMS Sensor Matching
Process
Each TPMS sensor has a unique
identification code. The identification
code needs to be matched to a new
tyre/wheel position after rotating the
vehicle's tyres or replacing one or
more of the TPMS sensors. The
TPMS sensor matching process
should also be performed after
replacing a spare tyre with a road
tyre containing the TPMS sensor.
The malfunction light and the DIC
message should go off at the next
ignition cycle. The sensors are
matched to the tyre/wheel positions,
10-47
using a TPMS relearn tool, in the
following order: driver side front
tyre, passenger side front tyre,
passenger side rear tyre, and driver
side rear. See your dealer for
service or to purchase a
relearn tool.
4. Use the five-way DIC control on
the right side of the steering
wheel to scroll to the Tyre
Pressure screen under the DIC
info page. See Driver
Information Centre (DIC) on
page 5-25.
You have two minutes to match the
first tyre/wheel position, and
five minutes overall to match all four
tyre/wheel positions. If it takes
longer, the matching process stops
and must be restarted.
5. Press and hold the SEL button
in the centre of the five-way DIC
control.
The TPMS sensor matching process
is outlined below:
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. Place the vehicle power mode in
ON/RUN/START. See Ignition
Positions on page 9-14.
3. Make sure the Tyre Pressure
info display option is turned on.
The info displays on the DIC can
be turned on and off through the
Settings menu. See Driver
Information Centre (DIC) on
page 5-25.
The horn sounds twice to signal
the receiver is in relearn mode
and the TIRE LEARNING
ACTIVE message displays on
the DIC screen.
6. Start with the driver side
front tyre.
7. Place the relearn tool against
the tyre sidewall, near the valve
stem. Then press the button to
activate the TPMS sensor.
A horn chirp confirms that the
sensor identification code has
been matched to this tyre and
wheel position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-48
Black plate (48,1)
Vehicle Care
8. Proceed to the passenger side
front tyre, and repeat Step 7.
9. Proceed to the passenger side
rear tyre, and repeat Step 7.
10. Proceed to the driver side rear
tyre, and repeat Step 7. The
horn sounds twice to indicate
the sensor identification code
has been matched to the driver
side rear tyre, and the TPMS
sensor matching process is no
longer active. The TIRE
LEARNING ACTIVE message
on the DIC display screen
goes off.
11. Shut the ignition off.
Tyre Inspection
We recommend that the tyres,
including the spare tyre, if the
vehicle has one, be inspected
for signs of wear or damage at
least once a month.
Replace the tyre if:
.
The indicators at three or
more places around the tyre
can be seen.
.
There is cord or fabric
showing through the tyre's
rubber.
.
12. Set all four tyres to the
recommended air pressure
level as indicated on the Tyre
and Loading Information label.
.
The tread or sidewall is
cracked, cut, or snagged
deep enough to show cord or
fabric.
The tyre has a bump, bulge,
or split.
.
The tyre has a puncture, cut,
or other damage that cannot
be repaired well because of
the size or location of the
damage.
Tyre Rotation
Tyres should be rotated at the
intervals specified in the
Maintenance Schedule. See
Scheduled Maintenance on
page 11-1.
Tyres are rotated to achieve a
uniform wear for all tyres. The
first rotation is the most
important.
Anytime unusual wear is
noticed, rotate the tyres as soon
as possible, check for proper
tyre inflation pressure, and
check for damaged tyres or
wheels. If the unusual wear
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (49,1)
Vehicle Care
continues after the rotation,
check the wheel alignment. See
When It Is Time for New Tyres
on page 10-49 and Wheel
Replacement on page 10-53.
the tyres have been rotated. See
Tyre Pressure on page 10-42
and Vehicle Load Limits on
page 9-8.
Reset the Tyre Pressure Monitor
System. See Tyre Pressure
Monitor Operation on
page 10-45.
Check that all wheel nuts are
properly tightened. See “Wheel
Nut Torque” under Capacities
and Specifications on
page 12-2.
{ Warning
Use this rotation pattern when
rotating the tyres.
Do not include the compact
spare tyre in the tyre rotation.
Adjust the front and rear tyres to
the recommended inflation
pressure on the Tyre and
Loading Information label after
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the
parts to which it is fastened, can
make wheel nuts become loose
after time. The wheel could come
off and cause an accident. When
changing a wheel, remove any
rust or dirt from places where the
wheel attaches to the vehicle. In
(Continued)
10-49
Warning (Continued)
an emergency, a cloth or a paper
towel can be used; however, use
a scraper or wire brush later to
remove all rust or dirt.
Lightly coat the centre of the
wheel hub with wheel bearing
grease after a wheel change or
tyre rotation to prevent corrosion
or rust build-up. Do not get
grease on the flat wheel
mounting surface or on the
wheel nuts or bolts.
When It Is Time for New
Tyres
Factors such as maintenance,
temperatures, driving speeds,
vehicle loading, and road conditions
affect the wear rate of the tyres.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-50
Black plate (50,1)
Vehicle Care
equipped, be replaced after six
years, regardless of tread wear. The
tyre manufacturer date is the last
four digits of the DOT Tyre
Identification Number (TIN) which is
moulded into one side of the tyre
sidewall. The first two digits
represent the week (01–52) and the
last two digits, the year. For
example, the third week of the year
2010 would have a four-digit DOT
date of 0310.
Tread wear indicators are one way
to tell when it is time for new tyres.
Tread wear indicators appear when
the tyres have only 1.6 mm (1/16 in)
or less of tread remaining. See Tyre
Inspection on page 10-48 and Tyre
Rotation on page 10-48.
The rubber in tyres ages over time.
This also applies to the spare tyre,
if the vehicle has one, even if it is
never used. Multiple factors
including temperatures, loading
conditions, and inflation pressure
maintenance affect how fast ageing
takes place. GM recommends that
tyres, including the spare if
Vehicle Storage
Tyres age when stored normally
mounted on a parked vehicle. Park
a vehicle that will be stored for at
least a month in a cool, dry, clean
area away from direct sunlight to
slow ageing. This area should be
free of grease, petrol, or other
substances that can deteriorate
rubber.
Parking for an extended period can
cause flat spots on the tyres that
may result in vibrations while
driving. When storing a vehicle for
at least a month, remove the tyres
or raise the vehicle to reduce the
weight from the tyres.
Buying New Tyres
GM has developed and matched
specific tyres for the vehicle.
The original equipment tyres
installed were designed to meet
General Motors Tyre
Performance Criteria
Specification (TPC Spec)
system rating. When
replacement tyres are needed,
GM strongly recommends
buying tyres with the same TPC
Spec rating.
GM's exclusive TPC Spec
system considers over a dozen
critical specifications that impact
the overall performance of the
vehicle, including brake system
performance, ride and handling,
traction control, and tyre
pressure monitoring
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (51,1)
Vehicle Care
performance. GM's TPC Spec
number is moulded onto the
tyre's sidewall near the tyre size.
If the tyres have an all-season
tread design, the TPC Spec
number will be followed by MS
for mud and snow.
GM recommends replacing worn
tyres in complete sets of four.
Uniform tread depth on all tyres
will help to maintain the
performance of the vehicle.
Braking and handling
performance may be adversely
affected if all the tyres are not
replaced at the same time.
If proper rotation and
maintenance have been done,
all four tyres should wear out at
about the same time. See Tyre
Rotation on page 10-48 for
information on proper tyre
rotation. However, if it is
necessary to replace only one
axle set of worn tyres, place the
new tyres on the rear axle.
Winter tyres with the same
speed rating as the original
equipment tyres may not be
available for H, V, W, Y and ZR
speed rated tyres. Never exceed
the winter tyre's maximum
speed capability when using
winter tyres with a lower speed
rating.
10-51
{ Warning
Mixing tyres of different sizes,
brands, or types may cause
loss of control of the vehicle,
resulting in a crash or other
vehicle damage. Use the
correct size, brand, and type
of tyres on all wheels.
{ Warning
Tyres could explode during
improper service. Attempting
to mount or dismount a tyre
could cause injury or death.
Only your dealer or authorised
tyre service centre should
mount or dismount the tyres.
{ Warning
Using bias-ply tyres on the
vehicle may cause the wheel
rim flanges to develop cracks
after many miles of driving.
A tyre and/or wheel could fail
suddenly and cause a crash.
Use only radial-ply tyres with
the wheels on the vehicle.
If the vehicle tyres must be
replaced with a tyre that does
not have a TPC Spec number,
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-52
Black plate (52,1)
Vehicle Care
make sure they are the same
size, load range, speed rating,
and construction (radial) as the
original tyres.
Vehicles that have a tyre
pressure monitoring system
could give an inaccurate
low-pressure warning if non-TPC
Spec rated tyres are installed.
See Tyre Pressure Monitor
System on page 10-43.
The Tyre and Loading
Information label indicates the
original equipment tyres on the
vehicle. See Vehicle Load Limits
on page 9-8 for the label
location and more information
about the Tyre and Loading
Information label.
Different Size Tyres and
Wheels
If wheels or tyres are installed that
are a different size than the original
equipment wheels and tyres, vehicle
performance, including its braking,
ride and handling characteristics,
stability, and resistance to rollover
may be affected. If the vehicle has
electronic systems such as antilock
brakes, rollover airbags, traction
control, electronic stability control,
or All-Wheel Drive, the performance
of these systems can also be
affected.
{ Warning
If different sized wheels are used,
there may not be an acceptable
level of performance and safety if
tyres not recommended for those
wheels are selected. This
increases the chance of a crash
and serious injury. Only use GM
specific wheel and tyre systems
developed for the vehicle, and
have them properly installed by a
GM certified technician.
See Buying New Tyres on
page 10-50 and Accessories and
Modifications on page 10-2.
Wheel Alignment and
Tyre Balance
The tyres and wheels were aligned
and balanced at the factory to
provide the longest tyre life and best
overall performance. Adjustments to
wheel alignment and tyre balancing
are not necessary on a regular
basis. Consider an alignment check
if there is unusual tyre wear or the
vehicle is significantly pulling to one
side or the other. Some slight pull to
the left or right, depending on the
crown of the road and/or other road
surface variations such as troughs
or ruts, is normal. If the vehicle is
vibrating when driving on a smooth
road, the tyres and wheels may
need to be rebalanced. See your
dealer for proper diagnosis.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (53,1)
Vehicle Care
Wheel Replacement
Replace any wheel that is bent,
cracked, or badly rusted or
corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming
loose, the wheel, wheel bolts, and
wheel nuts should be replaced.
If the wheel leaks air, replace it.
Some aluminium wheels can be
repaired. See your dealer if any of
these conditions exist.
Your dealer will know the kind of
wheel that is needed.
Each new wheel should have the
same load-carrying capacity,
diameter, width, offset, and be
mounted the same way as the one it
replaces.
Replace wheels, wheel bolts, wheel
nuts, or Tyre Pressure Monitor
System (TPMS) sensors with new
GM original equipment parts.
{ Warning
Using the wrong replacement
wheels, wheel bolts, or wheel
nuts can be dangerous. It could
affect the braking and handling of
the vehicle. Tyres can lose air,
and cause loss of control, causing
a crash. Always use the correct
wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel
nuts for replacement.
{ Caution
The wrong wheel can also cause
problems with bearing life, brake
cooling, speedometer or
odometer calibration, headlamp
aim, bumper height, vehicle
ground clearance, and tyre or tyre
chain clearance to the body and
chassis.
10-53
Used Replacement Wheels
{ Warning
Replacing a wheel with a used
one is dangerous. How it has
been used or how far it has been
driven may be unknown. It could
fail suddenly and cause a crash.
When replacing wheels, use a
new GM original equipment
wheel.
Tyre Chains
Use tyre chains only where legal
and only when necessary.
Before using tyre chains, check with
the tyre manufacturer to make sure
tyre chains are compatible with the
tyres on the vehicle. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions.
Only use tyre chains on 235/65R18
size tyres. Do not use tyre chains
on 235/55R20 size tyres.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-54
Black plate (54,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Caution
Do not install traction devices on
the front tyres.
Install them on the rear tyres only,
as tightly as possible, with the ends
securely fastened.
Always use fine mesh chains that
add no more than 10 mm to the tyre
tread and the inboard sides,
including chain lock.
{ Caution
To help avoid damage to the
vehicle, drive slowly, do not spin
the wheels, and readjust or
remove the device if it contacts
the vehicle.
Drive slowly and follow the cable
manufacturer's instructions. If the
cables are contacting the vehicle,
stop and retighten them. If the
contact continues, slow down until it
stops.
Do not use tyre chains on the
spare tyre.
If a Tyre Goes Flat
It is unusual for a tyre to blow out
while driving, especially if the tyres
are maintained properly. See Tyres
on page 10-40. If air goes out of a
tyre, it is much more likely to leak
out slowly. But if there is ever a
blowout, here are a few tips about
what to expect and what to do:
If a front tyre fails, the flat tyre
creates a drag that pulls the vehicle
toward that side. Take your foot off
the accelerator pedal and grip the
steering wheel firmly. Steer to
maintain lane position, and then
gently brake to a stop, well off the
road, if possible.
A rear blowout, particularly on a
curve, acts much like a skid and
may require the same correction as
used in a skid. Stop pressing the
accelerator pedal and steer to
straighten the vehicle. It may be
very bumpy and noisy. Gently brake
to a stop, well off the road,
if possible.
{ Warning
Driving on a flat tyre will cause
permanent damage to the tyre.
Re-inflating a tyre after it has
been driven on while severely
underinflated or flat may cause a
blowout and a serious crash.
Never attempt to re-inflate a tyre
that has been driven on while
severely underinflated or flat.
Have your dealer or an authorized
tyre service centre repair or
replace the flat tyre as soon as
possible.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (55,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Warning
{ Warning
Lifting a vehicle and getting under
it to do maintenance or repairs is
dangerous without the
appropriate safety equipment and
training. If a jack is provided with
the vehicle, it is designed only for
changing a flat tyre. If it is used
for anything else, you or others
could be badly injured or killed if
the vehicle slips off the jack. If a
jack is provided with the vehicle,
only use it for changing a flat tyre.
Changing a tyre can be
dangerous. The vehicle can slip
off the jack and roll over or fall
causing injury or death. Find a
level place to change the tyre. To
help prevent the vehicle from
moving:
If a tyre goes flat, avoid further tyre
and wheel damage by driving slowly
to a level place, well off the road,
if possible. Turn on the hazard
warning flashers. See Hazard
Warning Flashers on page 6-7.
1. Apply the parking brake
firmly.
2. Put an automatic
transmission in P (Park) or a
manual gearbox in 1 (First)
or R (Reverse).
This vehicle may come with a jack
and spare tyre or a tyre sealant and
compressor kit. To use the jacking
equipment to change a spare tyre
safely, follow the instructions below.
Then see Tyre Changing on
page 10-63. To use the tyre sealant
and compressor kit, see Tyre
Sealant and Compressor Kit on
page 10-56.
When the vehicle has a flat tyre (2),
use the following example as a
guide to assist you in the placement
of wheel blocks (1).
3. Turn off the engine and do
not restart while the vehicle
is raised.
4. Do not allow passengers to
remain in the vehicle.
5. Place wheel blocks on both
sides of the tyre at the
opposite corner of the tyre
being changed.
10-55
1. Wheel Block
2. Flat Tyre
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-56
Black plate (56,1)
Vehicle Care
The following information explains
how to repair or change a tyre.
Tyre Sealant and
Compressor Kit
{ Warning
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed
area with poor ventilation is
dangerous. Engine exhaust may
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust
contains carbon monoxide (CO)
which cannot be seen or smelled.
It can cause unconsciousness
and even death. Never run the
engine in an enclosed area that
has no fresh air ventilation. For
more information, see Engine
Exhaust on page 9-20.
{ Warning
Overinflating a tyre could cause
the tyre to rupture and you or
others could be injured. Be sure
to read and follow the tyre sealant
and compressor kit instructions
and inflate the tyre to its
recommended pressure. Do not
exceed the recommended
pressure.
{ Warning
Storing the tyre sealant and
compressor kit or other
equipment in the passenger
compartment of the vehicle could
cause injury. In a sudden stop or
collision, loose equipment could
strike someone. Store the tyre
sealant and compressor kit in its
original location.
If this vehicle has a tyre sealant and
compressor kit, there may not be a
spare tyre, tyre changing
equipment, and on some vehicles
there may not be a place to store
a tyre.
The tyre sealant and compressor
can be used to temporarily seal
punctures up to 6 mm (0.25 in) in
the tread area of the tyre. It can also
be used to inflate an under
inflated tyre.
If the tyre has been separated from
the wheel, has damaged sidewalls,
or has a large puncture, the tyre is
too severely damaged for the tyre
sealant and compressor kit to be
effective.
Read and follow all of the tyre
sealant and compressor kit
instructions.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (57,1)
Vehicle Care
The kit includes:
2. On/Off Button
3. Pressure Gauge
4. Pressure Deflation Button
5. Tyre Sealant Canister
6. Sealant/Air Hose (Clear)
7. Air Only Hose (Black)
8. Power Plug
9. Canister Release Button (Under
Sealant/Air Hose)
Tyre Sealant
Read and follow the safe handling
instructions on the label adhered to
the sealant canister.
Check the tyre sealant expiration
date on the sealant canister. The
sealant canister should be replaced
before its expiration date.
Replacement sealant canisters are
available at your local dealer. See
“Removal and Installation of the
Sealant Canister” following.
1. Selector Switch (Sealant/Air or
Air Only)
10-57
There is only enough sealant to seal
one tyre. After usage, the sealant
canister and sealant/air hose
assembly must be replaced. See
“Removal and Installation of the
Sealant Canister” following.
Using the Tyre Sealant and
Compressor Kit to Temporarily
Seal and Inflate a
Punctured Tyre
Follow the directions closely for
correct sealant usage.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-58
Black plate (58,1)
Vehicle Care
heated environment for five minutes.
This will help to inflate the tyre
faster.
4. Remove the valve stem cap from
the flat tyre by turning it
anticlockwise.
If a tyre goes flat, avoid further tyre
and wheel damage by driving slowly
to a level place. Turn on the hazard
warning flashers. See Hazard
Warning Flashers on page 6-7.
5. Attach the sealant/air hose (6)
onto the tyre valve stem. Turn it
clockwise until it is tight.
See If a Tyre Goes Flat on
page 10-54 for other important
safety warnings.
Do not remove any objects that
have penetrated the tyre.
1. Remove the tyre sealant and
compressor kit from its storage
location. See Storing the Tyre
Sealant and Compressor Kit on
page 10-63.
2. Unwrap the sealant/air hose (6)
and the power plug (8).
3. Place the kit on the ground.
When using the tyre sealant and
compressor kit during cold
temperatures, warm the kit in a
Make sure the tyre valve stem is
positioned close to the ground
so the hose will reach it.
6. Plug the power plug (8) into the
accessory power outlet in the
vehicle. Unplug all items from
other accessory power outlets.
See Power Outlets on page 5-6.
If the vehicle has an accessory
power outlet, do not use the
cigarette lighter.
If the vehicle only has a cigarette
lighter, use the cigarette lighter.
Do not pinch the power plug
cord in the door or window.
7. Start the vehicle. The vehicle
must be running while using the
air compressor.
8. Press and turn the selector
switch (1) anticlockwise to the
Sealant + Air position.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (59,1)
Vehicle Care
9. Press the on/off (2) button to
turn the tyre sealant and
compressor kit on.
The compressor will inject
sealant and air into the tyre.
The pressure gauge (3) will
initially show a high pressure
while the compressor pushes the
sealant into the tyre. Once the
sealant is completely dispersed
into the tyre, the pressure will
quickly drop and start to rise
again as the tyre inflates with
air only.
10. Inflate the tyre to the
recommended inflation
pressure using the pressure
gauge (3). The recommended
inflation pressure can be found
on the Tyre and Loading
Information label. See Tyre
Pressure on page 10-42.
The pressure gauge (3) may
read higher than the actual tyre
pressure while the compressor
is on. Turn the compressor off
to get an accurate pressure
reading. The compressor may
be turned on/off until the
correct pressure is reached.
{ Caution
If the recommended pressure
cannot be reached after
approximately 25 minutes, the
vehicle should not be driven
farther. The tyre is too severely
damaged and the tyre sealant
and compressor kit cannot inflate
the tyre. Remove the power plug
from the accessory power outlet
and unscrew the inflating hose
from the tyre valve.
10-59
11. Press the on/off button (2) to
turn the tyre sealant and
compressor kit off.
The tyre is not sealed and will
continue to leak air until the
vehicle is driven and the
sealant is distributed in the
tyre, therefore, Steps 12–
18 must be done immediately
after Step 11.
Be careful while handling the
tyre sealant and compressor kit
as it could be warm after
usage.
12. Unplug the power plug (8) from
the accessory power outlet in
the vehicle.
13. Turn the sealant/air hose (6)
anticlockwise to remove it from
the tyre valve stem.
14. Replace the tyre valve
stem cap.
15. Replace the sealant/air hose
(6), and the power plug (8)
back in their original location.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-60
Black plate (60,1)
Vehicle Care
19. Stop at a safe location and
check the tyre pressure. Refer
to Steps 1–11 under “Using the
Tyre Sealant and Compressor
Kit without Sealant to Inflate a
Tyre (Not Punctured).”
16. If the flat tyre was able to
inflate to the recommended
inflation pressure, remove the
maximum speed label from the
sealant canister (5) and place it
in a highly visible location. Do
not exceed the speed on this
label until the damaged tyre is
repaired or replaced.
17. Return the equipment to its
original storage location in the
vehicle.
18. Immediately drive the vehicle
8 km (5 mi) to distribute the
sealant in the tyre.
If the tyre pressure has fallen
more than 68 kPa (10 psi)
below the recommended
inflation pressure, stop driving
the vehicle. The tyre is too
severely damaged and the tyre
sealant cannot seal the tyre.
If the tyre pressure has not
dropped more than 68 kPa
(10 psi) from the recommended
inflation pressure, inflate the
tyre to the recommended
inflation pressure.
20. Wipe off any sealant from the
wheel, tyre and vehicle.
21. Dispose of the used sealant
canister (5) and sealant/air
hose (6) assembly at a local
dealer or in accordance with
local regulations and practices.
22. Replace with a new canister
assembly available from your
dealer.
23. After temporarily sealing the
tyre using the tyre sealant and
compressor kit, take the
vehicle to an authorised dealer
within 161 km (100 mi) of
driving to have the tyre
repaired or replaced.
Using the Tyre Sealant and
Compressor Kit without
Sealant to Inflate a Tyre (Not
Punctured)
To use the air compressor to inflate
a tyre with air only and not sealant:
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (61,1)
Vehicle Care
If a tyre goes flat, avoid further tyre
and wheel damage by driving slowly
to a level place. Turn on the hazard
warning flashers. See Hazard
Warning Flashers on page 6-7.
10-61
6. Plug the power plug (8) into the
accessory power outlet in the
vehicle. Unplug all items from
other accessory power outlets.
See Power Outlets on page 5-6.
See If a Tyre Goes Flat on
page 10-54 for other important
safety warnings.
If the vehicle has an accessory
power outlet, do not use the
cigarette lighter.
1. Remove the tyre sealant and
compressor kit from its storage
location. See Storing the Tyre
Sealant and Compressor Kit on
page 10-63.
If the vehicle only has a cigarette
lighter, use the cigarette lighter.
2. Unwrap the air only hose (7) and
the power plug (8).
3. Place the kit on the ground.
Make sure the tyre valve stem is
positioned close to the ground
so the hose will reach it.
4. Remove the tyre valve stem cap
from the flat tyre by turning it
anticlockwise.
5. Attach the air only hose (7) onto
the tyre valve stem by turning it
clockwise until it is tight.
Do not pinch the power plug
cord in the door or window.
7. Start the vehicle. The vehicle
must be running while using the
air compressor.
8. Press and turn the selector
switch (1) clockwise to the Air
Only position.
9. Press the on/off (2) button to
turn the compressor on.
The compressor will inflate the
tyre with air only.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-62
Black plate (62,1)
Vehicle Care
10. Inflate the tyre to the
recommended inflation
pressure using the pressure
gauge (3). The recommended
inflation pressure can be found
on the Tyre and Loading
Information label. See Tyre
Pressure on page 10-42.
The pressure gauge (3) may
read higher than the actual tyre
pressure while the compressor
is on. Turn the compressor off
to get an accurate reading. The
compressor may be turned on/
off until the correct pressure is
reached.
If you inflate the tyre higher
than the recommended
pressure you can adjust the
excess pressure by pressing
the pressure deflation
button (4) until the proper
pressure reading is reached.
This option is only functional
when using the air only
hose (7).
11. Press the on/off button (2) to
turn the tyre sealant and
compressor kit off.
Be careful while handling the
tyre sealant and compressor kit
as it could be warm after
usage.
12. Unplug the power plug (8) from
the accessory power outlet in
the vehicle.
13. Disconnect the air only hose
(7) from the tyre valve stem, by
turning it anticlockwise, and
replace the tyre valve
stem cap.
14. Replace the air only hose (7)
and the power plug (8) and
cord back in its original
location.
15. Place the equipment in the
original storage location in the
vehicle.
The tyre sealant and compressor kit
has an accessory adapter located in
a compartment on the bottom of its
housing that may be used to inflate
air mattresses, balls, etc.
Removal and Installation of the
Sealant Canister
To remove the sealant canister:
1. Unwrap the sealant/air hose to
access the canister release
button.
2. Press the canister release
button (9).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (63,1)
Vehicle Care
3. Pull up and remove the canister.
4. Replace with a new canister
which is available from your
dealer.
5. Push the new canister into
place.
6. Rewrap the sealant/air hose.
Storing the Tyre Sealant
and Compressor Kit
in a foam container in the rear
compartment storage area. If the
vehicle has a cargo cover, see
Cargo Management System on
page 4-5 for instructions on how to
access the tyre sealant and
compressor kit.
10-63
3. Wheel Wrench
4. Wing Nut
To access the spare tyre and tools:
1. Open the tailgate. See Tailgate
on page 2-11.
Tyre Changing
Removing the Spare Tyre and
Tools
2. Press on the bottom of the
handle assembly to unlatch it
and lift up on the handle.
The prop rod locks into place
when open.
This vehicle may have a tyre
sealant and compressor kit in place
of a jack or spare tyre. It is located
1. Extension
2. Jack
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-64
Black plate (64,1)
Vehicle Care
Removing the Flat Tyre and
Installing the Spare Tyre
Take off the wheel cover or centre
cap, if the vehicle has one, to reach
the wheel bolts.
1. Do a safety check before
proceeding. See If a Tyre Goes
Flat on page 10-54 for more
information.
3. Remove the spare tyre cover.
5. Remove the nut retaining the
spare tyre.
6. Remove the spare tyre and
place it next to the tyre being
changed.
7. Remove the wing nut.
8. Remove the extension, jack, and
wheel wrench and place them
near the tyre being changed.
4. Remove the rubber cover.
2. Turn the wheel wrench
anticlockwise to loosen and
remove the wheel nut caps.
Do not try to remove plastic caps
from the cover or centre cap.
3. Pull the cover or centre cap
away from the wheel. Store the
wheel cover in the cargo area
until you have the flat tyre
repaired or replaced.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (65,1)
Vehicle Care
4. Turn the wheel wrench
anticlockwise to loosen all the
wheel nuts, but do not remove
them yet.
5. Place the jack near the flat tyre.
{ Caution
Make sure that the jack lift head
is in the correct position or you
may damage your vehicle. The
repairs would not be covered by
your warranty.
6. Position the jack lift head at the
jack location nearest the
flat tyre.
The jacking location is indicated
by a V-shaped notch in the
plastic moulding. The jack must
not be used in any other
position.
10-65
7. Insert the hooked end of the
extension handle through the
jack and the flat end through the
wheel wrench.
{ Warning
Getting under a vehicle when it is
lifted on a jack is dangerous.
If the vehicle slips off the jack,
you could be badly injured or
killed. Never get under a vehicle
when it is supported only by
a jack.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-66
Black plate (66,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Warning
Raising the vehicle with the jack
improperly positioned can
damage the vehicle and even
make the vehicle fall. To help
avoid personal injury and vehicle
damage, be sure to fit the jack lift
head into the proper location
before raising the vehicle.
8. Turn the extension with the
wheel wrench clockwise to raise
the jack lift head until the jack
just fits under the vehicle.
Using a jack to raise the vehicle
without positioning it correctly
could damage your vehicle. When
raising your vehicle on a jack, be
sure to position it correctly under
the frame and avoid contact with
the plastic moulding.
{ Caution
{ Warning
Lifting a vehicle and getting under
it to do maintenance or repairs is
dangerous without the
appropriate safety equipment and
training. If a jack is provided with
the vehicle, it is designed only for
changing a flat tyre. If it is used
for anything else, you or others
could be badly injured or killed if
the vehicle slips off the jack. If a
jack is provided with the vehicle,
only use it for changing a flat tyre.
{ Caution
9. Raise the vehicle by turning the
wheel wrench clockwise until the
slots in the jack head fit into the
metal flange located behind the
triangle on the plastic moulding.
If the doors are locked with the
security system armed, the alarm
will activate when the vehicle is
raised by the jack.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (67,1)
Vehicle Care
10. Put the compact spare tyre
near you.
Warning (Continued)
changing a wheel, remove any
rust or dirt from places where the
wheel attaches to the vehicle. In
an emergency, a cloth or a paper
towel can be used; however, use
a scraper or wire brush later to
remove all rust or dirt.
10-67
13. Place the compact spare tyre
on the wheel-mounting surface.
{ Warning
Never use oil or grease on bolts
or nuts because the nuts might
come loose. The vehicle's wheel
could fall off, causing a crash.
14. Reinstall the wheel nuts.
Tighten each nut by hand until
the wheel is held against
the hub.
15. Lower the vehicle by turning
the jack handle anticlockwise.
Remove all of the wheel nuts.
11. Remove the flat tyre.
{ Warning
{ Warning
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the
parts to which it is fastened, can
make wheel nuts become loose
after time. The wheel could come
off and cause an accident. When
(Continued)
12. Remove any rust or dirt from
the wheel bolts, mounting
surfaces, and spare wheel.
Wheel nuts that are improperly or
incorrectly tightened can cause
the wheels to become loose or
come off. The wheel nuts should
be tightened with a torque wrench
to the proper torque specification
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-68
Black plate (68,1)
Vehicle Care
Warning (Continued)
{ Caution
after replacing. Follow the torque
specification supplied by the
aftermarket manufacturer when
using accessory locking wheel
nuts. See Capacities and
Specifications on page 12-2 for
original equipment wheel nut
torque specifications.
Wheel covers will not fit on the
vehicle's compact spare. If you try
to put a wheel cover on the
compact spare, the cover or the
spare could be damaged.
{ Caution
Improperly tightened wheel nuts
can lead to brake pulsation and
disc damage. To avoid expensive
brake repairs, evenly tighten the
wheel nuts in the proper
sequence and to the proper
torque specification. See
Capacities and Specifications for
the wheel nut torque specification.
Storing a Flat or Spare Tyre
and Tools
16. Tighten the wheel nuts firmly in
a crisscross sequence, as
shown.
17. Lower the jack all the way and
remove the jack from under the
vehicle.
18. Tighten the wheel nuts firmly
with the wheel wrench.
When reinstalling the wheel cover or
centre cap on the full-size tyre,
tighten all five plastic caps hand
snug with the aid of the wheel
wrench and tighten them with the
wheel wrench an additional
one-quarter of a turn.
{ Warning
Storing a jack, a tyre, or other
equipment in the passenger
compartment of the vehicle could
cause injury. In a sudden stop or
collision, loose equipment could
strike someone. Store all these in
the proper place.
To store the flat or spare tyre and
tools:
1. Open the tailgate. See Tailgate
on page 2-11 for more
information.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (69,1)
Vehicle Care
2. Put back all tools as they were
stored in the rear storage
compartment and put the
compartment cover back on. For
more information, see “Storing
the Compact Spare Tyre and
Tools” next in this section.
5. Attach the strap to the cargo
tie-down in the rear of the
vehicle.
10-69
The compact spare is for temporary
use only. Replace the compact
spare tyre with a full-size tyre as
soon as you can.
Compact Spare Tyre
{ Warning
3. Install the cargo cover. For more
information, see Cargo
Management System on
page 4-5.
Driving with more than one
compact spare tyre at a time
could result in loss of braking and
handling. This could lead to a
crash and you or others could be
injured. Use only one compact
spare tyre at a time.
4. Place the tyre, lying flat, in the
rear storage compartment.
6. Route the strap through the
wheel, as shown.
7. Attach the strap to the other
cargo tie-down in the rear of the
vehicle.
8. Tighten the strap.
9. Replace the rubber cover.
If this vehicle has a compact spare
tyre, it was fully inflated when new;
however, it can lose air over time.
Check the inflation pressure
regularly. It should be 420 kPa
(60 psi).
Stop as soon as possible and check
that the spare tyre is correctly
inflated after being installed on the
vehicle. The compact spare tyre is
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-70
Black plate (70,1)
Vehicle Care
designed for temporary use only.
The vehicle will perform differently
with the spare tyre installed and it is
recommended that the vehicle
speed be limited to 80 km/h
(50 mph). To conserve the tread of
the spare tyre, have the standard
tyre repaired or replaced as soon as
convenient and return the spare tyre
to the storage area.
When using a compact spare tyre,
the ABS and Traction Control
systems may engage until the spare
tyre is recognised by the vehicle,
especially on slippery roads. Adjust
driving to reduce possible
wheel slip.
{ Caution
When the compact spare is
installed, do not take the vehicle
through an automatic car wash
with guide rails. The compact
spare can get caught on the rails
(Continued)
Caution (Continued)
which can damage the tyre,
wheel, and other parts of the
vehicle.
Do not use the compact spare on
other vehicles.
Do not mix the compact spare tyre
or wheel with other wheels or tyres.
They will not fit. Keep the spare tyre
and its wheel together.
{ Caution
Tyre chains will not fit the
compact spare. Using them can
damage the vehicle and the
chains. Do not use tyre chains on
the compact spare.
Jump Starting
For more information about the
vehicle battery, see Battery on
page 10-21.
If the vehicle battery has run down,
you may want to use another
vehicle and some jump leads to
start your vehicle. Be sure to use
the following steps to do it safely.
{ Warning
Batteries can hurt you. They can
be dangerous because:
.
They contain acid that can
burn you.
.
They contain gas that can
explode or ignite.
.
They contain enough
electricity to burn you.
If you do not follow these steps
exactly, some or all of these
things can hurt you.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (71,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Caution
Ignoring these steps could result
in costly damage to the vehicle
that would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty. Trying to start
the vehicle by pushing or pulling it
will not work, and it could damage
the vehicle.
Your vehicle is equipped with a
remote positive (+) terminal (1) and
a remote negative (−) terminal (2).
The remote positive (+) terminal is
located in the engine compartment
on the driver side of the vehicle,
above the rear of the battery. The
remote negative (-) terminal is a
stud located in the engine
compartment on the driver side of
the vehicle, on the front tie bar. See
Engine Compartment Overview on
page 10-5.
To uncover the remote positive (+)
terminal, lift open the access panel
on the battery cover indicated by
the (+) sign.
1. Check the other vehicle. It must
have a 12-volt battery with a
negative ground system.
{ Caution
1. Remote Positive (+) Terminal
2. Remote Negative (-) Terminal
If the other vehicle does not have
a 12-volt system with a negative
ground, both vehicles can be
(Continued)
10-71
Caution (Continued)
damaged. Only use a vehicle that
has a 12-volt system with a
negative ground for jump starting.
2. Get the vehicles close enough
so the jump leads can reach, but
be sure the vehicles are not
touching each other. If they are,
it could cause a ground
connection you do not want. You
would not be able to start your
vehicle, and the bad grounding
could damage the electrical
systems.
To avoid the possibility of the
vehicles rolling, apply the
parking brake firmly on both
vehicles involved in the jump
start procedure. Put the
transmission in P (Park) before
applying the parking brake.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-72
Black plate (72,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Caution
If any accessories are left on or
plugged in during the jump
starting procedure, they could be
damaged. The repairs would not
be covered by the vehicle
warranty. Whenever possible, turn
off or unplug all accessories on
either vehicle when jump starting.
3. Turn off the ignition on both
vehicles. Unplug unnecessary
accessories plugged into the
cigarette lighter or the accessory
power outlet. Turn off the radio
and all lamps that are not
needed. This will avoid sparks,
helping save both batteries and
the radio.
4. Open the hood on the other
vehicle and locate the
positive (+) and negative (-)
terminal locations on that
vehicle.
Open the bonnet on your vehicle
and find the remote positive (+)
and remote negative (-) jump
starting terminals.
{ Warning
An electric fan can start up even
when the engine is not running
and can injure you. Keep hands,
clothing and tools away from any
underbonnet electric fan.
{ Warning
Using an open flame near a
battery can cause battery gas to
explode. People have been hurt
(Continued)
Warning (Continued)
doing this, and some have been
blinded. Use a torch if you need
more light.
Be sure the battery has enough
water. You do not need to add
water to the battery installed in
your new vehicle. But if a battery
has filler caps, be sure the right
amount of fluid is there. If it is low,
add water to take care of that
first. If you do not, explosive gas
could be present.
Battery fluid contains acid that
can burn you. Do not get it on
you. If you accidentally get it in
your eyes or on your skin, flush
the place with water and get
medical help immediately.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (73,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Warning
Fans or other moving engine
parts can injure you badly. Keep
your hands away from moving
parts once the engine is running.
5. Check that the jump leads do
not have loose or missing
insulation. If they do, you could
get a shock. The vehicles could
also be damaged.
Before you connect the cables,
here are some basic things you
should know. Positive (+) will go
to positive (+) or to a remote
positive (+) terminal if the
vehicle has one. Negative (-) will
go to a heavy, unpainted metal
engine part or to a remote
negative (-) terminal if the
vehicle has one.
Do not connect positive (+) to
negative (-) or you will get a
short that would damage the
battery and maybe other parts.
Do not connect the negative (-)
cable to the negative (-) terminal
on the dead battery because this
can cause sparks.
6. Connect the red positive (+)
cable to the positive (+) terminal
on the vehicle with the dead
battery. Use a remote
positive (+) terminal if the
vehicle has one.
7. Do not let the other end touch
metal. Connect it to the
positive (+) terminal of the good
battery. Use a remote
positive (+) terminal if the
vehicle has one.
8. Now connect the black
negative (-) cable to the
negative (-) terminal of the good
battery. Use a remote
negative (-) terminal if the
vehicle has one.
Do not let the other end touch
anything until the next step. The
other end of the negative (-)
cable does not go to the dead
battery. It goes to a heavy,
10-73
unpainted metal engine part or
to a remote negative (-) terminal
on the vehicle with the dead
battery.
9. Connect the other end of the
negative (-) cable away from the
dead battery, but not near
engine parts that move. The
electrical connection is just as
good there, and the chance of
sparks getting back to the
battery is much less.
Your vehicle has a remote (-)
terminal for this purpose.
10. Now start the vehicle with the
good battery and run the
engine for a while.
11. Try to start the vehicle that had
the dead battery. If it will not
start after a few tries, it
probably needs service.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-74
Black plate (74,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Caution
If the jump leads are connected
or removed in the wrong order,
electrical shorting may occur and
damage the vehicle. The repairs
would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty. Always connect
and remove the jump leads in the
correct order, making sure that
the cables do not touch each
other or other metal.
Jump Lead Removal
Reverse the sequence exactly when
removing the jump leads.
Towing the Vehicle
{ Caution
Incorrectly towing a disabled
vehicle may cause damage. The
damage would not be covered by
the vehicle warranty. Do not lash
or hook to the chassis
components — including the front
and rear subframes, suspension
control arms, and links — during
towing and recovery of a disabled
vehicle, or when securing the
vehicle. Use the proper nylon
strap harnesses around the tyres
to secure the vehicle.
{ Caution
Improper use of the tow eye can
cause vehicle damage. Use
caution and low speeds to
prevent damage to the vehicle.
Front Tow Eye
Have the vehicle towed on a flatbed
car carrier. A wheel lift tow truck
could damage the vehicle.
Consult your dealer or a
professional towing service if the
disabled vehicle must be towed.
Carefully open the cover by using
the small notch that conceals the
front tow eye socket.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (75,1)
Vehicle Care
10-75
Rear Tow Eye
Install the tow eye into the socket by
turning it clockwise until it stops in a
horizontal position.
When the tow eye is removed,
reinstall the cover with the notch in
the original position.
Carefully open the cover by using
the small notch that conceals the
rear tow eye socket.
Install the tow eye into the socket by
turning it clockwise until it stops in a
horizontal position.
When the tow eye is removed,
reinstall the cover with the notch in
the original position.
To tow the vehicle behind another
vehicle for recreational purposes,
such as behind a motor home, see
“Recreational Vehicle Towing” in this
section.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-76
Vehicle Care
Recreational Vehicle
Towing
Recreational vehicle towing means
towing the vehicle behind another
vehicle - such as behind a motor
home. The two most common types
of recreational vehicle towing are
known as dinghy towing and dolly
towing. Dinghy towing is towing the
vehicle with all four wheels on the
ground. Dolly towing is towing the
vehicle with two wheels on the
ground and two wheels up on a
device known as a dolly.
Here are some important things to
consider before recreational vehicle
towing:
.
.
Black plate (76,1)
What is the towing capacity of
the towing vehicle? Be sure to
read the tow vehicle
manufacturer's
recommendations.
What is the distance that will be
travelled? Some vehicles have
restrictions on how far and how
long they can tow.
.
Is the proper towing equipment
going to be used? See your
dealer or trailering professional
for additional advice and
equipment recommendations.
.
Is the vehicle ready to be
towed? Just as preparing the
vehicle for a long trip, make sure
the vehicle is prepared to be
towed.
Dinghy Towing
The vehicle may be dinghy towed
from the front. The vehicle can also
be towed on a platform trailer with
all four wheels off of the ground.
For vehicles being dinghy towed,
the vehicle should be run at the
beginning of each day and at each
RV fuel stop for about five minutes.
This will ensure proper lubrication of
transmission components.
To tow the vehicle from the front
with all four wheels on the ground:
1. Position the vehicle that will be
towed and secure it to the
towing vehicle.
2. Open the drivers door.
3. With the vehicle OFF, press the
brake pedal and press the
START/STOP switch to start the
engine (the green indicator light
on the switch will illuminate).
4. Put the vehicle in N (Neutral).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (77,1)
Vehicle Care
5. Press the START/STOP switch
again. The engine will stop, the
DIC will display Shift to Park and
the amber indicator light on the
switch illuminates. See
Transmission Messages on
page 5-37.
6. Remove the following fuses:
ESCL, BCM 1, BCM 2 and BCM
3. The START/STOP switch
indicator lights will be off. See
Instrument Panel Fuse Block on
page 10-35.
7. Close the drivers door.
{ Caution
If the vehicle is towed without
performing each of the steps
listed under “Dinghy Towing,” the
automatic transmission could be
damaged. Be sure to follow all
steps of the dinghy towing
procedure prior to and after
towing the vehicle.
10-77
{ Caution
{ Caution
If 105 km/h (65 mph) is exceeded
while towing the vehicle, it could
be damaged. Never exceed
105 km/h (65 mph) while towing
the vehicle.
Too much or too little fluid can
damage the transmission. Be
sure that the transmission fluid is
at the proper level before towing
with all four wheels on the
ground.
Once the destination has been
reached:
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. Reinstall the fuses. See
Instrument Panel Fuse Block on
page 10-35.
3. Shift the transmission to
P (Park).
4. Place the ignition position to
LOCK/OFF.
{ Caution
Do not tow a vehicle with the front
drive wheels on the ground if one
of the front tyres is a compact
spare tyre. Towing with two
different tyre sizes on the front of
the vehicle can cause severe
damage to the transmission.
5. Disconnect the vehicle from the
tow vehicle.
Dolly Towing
6. Start the engine and let it idle for
more than three minutes before
driving the vehicle.
The vehicle should not be towed
with two wheels on the ground. To
properly tow the vehicle, it should
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-78
Black plate (78,1)
Vehicle Care
be placed on a platform trailer with
all four wheels off of the ground or
dinghy towed from the front.
Appearance Care
Exterior Care
Towing the Vehicle From
the Rear
Locks
Locks are lubricated at the factory.
Use a de-icing agent only when
absolutely necessary, and have the
locks greased after using. See
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants on page 11-5.
{ Caution
Towing the vehicle from the rear
could damage it. Also, repairs
would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty. Never have the
vehicle towed from the rear.
Washing the Vehicle
To preserve the vehicle's finish,
wash it often and out of direct
sunlight.
{ Caution
Do not use petroleum-based,
acidic, or abrasive cleaning
agents as they can damage the
vehicle's paint, metal, or plastic
parts. If damage occurs, it would
not be covered by the vehicle
warranty. Approved cleaning
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (79,1)
Vehicle Care
Caution (Continued)
products can be obtained from
your dealer. Follow all
manufacturer directions regarding
correct product usage, necessary
safety precautions, and
appropriate disposal of any
vehicle care product.
{ Caution
Avoid using high-pressure
washers closer than 30 cm (12 in)
to the surface of the vehicle. Use
of power washers exceeding
8,274 kPa (1,200 psi) can result
in damage or removal of paint
and decals.
The e symbol is on any
underbonnet compartment electrical
centre that should not be power
washed. This could cause damage
that would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty.
If using an automatic car wash,
follow the car wash instructions. The
windscreen wiper and rear window
wiper, if equipped, must be off.
Remove any accessories that may
be damaged or interfere with the car
wash equipment.
Rinse the vehicle well, before
washing and after, to remove all
cleaning agents completely. If they
are allowed to dry on the surface,
they could stain.
Dry the finish with a soft, clean
chamois or an all-cotton towel to
avoid surface scratches and water
spotting.
10-79
Finish Care
Application of aftermarket clearcoat
sealant/wax materials is not
recommended. If painted surfaces
are damaged, see your dealer to
have the damage assessed and
repaired. Foreign materials such as
calcium chloride and other salts, ice
melting agents, road oil and tar, tree
sap, bird droppings, chemicals from
industrial chimneys, etc., can
damage the vehicle's finish if they
remain on painted surfaces. Wash
the vehicle as soon as possible.
If necessary, use non-abrasive
cleaners that are marked safe for
painted surfaces to remove foreign
matter.
Occasional hand waxing or mild
polishing should be done to remove
residue from the paint finish. See
your dealer for approved cleaning
products.
Do not apply waxes or polishes to
uncoated plastic, vinyl, rubber,
decals, simulated wood, or flat paint
as damage can occur.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-80
Black plate (80,1)
Vehicle Care
{ Caution
Machine compounding or
aggressive polishing on a base
coat/clear coat paint finish may
damage it. Use only non-abrasive
waxes and polishes that are
made for a base coat/clear coat
paint finish on the vehicle.
To keep the paint finish looking new,
keep the vehicle garaged or
covered whenever possible.
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal
Mouldings
{ Caution
Failure to clean and protect the
bright metal mouldings can result
in a hazy white finish or pitting.
This damage would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty.
The bright metal mouldings on the
vehicle are aluminium. To prevent
damage always follow these
cleaning instructions:
.
Be sure the moulding is cool to
the touch before applying any
cleaning solution.
.
Use a cleaning solution
approved for aluminium. Some
cleaners are highly acidic or
contain alkaline substances and
can damage the mouldings.
.
Always dilute a concentrated
cleaner according to the
manufacturer's instructions.
.
Do not use chrome cleaners.
.
Do not use cleaners that are not
intended for automotive use.
.
Use a nonabrasive wax on the
vehicle after washing to protect
and extend the moulding finish.
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/
Lenses, Emblems, Decals and
Stripes
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a
soft cloth and a car washing soap to
clean exterior lamps, lenses and
emblems. Follow instructions under
"Washing the Vehicle" previously in
this section.
Lamp covers are made of plastic,
and some have a UV protective
coating.
Use only lukewarm water, a soft
cloth, and mild car washing soap to
clean exterior lamps and lenses. Do
not clean or wipe them while they
are dry.
Do not use any of the following on
lamp covers:
.
Abrasive or caustic agents.
.
Washer fluids and other cleaning
agents in higher concentrations
than suggested by the
manufacturer.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (81,1)
Vehicle Care
.
Solvents, alcohols, fuels,
or other harsh cleaners.
.
Ice scrapers or other hard items.
.
Aftermarket appearance caps or
covers while the lamps are
illuminated, due to excessive
heat generated.
{ Caution
Failure to clean lamps properly
can cause damage to the lamp
cover that would not be covered
by the vehicle warranty.
{ Caution
Using wax on low gloss black
finish stripes can increase the
gloss level and create a
non-uniform finish. Clean low
gloss stripes with soap and
water only.
10-81
Air Intakes
Weatherstrips
Clear debris from the air intakes,
between the bonnet and windscreen
when washing the vehicle.
Apply Dielectric silicone grease on
weatherstrips to make them last
longer, seal better, and not stick or
squeak. Lubricate weatherstrips at
least once a year. Hot, dry climates
may require more frequent
application. Black marks from
rubber material on painted surfaces
can be removed by rubbing with a
clean cloth. See Recommended
Fluids and Lubricants on page 11-5.
Windscreen and Wiper Blades
Clean the outside of the windscreen
with glass cleaner.
Clean rubber blades using a lint-free
cloth or paper towel soaked with
windscreen washer fluid or a mild
detergent. Wash the windscreen
thoroughly when cleaning the
blades. Insects, road grime, sap,
and a build-up of vehicle wash/wax
treatments may cause wiper
streaking.
Replace the wiper blades if they are
worn or damaged. Damage can be
caused by extreme dusty
conditions, sand, salt, heat, sun,
snow, and ice.
Tyres
Use a stiff brush with tyre cleaner to
clean the tyres.
{ Caution
Using petroleum-based tyre
dressing products on the vehicle
may damage the paint finish and/
or tyres. When applying a tyre
dressing, always wipe off any
overspray from all painted
surfaces on the vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-82
Black plate (82,1)
Vehicle Care
Wheels and Trim - Aluminium
or Chrome
Use a soft, clean cloth with mild
soap and water to clean the wheels.
After rinsing thoroughly with clean
water, dry with a soft, clean towel.
A wax may then be applied.
{ Caution
Chrome wheels and other chrome
trim may be damaged if the
vehicle is not washed after driving
on roads that have been sprayed
with magnesium, calcium,
or sodium chloride. These
chlorides are used on roads for
conditions such as ice and dust.
Always wash the chrome with
soap and water after exposure.
{ Caution
To avoid surface damage, do not
use strong soaps, chemicals,
abrasive polishes, cleaners,
brushes, or cleaners that contain
acid on aluminium or
chrome-plated wheels. Use only
approved cleaners. Also, never
drive a vehicle with aluminium or
chrome-plated wheels through an
automatic car wash that uses
silicone carbide tyre cleaning
brushes. Damage could occur
and the repairs would not be
covered by the vehicle warranty.
Steering, Suspension, and
Chassis Components
Visually inspect the front and rear
suspension and steering system for
damaged, loose, or missing parts or
signs of wear. If equipped, inspect
the hydraulic power steering for
proper hook-up, binding, leaks,
cracks, chafing, etc. Visually check
constant velocity joints, rubber
boots, and axle seals for leaks.
Body Component Lubrication
Lubricate all key lock cylinders,
bonnet hinges, tailgate hinges, and
the fuel door hinge unless the
components are plastic. Applying
silicone grease on weatherstrips
with a clean cloth will make them
last longer, seal better, and not stick
or squeak.
Underbody Maintenance
At least twice a year, Spring and
Autumn, use plain water to flush dirt
and debris from the vehicle's
underbody. Your dealer or an
underbody car washing system can
do this. If not removed, rust and
corrosion can develop.
Sheet Metal Damage
If the vehicle is damaged and
requires sheet metal repair or
replacement, make sure the body
repair shop applies anti-corrosion
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (83,1)
Vehicle Care
material to parts repaired or
replaced to restore corrosion
protection.
Original manufacturer replacement
parts will provide the corrosion
protection while maintaining the
vehicle warranty.
Finish Damage
Quickly repair minor chips and
scratches with touch-up materials
available from your dealer to avoid
corrosion. Larger areas of finish
damage can be corrected in your
dealer's body and paint shop.
Chemical Paint Spotting
Airborne pollutants can fall upon
and attack painted vehicle surfaces
causing blotchy, ring-shaped
discolourations, and small, irregular
dark spots etched into the paint
surface. See “Finish Care”
previously in this section.
Interior Care
To prevent dirt particle abrasions,
regularly clean the vehicle's interior.
Immediately remove any soiling.
Note that newspapers or dark
garments that can transfer colour to
home furnishings can also
permanently transfer colour to the
vehicle's interior.
Use a soft bristle brush to remove
dust from knobs and crevices on the
instrument cluster. Using a mild
soap solution, immediately remove
hand lotions, sunscreen, and insect
repellent from all interior surfaces or
permanent damage may result.
Your dealer may have products for
cleaning the interior. Use cleaners
specifically designed for the
surfaces being cleaned to prevent
permanent damage. Apply all
cleaners directly to the cleaning
cloth. Do not spray cleaners directly
on any switches or controls.
Cleaners should be removed
quickly. Never allow cleaners to
10-83
remain on the surface being
cleaned for extended periods
of time.
Cleaners may contain solvents that
can become concentrated in the
interior. Before using cleaners, read
and adhere to all safety instructions
on the label. While cleaning the
interior, maintain adequate
ventilation by opening the doors and
windows.
To prevent damage, do not clean
the interior using the following
cleaners or techniques:
.
Never use a razor or any other
sharp object to remove a soil
from any interior surface.
.
Never use a brush with stiff
bristles.
.
Never rub any surface
aggressively or with excessive
pressure.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-84
.
Black plate (84,1)
Vehicle Care
Do not use laundry detergents or
dishwashing soaps with
degreasers. For liquid cleaners,
use approximately 20 drops per
3.8 L (1 gal) of water.
A concentrated soap solution will
leave a residue that creates
streaks and attracts dirt. Do not
use solutions that contain strong
or caustic soap.
.
Do not heavily saturate the
upholstery when cleaning.
.
Do not use solvents or cleaners
containing solvents.
Interior Glass
To clean, use a terry cloth fabric
dampened with water. Wipe droplets
left behind with a clean dry cloth.
Commercial glass cleaners may be
used, if necessary, after cleaning
the interior glass with plain water.
{ Caution
To prevent scratching, never use
abrasive cleaners on automotive
glass. Abrasive cleaners or
aggressive cleaning may damage
the rear window defogger.
Cleaning the windscreen with water
during the first three to six months
of ownership will reduce tendency
to fog.
.
Fabric/Carpet/Suede
Start by vacuuming the surface
using a soft brush attachment. If a
rotating brush attachment is being
used during vacuuming, only use it
on the floor carpet. Before cleaning,
gently remove as much of the soil
as possible using one of the
following techniques:
.
Gently blot liquids with a paper
towel. Continue blotting until no
more soil can be removed.
.
For solid soil, remove as much
as possible prior to vacuuming.
Speaker Covers
Vacuum around a speaker cover
gently, so that the speaker will not
be damaged. Clean spots with just
water and mild soap.
Coated Mouldings
Coated mouldings should be
cleaned.
.
When lightly soiled, wipe with a
sponge or soft lint-free cloth
dampened with water.
When heavily soiled, use warm
soapy water.
To clean:
1. Saturate a clean lint-free
colourfast cloth with water.
Microfiber cloth is recommended
to prevent lint transfer to the
fabric or carpet.
2. Remove excess moisture by
gently wringing until water does
not drip from the cleaning cloth.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (85,1)
Vehicle Care
3. Start on the outside edge of the
soil and gently rub toward the
centre. Fold the cleaning cloth to
a clean area frequently to
prevent forcing the soil in to the
fabric.
4. Continue gently rubbing the
soiled area until there is no
longer any colour transfer from
the soil to the cleaning cloth.
5. If the soil is not completely
removed, use a mild soap
solution followed only by plain
water.
If the soil is not completely
removed, it may be necessary to
use a commercial upholstery
cleaner or spot lifter. Test a small
hidden area for colourfastness
before using a commercial
upholstery cleaner or spot lifter.
If ring formation occurs, clean the
entire fabric or carpet.
Following the cleaning process, a
paper towel can be used to blot
excess moisture.
Cleaning High Gloss Surfaces
and Vehicle Information and
Radio Displays
For vehicles with high gloss
surfaces or vehicle displays, use a
microfibre cloth to wipe surfaces.
Before wiping the surface with the
microfibre cloth, use a soft bristle
brush to remove dirt that could
scratch the surface. Then use the
microfibre cloth by gently rubbing to
clean. Never use window cleaners
or solvents. Periodically hand wash
the microfibre cloth separately,
using mild soap. Do not use bleach
or fabric softener. Rinse thoroughly
and air dry before next use.
{ Caution
Do not attach a device with a
suction cup to the display. This
may cause damage and would
not be covered by the warranty.
10-85
Instrument Panel, Leather,
Vinyl, Other Plastic Surfaces,
Low Gloss Paint Surfaces and
Natural Open Pore Wood
Surfaces
Use a soft microfiber cloth
dampened with water to remove
dust and loose dirt. For a more
thorough cleaning, use a soft
microfiber cloth dampened with a
mild soap solution.
{ Caution
Soaking or saturating leather,
especially perforated leather, as
well as other interior surfaces,
may cause permanent damage.
Wipe excess moisture from these
surfaces after cleaning and allow
them to dry naturally. Never use
heat, steam, spot lifters, or spot
removers. Do not use cleaners
that contain silicone or wax-based
products. Cleaners containing
(Continued)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-86
Black plate (86,1)
Vehicle Care
Caution (Continued)
these solvents can permanently
change the appearance and feel
of leather or soft trim and are not
recommended.
Cargo Cover and
Convenience Net
Floor Mats
{ Warning
Wash with warm water and mild
detergent. Do not use chlorine
bleach. Rinse with cold water, and
then dry completely.
If a floor mat is the wrong size or
is not properly installed, it can
interfere with the pedals.
Interference with the pedals can
cause unintended acceleration
and/or increased stopping
distance which can cause a crash
and injury. Make sure the floor
mat does not interfere with the
pedals.
Care of Safety Belts
Do not use cleaners that increase
gloss, especially on the instrument
panel. Reflected glare can decrease
visibility through the windshield
under certain conditions.
{ Caution
Use of air fresheners may cause
permanent damage to plastics
and painted surfaces. If an air
freshener comes in contact with
any plastic or painted surface in
the vehicle, blot immediately and
clean with a soft cloth dampened
with a mild soap solution.
Damage caused by air fresheners
would not be covered by the
vehicle warranty.
Keep belts clean and dry.
{ Warning
Do not bleach or dye safety belts.
It may severely weaken them. In
a crash, they might not be able to
provide adequate protection.
Clean safety belts only with mild
soap and lukewarm water.
Use the following guidelines for
proper floor mat usage.
.
The original equipment floor
mats were designed for your
vehicle. If the floor mats need
replacing, it is recommended
that certified floor mats be
purchased. Non-certified floor
mats may not fit properly and
may interfere with the pedals.
Always check that the floor mats
do not interfere with the pedals.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (87,1)
Vehicle Care
.
Use the floor mat with the
correct side up. Do not turn
it over.
.
Do not place anything on top of
the driver side floor mat.
.
Use only a single floor mat on
the driver side.
.
Do not place one floor mat on
top of another.
Removing and Replacing the
Floor Mats
The driver side floor mat is held in
place by two button-type retainers.
The passenger side floor mat is held
in place by one button-type retainer.
1. Pull up on the rear of the floor
mat to unlock each retainer and
remove.
2. Reinstall by lining up the floor
mat retainer openings over the
carpet retainers and snapping
into position.
3. Make sure the floor mat is
properly secured and verify that
it does not interfere with the
pedals.
10-87
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
10-88
Vehicle Care
2 NOTES
Black plate (88,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Service and Maintenance
Service and
Maintenance
General Information
General Information . . . . . . . . . . 11-1
Scheduled Maintenance
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . 11-1
Recommended Fluids,
Lubricants, and Parts
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5
Maintenance Replacement
Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
Maintenance Records
Maintenance Records . . . . . . . . 11-7
General Information
It is essential that your vehicle
receives the maintenance outlined
on the following pages to retain the
safety, reliability and performance
originally built into your vehicle.
When your odometer reaches the
mileage indicated on the following
pages, or the corresponding time
interval has been reached, take
your vehicle, preferably to an
authorised dealer and/or repairer,
who will provide the proper parts
and service.
Once maintenance has been
performed, have the authorised
dealer and/or repairer fill out and
stamp the appropriate box in this
booklet to serve as your
maintenance record which may be
needed for warranty repairs. It will
also show future owners how well
your vehicle has been maintained.
11-1
Scheduled
Maintenance
Engine Oil Change
When the CHANGE ENGINE OIL
SOON message displays, have the
engine oil and filter changed within
the next 1 000 km/600 mi. If driven
under the best conditions, the
engine oil life system might not
indicate the need for vehicle service
for more than a year. The engine oil
and filter must be changed at least
once a year and the oil life system
must be reset. Your trained dealer
technician can perform this work.
If the engine oil life system is reset
accidentally, service the vehicle
within 5 000 km/3,000 mi since the
last service. Reset the oil life
system when the oil is changed.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
11-2
Black plate (2,1)
Service and Maintenance
Inspection Every 15 000 km or
1 Year
.
Change engine oil and filter.
Reset oil life system.
.
Engine coolant level check.
.
Engine cooling system
inspection. Visual inspection of
hoses, pipes, fittings, and
clamps and replacement,
if needed.
.
Windscreen washer fluid level
check.
.
Windscreen washer fluid level
check.
.
Windscreen wiper blade
inspection for wear, cracking,
or contamination and
windscreen and wiper blade
cleaning, if contaminated. Worn
or damaged wiper blade
replacement.
.
Tyre inflation pressures check.
.
Tyre wear inspection.
.
Fluids visual leak check. A leak
in any system must be repaired
and the fluid level checked.
.
Engine air cleaner filter
inspection.
.
Brake system inspection.
.
Steering and suspension
inspection. Visual inspection for
damaged, loose, or missing
parts or signs of wear.
.
.
Body hinges and latches, key
lock cylinders, folding seat
hardware, and rear
compartment, bonnet, and
console door hinges and latches
lubrication. More frequent
lubrication may be required
when the vehicle is exposed to a
corrosive environment. Applying
silicone grease on weatherstrips
with a clean cloth makes them
last longer, seal better, and not
stick or squeak.
Restraint system component
check.
.
Fuel system inspection for
damage or leaks.
.
Exhaust system and nearby heat
shields inspection for loose or
damaged components.
.
Accelerator pedal check for
damage, high effort, or binding.
.
Bonnet/Deck lid/Tailgate/Lift
glass Support Gas Strut Service:
Visually inspect gas strut,
if equipped, for signs of wear,
cracks, or other damage. Check
the hold open ability of the gas
strut. Contact your authorised
repairer if service is required.
.
Road Test. Check all systems for
correct function/performance.
.
To maintain air conditioning
efficiency, have an authorised
repairer check the system at
least once each year.
.
Automatic transmission shift lock
control function check.
.
Parking brake and automatic
P (Park) mechanism check.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Service and Maintenance
.
Underbody flushing service.
.
Tyre sealant and compressor kit
(if equipped with tyre sealant
and compressor kit), check
sealant expiration date.
Additional Maintenance Every
30 000 km or 2 Years
In addition to the items listed under
“Inspection every 15 000 km or
1 year” the following items should
be carried out every 30 000 km or
2 years (whichever occurs first):
.
Passenger compartment air filter
— replace (if applicable).
.
Engine Air Filter Replacement.
.
All-wheel-drive vehicles only:
During any maintenance, if a
power washer is used to clean
mud and dirt from the
underbody, care should be taken
to not directly spray the transfer
case output seals. High pressure
water can overcome the seals
and contaminate the transfer
case fluid. Contaminated fluid
Check to be sure vent hose is
unobstructed, clear, and free of
debris. During any maintenance,
if a power washer is used to
clean mud and dirt from the
underbody, care should be taken
to not directly spray the transfer
case output seals. High pressure
water can overcome the seals
and contaminate the transfer
case fluid. Contaminated fluid
will decrease the life of the
transfer case and should be
replaced.
will decrease the life of the
transfer case and should be
replaced.
.
Automatic transmission fluid
change (severe service) for
vehicles mainly driven in heavy
city traffic in hot weather, in hilly
or mountainous terrain, when
frequently towing a trailer,
or used for taxi, police,
or delivery service.
Replace Every 2 Years
Replace brake fluid every 2 years.
Note: All vehicles with rear-wheel
drive — change driveline axle oil
every 30 000 km, if vehicle is used
for towing purposes.
Additional Maintenance Every
150 000 km or if Necessary
.
Spark plugs — replace
.
Automatic transmission fluid and
filter change
.
Four-wheel drive only: Check
vent hose at transfer case for
kinks and proper installation.
11-3
Additional Maintenance Every
250 000 km or Every Five
Years, Whichever Occurs First
.
Engine cooling system drain and
refill (or every five years,
whichever occurs first).
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
11-4
Service and Maintenance
Conditions Requiring More
Frequent Maintenance (Severe
Service)
.
Extreme temperatures
.
Heavy city traffic
.
Hilly or mountainous terrain
.
Dusty, muddy or off-road
conditions
.
Commercial use or trailer towing
.
Most trips less than 6 km
Note: All vehicles with rear-wheel
drive — change driveline axle oil
every 30 000 km, if vehicle is used
for towing purposes.
Black plate (4,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
Service and Maintenance
11-5
Recommended Fluids, Lubricants, and Parts
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants
Usage
Fluid/Lubricant
Engine Oil
Use only engine oil licensed to the dexos2 specification of the proper SAE
viscosity grade. ACDelco dexos2 Synthetic Blend is recommended. See
Engine Oil on page 10-6.
Engine Coolant
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and use only DEX-COOL Coolant.
See Engine Coolant on page 10-12.
Fuel Additive
Hydraulic Brake System
Windscreen Washer
Fuel System Treatment PLUS (Part No. 88861013).
DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid (GM Part No. 19299818).
Automotive windscreen washer fluid that meets regional freeze protection
requirements.
Hydraulic Power Steering System
DEXRON®-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid.
Automatic Transmission
DEXRON®-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid.
Chassis Lubrication
Chassis Lubricant (GM Part No. 12377985) or lubricant meeting
requirements of NLGI #2, Category LB or GC-LB.
Key Lock Cylinders
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. 12346241).
Bonnet Latch Assembly, Secondary
Latch, Pivots, Spring Anchor and
Release Pawl
Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol (GM Part No. 89021668) or lubricant meeting
requirements of NLGI #2, Category LB or GC-LB.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
11-6
Black plate (6,1)
Service and Maintenance
Usage
Fluid/Lubricant
Bonnet, Door, and Folding Seat
Hinges
Power Tailgate Actuator Ball Joint
Weatherstrip Conditioning
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. 12346241).
Multi-Purpose Lubricant (GM Part No. 89021668).
Weatherstrip Lubricant (GM Part No. 3634770) or Dielectric Silicone
Grease (GM Part No. 12345579).
Maintenance Replacement Parts
Replacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer.
GM Part Number
ACDelco Part Number
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter
Part
20897358
A3147C
Engine Oil Filter
89017525
PF63
Passenger Compartment Air Filter Element
13271191
CF176
Spark Plugs
12622561
41-109
Driver Side - 65.0 cm (25.6 in)
22870539
-
Passenger Side - 42.5 cm (16.7 in)
22870540
-
Rear - 30.0 cm (11.8 in)
20825882
-
Wiper Blades
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
Service and Maintenance
11-7
Maintenance Records
After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the
type of services performed in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts.
Date
Odometer
Reading
Serviced By
Maintenance Stamp
Services Performed
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
11-8
Date
Black plate (8,1)
Service and Maintenance
Odometer
Reading
Serviced By
Maintenance Stamp
Services Performed
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Technical Data
Technical Data
Vehicle Identification
Vehicle Identification
Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN)
Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1
Engine Identification . . . . . . . . . 12-1
Service Parts Identification
Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1
Vehicle Data
12-1
Engine Identification
The eighth character in the VIN is
the engine code. This code
identifies the vehicle's engine,
specifications, and replacement
parts. See “Engine Specifications”
under Capacities and Specifications
on page 12-2 for the vehicle's
engine code.
Service Parts
Identification Label
Capacities and
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2
Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . 12-4
This label, on the inside of the rear
side cargo management cover, has
the following information:
This legal identifier is in the front
corner of the instrument panel, on
the left side of the vehicle. It can be
seen through the windscreen from
outside. The VIN also appears on
the Vehicle Certification and Service
Parts labels and certificates of title
and registration.
.
Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN).
.
Model designation.
.
Paint information.
.
Production options and special
equipment.
Do not remove this label from the
vehicle.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
12-2
Black plate (2,1)
Technical Data
Vehicle Data
Capacities and Specifications
Capacities
Application
Metric
Air Conditioning Refrigerant
English
For the air conditioning system refrigerant type and
charge amount, see the refrigerant label under the
bonnet. See your dealer for more information.
Engine Cooling System
3.6L V6 Engine
12.8 L
13.5 qt
Engine Oil with Filter
5.7 L
6.0 qt
Fuel Tank
79.5 L
21.0 gal
190 Y
140 lb ft
Wheel Nut Torque
All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in this
manual. Recheck fluid level after filling.
Engine Specifications
Engine
3.6L V6 (LFX)
VIN Code
Horsepower
Torque
Spark Plug Gap
3
230 kW (308 hp)@
6800 min -1
359 Y (265 lb ft)
@2400 min -1
0.95–1.10 mm (0.037–
0.043 in)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
Technical Data
Fuel Consumption and Emissions Information
Equivalent
Inertia Mass
Carbon Dioxide
(g/km)
Fuel Economy
(L/100 km)
Urban
Extra-Urban
Combined
Normal Mode
2040 kg (4500 lb)
378
200
268
ECO Mode 2040 kg
(4500 lb)
350
191
252
Normal Mode
2040 kg (4500 lb)
16.3
8.6
11.5
ECO Mode 2040 kg
(4500 lb)
15.1
8.2
10.8
12-3
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
12-4
Technical Data
Engine Drive Belt Routing
Black plate (4,1)
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
Customer Information
Customer
Information
Customer Information
Declaration of Conformity . . . . 13-1
Vehicle Data Recording and
Privacy
Vehicle Data Recording and
Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-1
Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . 13-2
Radio Frequency
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . 13-2
Customer Information
Declaration of Conformity
This vehicle has systems that
transmit and/or receive radio waves
subject to Directive 1999/5/EC.
These systems are in compliance
with the essential requirements and
other relevant provisions of
Directive 1999/5/EC. Copies of the
original Declarations of Conformity
can be obtained on our website.
13-1
Vehicle Data
Recording and
Privacy
Event Data Recorders
Data Storage Modules in the
Vehicle
A large number of electronic
components of your vehicle contain
data storage modules temporarily or
permanently storing technical data
about the condition of the vehicle,
events, and errors. In general, this
technical information documents the
condition of parts, modules,
systems, or the environment:
.
Operating conditions of system
components (e.g., filling levels).
.
Status messages of the vehicle
and its single components (e.g.,
number of wheel revolutions/
rotational speed, deceleration,
lateral acceleration).
.
Dysfunctions and defects in
important system components.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-Europe-6882117) - 2014 crc - 8/7/13
13-2
Black plate (2,1)
Customer Information
.
Vehicle reactions in particular
driving situations (e.g., inflation
of an airbag, activation of the
stability regulation system).
.
Environmental concerns (e.g.,
temperature).
This data is exclusively technical
and helps identify and correct errors
as well as optimise vehicle
functions.
Motion profiles indicating travelled
routes cannot be created with
this data.
If services are used (e.g., repair
works, service processes, warranty
cases, quality assurance),
employees of the service network
(manufacturer included) are able to
read out this technical information
from the event and error data
storage modules applying special
diagnostic devices. If required, you
will receive further information at
these dealers. After an error has
been corrected, the data is deleted
from the error storage module or
constantly overwritten.
When using the vehicle, situations
may occur in which this technical
data related to other information
(accident report, damages on the
vehicle, witness statements, etc.)
may be associated with a specific
person — possibly, with the
assistance of an expert.
Additional functions contractually
agreed upon with the client (e.g.,
vehicle location in emergency
cases) allow the transmission of
particular vehicle data from the
vehicle.
Infotainment System
If the vehicle is equipped with a
navigation system as part of the
infotainment system, use of the
system may result in the storage of
destinations, addresses, telephone
numbers, and other trip information.
See the infotainment manual for
information on stored data and for
deletion instructions.
Radio Frequency
Identification (RFID)
Radio Frequency Identification
(RFID) technology is used in some
vehicles for functions such as tyre
pressure monitoring and ignition
system security. It is also used in
connection with conveniences such
as Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
transmitters for remote door locking/
unlocking and starting, and
in-vehicle transmitters for garage
door openers. RFID technology in
Cadillac vehicles does not use or
record personal information or link
with any other Cadillac system
containing personal information.
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (1,1)
INDEX
A
Accessories and
Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18
Active Emergency
Braking System . . . . . . . . 1-16, 9-48
Adaptive Cruise Control . . . . . . . 9-34
Adaptive Forward
Lighting (AFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Adaptive Forward Lighting
(AFL) Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24
Add-On Electrical
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-64
Adjustable Throttle and
Brake Pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
Adjustments
Lumbar, Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Thigh Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . . 10-9
Air Filter, Passenger
Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Airbag System
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28
How Does an Airbag
Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-23
What Makes an Airbag
Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-23
What Will You See after an
Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-23
When Should an Airbag
Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-22
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . .3-20
Airbags
Adding Equipment to the
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-27
Light On-Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
On-Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
On-Off Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25
Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13
Servicing Airbag-Equipped
Vehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-27
System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-19
Alarm
Vehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15
Alert
Side Blind Zone (SBZA) . . . . . .9-50
All-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . 9-25, 10-22
i-1
Anti-theft
Locking System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17
Antilock Brake
System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-19
Appearance Care
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-78
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-83
Armrest Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Ashtrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Assistance Systems for
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45
Assistance Systems for
Parking and Reversing . . . . . . . 9-43
Automatic
Dimming Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-20
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-21
Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . .10-9
Automatic Transmission
Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-23
Shift Lock Control
Function Check . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
i-2
Black plate (2,1)
INDEX
B
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21
Exterior Lighting Battery
Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70
Load Management . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10
Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Voltage and Charging
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-28
Blade Replacement, Wiper . . . 10-23
Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
Brake
Pedal and Adjustable
Throttle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-13
System Warning Light . . . . . . . .5-18
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-26
Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-28
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-27
System Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .5-28
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Braking System
Active Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . .1-16
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . 10-25, 10-26
High Intensity Discharge
(HID) Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26
Indicator Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29
License Plate Lamps . . . . . . . 10-30
Reversing Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30
Buying New Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-50
C
Capacities and
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2
Carbon Monoxide
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-20
Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
Cargo
Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Management System . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
Tie-Downs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
Cargo Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Cargo Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
Cautions, Danger, and
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii
Centre Console Storage . . . . . . . . 4-3
Chains, Tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-53
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . 5-15
Check
Engine Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
Child Restraints
Infants and Young
Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-31
ISOFIX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-40
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-29
Securing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41, 3-42
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-33
Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32
Cleaning
Exterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-78
Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-83
Climate Control Systems
Dual Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Cluster, Instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
Compact Spare Tyre . . . . . . . . . . 10-69
Compartments
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (3,1)
INDEX
Compass
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-29
Compressor Kit, Tyre
Sealant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56
Conformity
Declaration of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-1
Control
Traction and Electronic
Stability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-29
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
Coolant
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
Engine Temperature
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12
Engine Temperature
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-21
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11
Engine Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .5-30
Courtesy Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Cover
Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-6
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-25
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-29
Cruise Control, Active . . . . . . . . . 9-34
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
D
Danger, Warnings, and
Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii
Daytime Running
Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Declaration of Conformity . . . . . . 13-1
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Door
Ajar Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-30
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Power Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Rear Seat Pass-Through . . . . . 3-11
Drive Belt Routing, Engine . . . . . 12-4
Drive Systems
All-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . 9-25, 10-22
Driver Assistance Systems . . . . 9-42
i-3
Driver Information
Centre (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25
Driving
Assistance Systems . . . . . . . . . .9-45
Characteristics and
Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-57
Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
For Better Fuel Economy . . . . .1-18
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . 9-5
If the Vehicle is Stuck . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
Dual Automatic Climate
Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
E
ECO Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24
Economy Mode
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-24
Electric Parking Brake Light . . . 5-18
Electrical Equipment,
Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-64
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
i-4
Black plate (4,1)
INDEX
Electrical System
Engine Compartment
Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33
Fuses and Circuit
Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32
Instrument Panel Fuse
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35
Overload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32
Rear Compartment Fuse
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37
Engine
Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9
Check and Service Engine
Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
Compartment Overview . . . . . . .10-5
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
Coolant Temperature
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12
Coolant Temperature
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-21
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Cooling System Messages . . .5-30
Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-6
Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . .12-4
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-20
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-17
Engine (cont'd)
Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9
Oil Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-31
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16
Petrol Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-15
Power Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-31
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22
Running While Parked . . . . . . . .9-21
Engine Identification . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Equipment, Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-61
Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Extender, Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Exterior Lighting Battery
Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
F
Features
Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
Filter,
Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . .10-9
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Flat Tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-54
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-63
Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-86
Fluid
Automatic Transmission . . . . . .10-9
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Fog Lamp Light, Rear . . . . . . . . . 5-24
Fog Lamps
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
Forward Collision Alert
(FCA) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45
Front Fog Lamp
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24
Front Seats
Heated and Ventilated . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Front Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-54
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-54
Economy Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18
Economy Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22
Filling a Portable Fuel
Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-56
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-55
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (5,1)
INDEX
Fuel (cont'd)
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . .5-23
Recommended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-54
System Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .5-31
Fuel Economy Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24
Fuses
Engine Compartment
Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33
Fuses and Circuit
Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32
Instrument Panel Fuse
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35
Rear Compartment Fuse
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37
G
Gauges
Engine Coolant
Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Mileometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-10
Rev Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-10
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Warning Lights and
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
General Information
Service and Maintenance . . . . . 11-1
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-57
Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
H
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Hazard Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Headlamp Levelling Control . . . . 6-5
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26
Adaptive Forward
Lighting (AFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Daytime Running
Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
High Intensity Discharge
(HID) Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26
Indicator Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29
Lamps On Reminder . . . . . . . . .5-24
Main-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . .5-23
i-5
Headlamps (cont'd)
Main/Dipped Beam Changer . . . 6-3
Twilight Sentinel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Heated
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-10
Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Heated and Ventilated Front
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20
Heater
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-17
High-Speed Operation . . . . . . . . 10-43
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . 9-5
Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . 9-28
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
How to Wear Safety Belts
Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
I
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14
Immobiliser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
i-6
Black plate (6,1)
INDEX
Indicator
Vehicle Ahead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20
Infants and Young Children,
Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31
Infotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
Interior Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . 2-21
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii
ISOFIX Child Restraint
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40
J
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70
K
Key and Lock Messages . . . . . . . 5-32
Keyless Entry
Remote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . 2-3
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
L
Lamps
Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . 6-4
Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Exterior Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Exterior Lighting Battery
Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Front Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . .5-15
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-32
Number Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24
Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10
Rear Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-51
Lane Departure Warning
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14
Levelling Control
Headlamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
Light
Adaptive Forward Lighting
(AFL) Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24
Lighter, Cigarette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Lighting
Adaptive Forward . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10
Illumination Control . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
Lights
Airbag On-Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Airbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13
Antilock Brake System
(ABS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-19
Brake System Warning . . . . . . .5-18
Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-25
Electric Parking Brake . . . . . . . .5-18
Engine Coolant
Temperature Warning . . . . . . .5-21
Engine Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . .5-22
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Fog Lamp, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24
Front Fog Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24
Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22
Lane Departure Warning . . . . . .5-19
Low Fuel Warning . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23
Main-Beam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23
Main/Dipped Beam Changer . . . 6-3
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (7,1)
INDEX
Lights (cont'd)
Seat Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . .5-12
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23
Service Electric Parking
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-19
StabiliTrak® OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20
Traction Control System
(TCS)/StabiliTrak® . . . . . . . . . .5-21
Traction Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20
Tyre Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22
Lights, Hazard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7
Limited-Slip Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . 9-31
Locking Systems, Anti-theft . . . . 2-17
Locks
Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . 5-23
Lumbar Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
M
Main-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
Maintenance
Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7
Maintenance Schedule
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . 11-1
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . 5-15
Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23
Memory Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
Memory Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Messages
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-36
Battery Voltage and
Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-28
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-28
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-29
Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-30
Engine Cooling System . . . . . . .5-30
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-31
Engine Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-31
Fuel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-31
Key and Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-32
Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-32
Object Detection System . . . . .5-33
i-7
Messages (cont'd)
Ride Control System . . . . . . . . . .5-35
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-36
Service Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-36
Starting the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . .5-36
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-37
Tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-37
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-28
Vehicle Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38
Vehicle Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38
Mileometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Mirrors
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . .2-20
Automatic Dimming
Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Convex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-20
Manual Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Tilt in Reverse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-20
Mirrors, Interior Rearview . . . . . . 2-21
Monitor System, Tyre
Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-43
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
i-8
Black plate (8,1)
INDEX
N
P
Net
Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
Net, Convenience . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
New Vehicle Run-In . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
Park
Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-18
Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-19
Parking
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-27
Brake and P (Park)
Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . 10-23
Over Things That Burn . . . . . . .9-20
Parking or Reversing
Assistance Systems . . . . . . . . . .9-43
Passenger Compartment Air
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Personalisation
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38
Petrol Engine, Starting . . . . . . . . . 9-15
Power
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Protection, Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Retained Accessory (RAP) . . .9-18
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
O
Object Detection System
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-33
Off-Road
Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Oil
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-6
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . .10-9
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-31
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22
Older Children, Restraints . . . . . 3-29
Outlets
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . 10-16
Pregnancy, Using Safety
Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Privacy
Radio Frequency
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . .13-2
R
Radio Frequency
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . .13-2
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Rear Axle
Limited-Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-31
Rear Climate Control System . . . 8-6
Rear Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . 5-24
Rear Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Rear Seat
Pass-Through Door . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-10
Rear Window Washer/Wiper . . . . 5-4
Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Reclining Seat Backrests . . . . . . . 3-5
Recommended
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-54
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (9,1)
INDEX
Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5
Records
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7
Recreational Vehicle
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-76
Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2, 2-3
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31
Replacement Parts
Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6
Replacing Airbag System . . . . . . 3-28
Replacing Safety Belt
System Parts after a Crash . . . 3-18
Restraints
Where to Put . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-34
Retained Accessory
Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18
Rev Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Reverse Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20
Ride Control Systems
Limited Slip Rear Axle . . . . . . . .9-31
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-35
Selective . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-31
Roads
Driving, Wet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Roof
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Rotation, Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-48
Routing, Engine Drive Belt . . . . . 12-4
Running the Vehicle While
Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21
Running-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . 9-13
S
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-18
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
How to Wear Safety Belts
Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . .3-14
Replacing after a Crash . . . . . .3-18
Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . .3-17
Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Safety System Check . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . 11-1
Sealant Kit, Tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56
Seat Belts
Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12
i-9
Seats
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Heated and Ventilated Front . . . 3-8
Heated, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-10
Lumbar Adjustment, Front . . . . . 3-4
Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Power Adjustment, Front . . . . . . 3-3
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Reclining Seat Backrests . . . . . . 3-5
Securing Child
Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41, 3-42
Security
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-36
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15
Vehicle Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15
Selective Ride Control . . . . . . . . . 9-31
Service
Accessories and
Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . .10-3
Engine Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
Maintenance Records . . . . . . . . 11-7
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
i-10
Black plate (10,1)
INDEX
Service (cont'd)
Maintenance, General
Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1
Parts Identification Label . . . . .12-1
Vehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .5-36
Service Electric Parking
Brake Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
Servicing the Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
Shift Lock Control Function
Check, Automatic
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Shifting
Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-18
Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-19
Side Blind Zone
Alert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-50
Signals, Turn and
Lane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7
Spare Tyre
Compact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-69
Specifications and
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
StabiliTrak
OFF Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20
Start Assist, Hills . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-28
Start Vehicle, Remote . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . . 10-22
Starting the Petrol Engine . . . . . 9-15
Starting the Vehicle
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-36
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3
Fluid, Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
Heated Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Storage Areas
Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Cargo Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Cargo Management System . . . 4-5
Centre Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . . 4-1
Storing the Tyre Sealant
and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . 10-63
Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
Switches
Airbag On-Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv
System
Active Emergency Braking . . . .9-48
Forward Collision
Alert (FCA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-45
Infotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1, 13-2
Roof Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Systems
Driver Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-42
T
Tailgate
Carbon Monoxide . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . 2-18
Immobiliser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17
Thigh Support Adjustment . . . . . . 3-4
Throttle, Adjustable . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Towing
Driving Characteristics . . . . . . . .9-57
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-61
General Information . . . . . . . . . .9-57
Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . 10-76
Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-60
Trailer Sway Control (TSC) . . .9-64
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-74
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
Black plate (11,1)
INDEX
Traction
Control System (TCS)/
StabiliTrak® Light . . . . . . . . . . . .5-21
Limited-Slip Rear Axle . . . . . . . .9-31
Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20
Selective Ride Control . . . . . . . .9-31
Traction Control/Electronic
Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-29
Trailer
Sway Control (TSC) . . . . . . . . . .9-64
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-60
Transmission
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-21
Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-37
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Turn and Lane-Change
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7
Twilight Sentinel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
Tyres
Buying New Tyres . . . . . . . . . . 10-50
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-53
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-63
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-69
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-52
If a Tyre Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . 10-54
Tyres (cont'd)
Inflation Monitor System . . . . 10-45
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-48
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-37
Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-43
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22
Pressure Monitor System . . . 10-43
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-48
Sealant and
Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56
Sealant and Compressor
Kit, Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-63
Wheel Alignment and
Tyre Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-52
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . 10-53
When It Is Time for New
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-49
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41
U
Using This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii
i-11
V
Vehicle
Alarm System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Identification
Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-1
Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-28
Personalisation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38
Reminder Messages . . . . . . . . . .5-38
Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15
Speed Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-74
Vehicle Ahead Indicator . . . . . . . 5-20
Vehicle Care
Storing the Tyre Sealant
and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . 10-63
Tyre Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42
Ventilation, Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
Cadillac SRX Owner Manual - 2014 - crc - 8/7/13
i-12
Black plate (12,1)
INDEX
W
Warning
Brake System Light . . . . . . . . . . .5-18
Lane Departure (LDW) . . . . . . .9-51
Warning Lights, Gauges, and
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii
Cautions and Danger . . . . . . . . . . . .iii
Hazard Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38
Washer, Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
Wheels
Alignment and Tyre
Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-52
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-52
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-53
When It Is Time for New
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-49
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . 3-34
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Windscreen
Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Winter
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
Winter Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . 10-23
Wipers
Rear Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4